Is - 2825.1969
Is - 2825.1969
Is - 2825.1969
Irl-
1s : 2825-1969
INDIAN STANDARD
UNFIRED
COMMITTEE,
EDC 48
FIRST IUBI,ISHEI)
MARCH 1971
JANUARY
1994
1996
199s
UDC
66.023: 621.642
PRINED IN 1NDIA
Al I(I\Y fC_AYPRINTERS, DELfII, INDIA AND IUBLISIIED l3Y
BUREAU OF INDIAN STANDARDS, 9 BAIIADUR SIiAH ZAFAR MARG, NEW DELHI 110 002
Chairman
SHRI V. MAHAD~VAN
The
SHRI N . c. BAOCIfI
SHRI S.-,G. BANRBJEE
SHRI J. BASU
SHRI N. THANDAVAN ( Alternate)
SHRI
A. K. BHATTACHARYA
SHRI T. BHARDWAJ (Alternate )
SHRI S. R. BHISE
and
Kuljian Corporation
Chemicals
Travancore
Pneumatic
Delhi
Ltd, Calcutta
Co Ltd, PWM
New
Ltd,
Directorate
General of Factory Advice
Institutes, Bombay
Railwav Board ( Ministry of Railways)
Co of India
Ltd,
Co Ltd, Jamshedpur
Department
of Heavy Engineering ( Ministry of Industry
& Supply ), New Delhi
John Thompson India ( Pvt ) Ltd, Calcutta
Heavy Electricals ( India ) Ltd, Bhopal
SHRI S. N. SENOUPTA
SHRI N. P. SINOH
SHRI
N. S. SESHADRI ( Alhwnate )
SHRI M. M. SuRI
Mechanical
Engineering
Central
( CSIR ), Durgapur
Central Boilers Board, New Delhi
ACC-Vickers-Babcock
Ltd, Calcutta
Tata Chemicals Ltd, Mithapur
TECHNICALADVISER( BOILERS)
SHRI 1). G. TURNBULL
SHRI M. K. VADOAMA
SHRI S. BALAKRISHNAN( Al&no&.)
SHRI K. S. WHITEHO~SE
SRRI I<. A. I. WILLIAMSON
SHRI B. S. KRWHNAMACHAR,
7
Director ( Strut & Met )
SHRI M. V. PATANKAR,
Director
Fertilizers
Udyogamandal
Research
Institute
( Mech Engg )
SHRI M. G. KRISHNA RAO
Deputy Director
Subcommittee,
Materials
EDC 48
: 1
COWUW
Hindustan Steel Ltd, Ranchi
SmI S. C. LAHIRI
Members
SHRI s. L. ARANHA
L>EPUTYDIRECTORRESEARCH(MET - I )
SlIRI
1%. HILL
Design
and
Fabrication
Subcommittee,
SARI J. BASIJ
SHRI D. S. DESAI
SHRI S. GIIOSH
SHRI 13. HILL
SHRI G. CODD ( Akernale )
Heavy Eleciricals
( India
Co of* India
) Ltd, Bhopal
EDC 48 : 2
The A.P.V. Engineering Co Pvt Ltd, Calcutta
M.N. Ddstur & Co Pvt Ltd, Calcutta
The Alk.\li & Chrmical Corporation of India Ltd, (ialcutta
Lloyds Register of Sllipping, Calcutta
Representing
Members
SHRI J. P. MIJKHERJBE
DR R. S. DUBEY ( Altemah )
SHRI M. H. PHERWANI
Walchandnagar
SkQI V. M. RaO
SHRI K. SATYANARAYANA ( Alf~n&)
REPRILSENTATIVE
S&iRtS. N. SENGUPTA
SENIOR INSPECTING ENGINEER
SHRI N. P. SIKGII
SHQI N. S. SESHADRI ( Altemale
TECHNICAL ADVISER ( BOILERS)
Testing
and
Inspection
Industries
Ltd, Walchandnagar
Institute
Central
Subcommittee,
EDC 48 : 3
Concenrr
Directorate General of Factory Advice Service and Labour
Institutes, Bombay
SHRI S. R. BHISE
Members
SHRI S. L. ARANHA
Burmah
Shell Oil Storage
Ltd, Bombay
Code of Practice
Imperial
Chemical
Lloyds Reglstrr
The K.C.P.
Industries
( India ) Pvt
of Shipping,
Co of India
Ltd,
Calcutta
Calcutta
Ltd, Madras
SHRI S. N. SENGUPTA
and Distributing
John Thompson
SMDC
( India j
14 : 4
Members
.%
SHRI N. C. BAGCHI
SHRI A. K. Bose
SHRI J. C. KAPUR ( Altnnate )
DEPUTY DIRECTOR RESEARCH (MET-I
SHRI A. JEAVON~
SHRI V. ~~AHADEVAN
SHRI V. R. RAMA PRA&D
SHRI H. L. PRABHAKAR ( Al&a&
SHRI K. G. K. RAO
SHRI S. C. ROY
Editing
Electricals
& Standards
Organization
( Ministry
& General
Engineering
Corporation,
Chemicals
Travancore
Ltd,
of
Udyoga-
)
Tata Engioecring
& Locomotive Co Ltd, Jamshcdpur
Central Boilers Board, New Delhi
Panel
Conrener
SHRI V. MAHADEVAN
The
Fertilizers
Udyogamandal
and
Chemicals
Travancorc
Lto,
Mem bns
SHRI S. P. BATRA
SHQI S. C. JAIN (Alternate)
SHQI S. C. DEY
SHRIJ. N. GOSWAMY
SHQI H. S. RAO ( Alternate )
SHRI H. H. JETHANANDANI
SIIRI $-I. R. S. RAO
&RI S. c. ROY
vi
Department
of Industrial
Industrial Development,
Affairs )
Development
Internal
Trade
( Ministry
of
& Gumpany
CONTENTS
0. FOREWORD
SECTION
GENERAL,
MATERIALS AND
DESIGN
2.
GENERAL
MATERIALSOF CONSTRUCTION
AND ALLOWABLESTRESSVALUES
3.
4.
5.
DESIGN
FLANGE CALCULATIONS
FORNON-STANDARD
FLAWOES
PRESSURE
RELIEVINGDEVICES
1.
SECTION
II
FABRICATION
AND
9..
8.
9.
Ill
INSPECTION,
. .
5
9
11
43
56
WELDING
.6. MANUFACTURE
AND WORKMANSHIP
7. WELDINGQUALIFICATIONS
SECTION
. ..
. ..
TESTS, MARKING
AND
INSPECTION
ANDTESTS
MARJUNOAND RECORDS
...
.*.
65
79
.*.
...
95
110
RECORDS
APPENDICES
115
ALLOWABLESTREET
VALUESFOR FERROUS
AND NON-FERROUS
MATERIAL . . .
ELEVATED TEMPERATUREVALUES FOR CARBON AND Low ALLOY STEELS
. ..
WITHUNCERTIFIED
HIOHTEMPERATURE
PROPERTIES
124
APPENDIXC STRESSES
FROMLOCAL LOADS ON, AND THERMALGRADIENTSIN, PRESSURE
126
.. .
VESSEts
APPENDIXD TENTATIVE RECOMMENDED
PRACTICEFOR VESSELSREQUIREDTO OPERATE
AT Low TEMPERATURES
...
175
178
.
.
.
APPENDX E TENTATIVERECOMMENDED
PRACTICETO AVOIDFATIGUECRACKINO
APPENDIXF ALTERNATEMETHODFORDETERMINING
SHELLTHICKNESSES
OF CYLINDRICAL
180
...
ANDSPHERICALVESSELSUNDEREXTERNALPRESSURE
BY USE OF CHARTS
195
.. .
APPENDIXG TYPICALDESIGNOF WELDEDCONNECTIONS
APPENDIXH PRO FORMA FOR THE RECORD OF WELDING PROCEDUREQUALIFICATION/
224
WELDER PERFORMANCE
QLJALIFICATION
TEST
.. .
APPENDIXJ WELDINO OF CLAD STEEL AND' APPLICATIONOF CORROSION-RESISTANT
226
..*
LININGS
231
.*.
APPENDIXK METHODOF PREPARINQ
ETCHEDSPECIMEN
232
.
.
.
APPENDIXL PRO FO~A FORREPORTOF RADIOORAPHIC
EXAMINATION
APPENDIXM PRO FOMA FOR MAKERSCERTIFICATEOF MANUFACTUREAND PRODUCTION
233
.I.
TEST
APPENDIXA
APPENDIXB
APPENDIXN
235
vii
IS a2025- 1969
0.
FOREWORD
0.1 This
Indian
Standard
was adopted by the
Indian Standards
Institution
on 19 March 1969,
after the draft finalized by the Unfired Pressure
Vessels Sectional Committee had been approved
by the Mechanical Engineering Division Council.
0.2 Pressure vessels are widely used in chemical
and petroleum industries, for generation of steam
and for storage and conveyance of compressed and
liquefied gases.
publications:
ISO/R
831-1968 Rules for construction
of
stationary
boilers.
International
Organization for Standardization.
INSTA
20/Sekr.
37-1957 Recommendation
regarding welded pressure vessels. Part I :
Rules for construction.
Dansk Standardiseringsraad ( Denmark ).
AD Merkblatt H, SchweiBen von Druckbehaltern aus Stahl, 1960 ( Welding of steel pressure vessels ). Vereinigung
der Technishen
Uberwachungs-Vereine.
Swedish
Pressure
vessel code i959.
The
pressure vessel commission, the Royal Swedish Academy
of Engineering
Sciences,
Stockholm.
Swedish Code for welding of pressure vessels
( boiler welding code ). The Royal Swedish
Academy
Sciences,
of
Engineering
Stockholm.
B.S. 1500 :- Fusion welded pressure vessels for
use in the chemical, petroleum and allied
industries.
Part 1 : 1958 Carbon
British Standards
otherwise
SECTION
1.
2.
GENERAL,
MATERIALS
DESIGN
GENERAL
~~ATERIALS
01. CONSTRL~CIION
ALLCWAELE STRESSVALUES
AXW
2.1 Ma~elkls
SlWhS
2.2 AlloIv.?llle
2.3 Materials for I,oM. lempcraturc
2.4
3.
AND
h,iatrrials
Service
fix. \Velding
DESIGN
3.1
3.2
3.3
3.4
3.5
3.6
3.7
3.8
3.9
3.10
3.11
3.12
3.13
3.14
Gcllcl-al
Corrosion,
llrwjon ant1 Protection
i=ylinrlricnl and Spherical
Shcils
Domcci llnds
Coni,al I<ncls
Unstiqd
Elnt 1 Icacls and Cwcrs
Stayed
and l%racdPlatcs
Openings,
Branches ad Compensation
Access and lnspcction
Openings
Bolted Flange Connections
Ligamer.t Efficiency
Jacketed
Vessels
sIIpporl
intrrnal
Sllnclllrcs
5.
4. r
4.2
4.3
4.4
General
Fasteners
Classification
of l+inges
Flanges Subject to internal
4.5
4.6
4.7
4.8
4.9
Bolt Loads
Flange Monw~lts
Flallge S~WSSCS
Allowable Fl.?ngc Strrsscs
Flanges Snbiwt lo I;xtcrnal
PRESSUREk3LJEVING
5.1
5.2
5.3
5.4
5.5
5.6
5.7
Pressure
Pressure
nEVlcES
General
Design
Marking
Capacity of Relief Valves
Pressure Setting of a Pressure Relieving Device
Installation
of Press~.xc Relieving Devices
Discharge
Lines
..
...
...
...
5
5
6
. ..
...
. ..
...
...
9
10
11
11
.. .
11
...
11
. ..
...
...
...
*..
...
12
12
17
21
24
28
...
...
...
a..
..D
...
...
30
35
36
36
39
41
41
...
43
. ..
...
43
43
...
...
...
...
...
...
1..
43
43
45
53
56
56
56
...
56
...
...
.*.
..*
...
56
61
61
61
62
...
..
62
62
fs:2825.1!69
1. GENERAL
1.1 Scope
1.1.1 This code covers minimum
construction
requirements
for the design, fabrication,
inspection, testing and certification
of fusion welded
unfired pressure vessels in ferrous as well as in
non-ferrous metals.
1.1.1.1 This
following:
code
does
not
include
for
pressure
the
Vessels designed
200 kgf/cm2;
b)
c)
of 1 lOC,
water capacity
of 500 litres;
Vessels having an internal operating pressure not exceeding 1 kgf/cm2 with no limitations on size;
e) Vessels
f)
not
on
S) Vessels
h)
dia
of 50 000 kcal/h,
2) water temperature
3) a nominal
exceeding
is due
energy application;
and
Standards.
tanks
covered
and
by
IS:2825-1969
1.2.5 Minimum Thickness - The thickness obtained
by calculation
according
to formulae
in the code. This is only a minimum value and
requires to be increased to allow for other factors
affecting the use of the vessel as noted below.
1.2.5.1 Vessels or parts of vessels subject to
corrosion and erosion ( mechanical abrasion ) shall
have provision made to cover the total amount of
the deterioration
anticipated over the desired life
of the equipment.
The actual allowance is a
mat:er for careful consideration
and agreement
hetwccn the purchaser
and the manufacturer
( .ree also 3.2 ) .
1.2.5.2 Provision for additional
allowances
should be made to take care of additional stresses
due to:
4 impact loads, including rapidly fluctuating
pressure;
weight
of the vessel and contents under
b)
operating and test conditions;
cl superimposed loads, such as other vessels,
platforms and ladders, piping, insulation,
and corrosion or erosion resistant lining;
wind loads and earthquake
loads where
required;
e) thermal stresses; and
f ) reactions of supporting lugs, ring, saddles
or other types of supports.
13 Classification
1.3.1 The welded pressure vessels covered by
this code shall conform to one of the classes shown
in Table 1.1. Each class of construction provides
for the use in design, of a joint efficiency factor
associated with the material,
quality
control
inspection and tests prescribed for that class.
1.3.1.1 Class
1 z~ssels
chambers
*For other terms relating to welding and cuttinz, see to the vessel which intersect the shell or brads of a vc.\sel and
dclinirirrns gilen in IS : 812.1957 Gloasrry of terms relating form an integral part of the pressure containing enclosures,
to wclcling and cutting of metals .
for example, rumps.
6
l8:2825-1969
Co&gory C-Welded
joints
connecting
flanges, van stone laps, tube sheets, and
flat heads to main shells, to formed heads,
to transitions in diameter, to nozzles or to
communicating chambers*, and any welded
joint connecting one side plate? to another
side plate of a flat sided vessel.
FIG. 1.1
REQUIRRMENT
1.1
TYPICAL OF CATEGORIES
A, B, C AND D
CLASSIFICATION
OF PRESSURE VESSELS
CLAll 1
ii:.
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(51
1.
1.00
0.85
0.70
2.
Radiography
3.
Limitations
a) Permissible
plate material
0.60
050
No radiography
No radiography
-.
*Communicating chambers are defined as appurtmanca
to the vessel which i-ct
the shell or heads of a ves~cl and
form an integral part of the pressure containing enclosures, for example, surqpl;
tSide plates of a tlat sided vessel are defined as any of the flat plates forming an integral part of the pressure containing
enclosura.
IS : 2825 - 1969
TABLE
1.1
CLASSIFICATION
CLASS 1
REQUIREMENT
CLASS
OF PRESSURE
VESSELS -
Conki
CLwr 3
it.
(1)
4.
Type
(4)
(3)
(2)
b) Shell
or end
plate thickness
of joints
Quality
(7)
Maximum
thickness 16 mm before corrosion allowance is added
hfaximum
thickness 16 mm before corrosion allowance is added
Maximum
thickness 16 mm before corrosion allowance is added
i) Double weld.
ed butt joints,
with full penetration
exeluding
butt
with
joints
metal backing
strips
which
in
remain
place
i) Single
welded butt joints
with backing
strip not over
16 mm thickness or over
i) Single
full
fillet lap joints
for
circumferential seams
only
(see 6.3.1)
ii) Single
weided butt joints
with backing
strip J=O*80
( see 6.3.6.1)
fFie 2;
Out-
control
a) Material
b) During
cation
(5)
Maximum
thickness 38 mm after
adding corrosion
allowance
(5)
on
No limitation
thickness
fabri-
i) Inspection
and
tests at
steel
makers
works
i) Inspection
and
tests at
steel makers
works
i) Inspection
and tests at
steel
makers
work9
i) Inspection
and tests at
steel makers
works
ii) Identification
and marking
of plate and
other components
ii) Identification
and marking
of plate and
other components
ii) Identification
and marking
of plate and
other components
ii) Identification
and marking
of plate and
other components
iii) Inspection
of
material
and
plate edges
iii) Inspection
of
material
and
plate edges
iii) Inspection
ot
material
and
plate edges
iii) Inspection
of
material
and
plate edges
iii) Identification
and stamping
of weld test
plates
iii) Identification
and stamping
of weld
test
plates
iii) Identification
and stamping
of weld test
plates
iii) Inspection
during
welding
gress, %cI):doing
second
side welding
grooves
after
preparation
by chipping,
gouging, grinding or machining
iv) Inspection
during
wclding
in progrcss, including
second
side welding
grooves after
preparation
by chipping,
gouging, grinding or machining
iv) Inspection
during
welding in
progress, including
second
side welding
grooves after
preparation
by chipping,
gouging, grinding or machining
iv) Inspection
during
welding
in progress, including
second
side
welding
grooves aFter
preparation
by chipping,
gouging, grinding or machining
iv) Calibration
dimenand
sional
check
on completion
i) Inspection
and
tests at
steel
makers
works
ii) Inspection
of
material
and
plate edges
( Continued )
'IS.:
2825-iwb
TABLE 1.1
RBQUIREM~NT
SL
CLASSIFICATION
CLASS I
CLASS
OF PRESSURE VESSELS -
v) Inspection
of
main
seams
after dressing
6.
Mechanical
-------*---__--_-_~
test
v) Inspection
of
seams
main
after dressing
vi) Calibration
dimenand
sional
check
on completion
vi) Calibration
and
dimensional
check
on completion
Mechanical
test
on longitudinal
seams (see 85.1)
Mechanical
tests
on longitudinal
seams ( see 8.5.2 )
i) One reduced
section tensile
test
ii) Bend
test outer surface
in tension*
iii) Bend
test inner surface
in tension*
(6)
-
(5)
(4)
(2)
(1)
CLASS
~-_..----
No.
Contd
v) Calibration
and
dimcnsional
check
on completion
-
(7)
-
i) A check bend
and tensile test
on each plate
for
material
whose s ci6.
cations Je0 not
envisage
de.
tailed testing
i) A check bend
and tensile teat
on each plate
for
material
whcac specifications do not
envisage
detailed testing
Nil
i) A check bend
and tensile tat
on each plate
for material
whose II
cations 80 not
cnvisz-,e da
tailed testing
Nil
test v) Bend
inner
surface
in tension+
vi) Macro
micro
nation
7.
Welding
procedure and operator qualification
8.
Post-weld
treatment
9.
Pressure
aside
heat
test
and
exami-
Check on welding
procedure
and
operator
qualification (see 7.1)
See 6.12
See6.12
Hydraulic
pressure test (see 8.4)
Hydraulic
pressure test (see 8.4)
as alternate
test
Check on welding
procedure
and
operator
qualification ( see 7.1)
Check on welding
procedure
and
operator
qualification (see 7.1).
Number
and
type
of
test
pieces as agreed
to between
purchaser
and
manufacturer
Check on welding
procedure
and
operator
qualification ( 5~ 7.1).
Number
and
test
type
of
pieces as agreed
to
between
purchaser
and
manufacturer
Check on welding
procedure
and
operator
qua&
6cic~b;;~,t
7.1).
and
type
of teat
pieces as agreed
to between
purchaser
and
manufacturer
See 6.12
See 6.12
Sse 6.12
Hydraulic
pressure test (see 8.4)
Hydraulic
pressure test (see a4)
(c)
and 8.5.2.2
Hydraulic
pralure teat (~cd 8.4)
(b) ].
ALLOWABLE
OF CONSTRUCTION
STRESS VALUES
AND
2.1 Materials
2.1.1 The materials
2825-1969
IS:
according
fasteners
Stress
is
on
L..
length
gauge
of 5~65dx,
less than
100 -R,
2.2
TABLE
2.1
DESIGN
STRESS
FACTORS
FOR
VARIOUS
MATERIALS
( Claurr 2.2.1 )
HIon
ALLOY
STI~EU
Low ALLOY
STEEL,9
NON-FERROUII
MATERIAL
OTHERTHAN
BOLTINQ
MATERIAL
1.5
l-5
rtrcss at
3.0
2.5
1.5
1.5
1.50
PROPERTY
CARBON AND
CARBON
MANGANESE
STEELS
stress*
tensile
at
ture
Average stress to produce a total
creep strain of one pcrccut in
IO0 000 hours at design tempcrature
Certiflpd 10 percent
design temperature
proof
stress at
of 0.75.
However,
a quality
a)
b)
All castings have been examined at all critical locations using magnetic- particle, or p-netrant
(see IS : 36581966t
and IS : 3703-19663 ) 0,. by grinding or machining and etching.
c)
If
Castings found to be defective have been rcrjected or repaired to thr satisfaction of the inspecting authority.
repairs by welding are carried out, the castings should be subscqucntly
stress-rclicved or heat-treated as agreed
Repaired areas of castings should be re-examined
in
between the steel-maker and the inspecting authority.
In all other cases a frctor
accordance with (a! above and shqvld be shown to be free from harmful defects.
of O-75 shall bcused instead of C.90.
*The minimum
tCodc
specified yield stress ( at room tempt raturc ) may be taken to apply for all temperatures
*Ccncral
tTtchnica1
10
factor
rcquircmcnts
supply conditiolis
materials
(&$I rcui.rion).
fluid procedure
up to 50C.
Iy : 2825 - 1969
2.2.2 Where safe stress values for material in
compression
are required,
for example,
in the
case of the design of vessels subject to loadings
( see 1.2.5.2 and 3.3.2.4)
that product longitudinal
compressive stresses, it shah bc calculated as given
in Appendix C.
2.2.3 Sh~nr Stresses .- The maximum permissible
shear stress ( where present alone ) shall not
exceed 50 percent of the allowable stress value.
2.2.4 Beming Stressrs - The maximum permissible bearing stress shall not exceed 50 percent of the
allowable stress value.
2.3 Materials
for Low Temperature
ServiceSpecial consideration shall be given to the choice
of materials
for vessels designed for operation
below 0C. Aluminium and its alloys not being
subject to brittle fracture are particularly suitable
for operation at temperatures
below 0C.
Austenitic stainless steels ( wrought ) are quite suitable
For use below this tempefot use up to -200C.
rature or where cast materials are used special consideration shall be given to the choice of material
A recommended practice for carbon
and design.
and low alloy steel vessels required to operate at
low temperatures is given in Appendix D.
2.4 Materials
for Welding - The electrodes,
filler rods and flux shall satisfy the requirements
of appropriate Indian Standards and shall correspond to those used in the procedure qualification
tests and welders performance tests. The following Indian Standards are available or under preparation:
IS : 814-1970
Specification
for covered electrodes for metal arc welding of
struclural steel ( third revision )
IS : 12781967
IS : 1395-1964
IS :
3. DESIGN
3.1 General - Vessels covered by this code shall
be designed for the most severe combinations
of
operating conditions which may be experienced
in the normal operations.
Special consideration shall be given to vessels
designed to operate at temperatures
below 0C.
A tentative
recommended
practice
for vessels
required to operate at low temperatures is given
in Appendix D.
Where vessels are subject to alternate heating
and cooling, provision shall he made in the design
to permit expansion or contraction to avoid excessive thermal stresses ( see Appendix E ).
This code does not contain rules to cover all
details of design and construction.
Where complete details are not given, it is the intention that
the manufacturer,
subject to the approval of the
purchaser and/or the inspecting authority, shall
follow such details ofdesign and construction lvhich
will be as safe as those provided by this code.
3.1.1 Design iXckness - In the clauses
follow, methods are given for calculating
thicknesses required for the various parts
pressure vessel.
3.1.3
IS : 3613-1966
Specification
for
acceptance
tests for wire flux combinations
for submerged arc welding
IS : 4972-1969
IS :
Loadings
3.1.3.1
Specification
for molybdenum
and chromium
molybdenum
low alloy steel electrodes for
metal arc welding ( revised)
spot
that
the
of a
loadings
b)
c)
Wind loading
loadings.
IS : 5206I?69
static head;
in combination
with other
3.1.3.2
Special consideration may be required
to be given to the effect of the following:
a) Local stresses due to supporting lugs, ring
girders, saddles, internal structures or connecting piping;
Specification
for
corrosion
resisting chromium and chromium
nickel
steel
covered
electrodes for metal arc welding
Specification
for filler wires
for metal inert gas lvelding
( under ,4refarutim )
or surg-
11
LS : 2825 - 1969
established by reason of accurate knowledge
of the chemical characteristics
of whatever
substances they are to contain.
d) Forces
due to temperature
differences,
including the effects of differential expansion;
e) Forces caused by the method of supporting
the vessel during transit or erection; and
f)
Fluctuating
pressure and temperature
Appendix E ) .
( see
Corrosion,
Erosion
and Protection
3.2.1 General
3.2.1.1 Whenever the word corrosion is used
in this code it shall be taken to mean corrosion,
oxidation, scaling, abrasion, erosion and all other
forms of wastage.
Stress corrosion cracking may
occur under certain conditions of temperature and
environment and cannot be catered for by increasing thickilesses.
Under conditions, where stress
corrosion may occur, consideration shall be given
to the materials used and the residual stress in
fabricated vessels.
It is impossible to laydown definite precautionary rules to safeguard against the effects of corrosion owing to the complex nature of corrosion itself,
which rniy exist in many forms, for example:
a) Chemical attack, where the metal is dissolved by the reagents, it may be general
over the whole surface, or localized ( causing pitting ), or a combination of the two;
b) Rusting,
moisture
action of
c) Erosion, where a reagent, otherwise innocuous, flows over the surface at a velocity
greater than some critical value; and
d) High
temperature
oxidation
( scaling ).
b)
predictable - Vessels
in
rates may be definitely
in
Corrosion rate unpredictable - Vessels
which corrosion rates are either variable
throughout the vessel or indeterminate \ in
magnitude.
Corrosion rate negligible - Vessels in which
corrosion rates are known to be negligible.
3.2.2 Additional Thickness to Allow for CorrosionThe allowances adopted shall be adequate
to
cover the total amount of corrosion expected on
either or both surfaces of the vessel.
In cases where corrosion may occur, additional
metal thickness over and above that required for the
design conditions should be provided, at least
equal to the expected
corrosion
loss during
the desired life of the vessel.
It is recommended
that in all such cases a minimum corrosion allowance of 1.5 mm should be provided unless a protective lining is employed.
Where the corrosion effects are negligible,
excess thickness need be provided.
no
Cylindrical
and Spherical
Shells
3.3.1 General
3.3.1.1
The thickness shall be not less than
that calculated
by the following formulae and
shall be increased,
if necessary,
to meet the
requirements of 3.1 and 3.2.
3.3.2
notations
3.3.2.1
Notation - The following
are used in the design of spherical and cylindrica
vessels subject to internal pressure:
thickness
of shell plates
exclusive of corrosion allowance in mm,
t = minimum
PDO
PDi
t = POOfJ--p = 2OOfJ+p
--=- PoOfJt
or
Dl+t
200fJt
Do-t
. . ..(3.1)
. . . (3.2)
_Pg!_ =
PDO
4OOfJ-p
4OOfJ+P
400fJt
400fJt
P = -._-.--_=__
Di+t
Do-t
or
Ue
M = longitudinal
bending
moment
in
kgf.mm;
T = torque about vessel axis in kgfmm;
W = weight ( vertical vessel only ) in kg :
4 for points above plane of support weight of vessel, fittings, attaehments and fluid supported above
the point considered, the sum to be
given a negative sign in equation
( 3.5 );
b) for points below plane of support weight of vessel, fittings and attachments below the point considered,
plus weight of fluid contents, the
sum to be given a positive sign in
equation ( 3.5 );
. . . (3.3)
. . . (3.4)
Under no circumstances
shall the shell
thickness ( before adding corrosion allowance )
be less than that given in equation ( 3.1 ).
Where the shell is subjected to loadings additional to those due to internal pressure, the basis
of design shall be that the stress equivalent to the
membrane
stresses shall nowhere
exceed the
allowable stress.
t = shearing
stress in kgf/mms.
Then
4GPD?
uz =
ug
+ W&4$. ..(3.5)
xt (Di+t)
PCa-+-t
1
. . . (3.6)
2001
2T
T=XtDl(D,+t)
. . . (3.7)
The requirements
. ..(3.8)
ee Gf
uz ( tensile ) <f
uz ( compressive
) < 0.125 E
k
0
>
. . . (3.9c)
( see 8.4 )
. ..(3.9d)
. ..(3.9e)
. ..(3*9f)
4M/Di in equation
IS : 2825- 1969
TABLE
3.1
OF E FOR
VALUES
FERROUS
MATERNAL
Carbon
stec1s
o/o
%
Carbon-molybdenum
steels
and
chrome-molybdenum
steels ( up to 3 y0 Cr )
Intermediate
chrome molybdenum steels and austenitic stainless htecls
NOTE -
DESIGN TEMPERATCREC
oh_____-_._-__
r__----__---___
0
c<o,so
c>o.30
100
200
300
lo0
19.6
21.1
19.6
21.0
19.5
20.7
19.0
19.9
18.1
19.0
17.0
17.3
21.1
21.0
20.7
20.1
19.4
1:I. 1
17.1
19.3
19.3
19.0
18.6
!8,0
17 3
16
TABLE
VALUES
GRADE
OF E FOR ALUMINIUM
-100
IN 103 kgfimm?
aad 3.3.2.4)
DESIGN TEMPERATUREC
__-~-~------_--h____---.__
r---200
500
by interpolation.
(Ckmes 3.3.?.1
MATERIAL
~-_.-_-._---~
20
Intermediate
3.2
IN 103 kgf/mm2
MATERIALS
ar:d 3.3.2.4)
(Clauses 3.3.2.1
-_
_______-
50
15
100
125
150
----my
200
lB, N3, N4
7.8
7.4
7.1
7.0
7.0
6.9
6.8
6.7
6.4
H9
7.4
7.1
6.8
6.6
6.6
6.5
ii.5
6.3
6.0
H15
8.3
7.9
7.5
7.4
7.4
7.3
7.2
7.1
6.8
A6
8.9
8.5
8.2
8.1
8.0
7.9
7.8
7.7
7.4
Intermediate
values
NOTE 1 -
NATE
2 - Since aluminium
used with caution.
TABLE
may be obtained
VALUES
3.3
by interpolation.
do not have
a well-defined
OF E FOR NICKEL
( &uses
3.3.2.1
Nickel
70 0% Nickel and
copper alloy
Nickel,
75 %
chromium
and
ferrous alloy
tin bronze
bronze
Cupro
nickels
18.8
16.5
14.0
11.7
IO.9
17.6
169
16.2
15.5
15.0
15%
10 %
21.8
20.7
20.0
17.6
16.0
13.0
11.9
3.4
VALUES
OF E FOR COPPER
14
AND
IN 10s kgf/mma
ITS ALLOYS
and 3.3.2.4)
DEDGN TEMPLRAT:IREC
h___--_-150
200
250
__.. _________~
~-_---_---~~-~
20
50
100
11.2
11.1
11.0
10.8
10 6
66 % Cu, 34 % Zn
9.8
9.7
9.6
9.5
88 /b Cu, 6 % Sn,
1.5 % Pb, 4.5 % Zn
85.5 % Cu,
12.5 % Sn, 10 % Zn
59 % cu, 39 % Zn
9.1
9.0
8,9
10.5
10.3
10.2
10.7
10.2
9.8
9.1
8.3
7.7
80 % Cu, 20 % Ni
13.3
131
12.9
12.6
12.4
12.1
118
70 % C:&
NOTE
750
18.0
99.98 % Cu
brass
700
20.4
COMPOSITION
Muntz
IN 103 kgf/mmz
and 3.3.2.4 )
18.8
MATERIAL
Copper
of E are to be
21.1
( Clamrs 3.3.2.1
Phosphor
ALLOYS
\-alucs
30 %
TABLE
Leaded
AND NICKEL
the abo\e
point,
DESIGN TEMPERATUREC
~~_____~_~~__~_~~_~~~_~~~_~_~~_~~~_~_~
20
300
490
500
600
MATERIAL
Commercial
yield
Intermediate
30 % Ni
by interpolation.
300
350
400
10.4
10.1
9.7
9.1
8.9
8.6
8.5
8.7
8.4
8.2
8.0
7.7
9.8
9.5
9.1
8.5
6.7
11.5
14.2
IS : 2825- 1969
3.3.3 ShellsSubjected to External Pressure - The
thickness of thin-walled shells subjected to external
pressure may be calculated either by the formulae
below
or by the method
given
in
given
Appendix F.
3.3.3.1
b)
4
,
orp = -
shells,
the effective
p = design pressure in
kgf/cm;
o = O-2 percent
and
stress in kgf/mms;
proof
3.3.3.2
Thickness of cylindrical shells under
external pressure - The thickness of the cylindrical
shells under external pressure is given by equations
3.10, 3.11, or 3.12 as is applicable:
(lop >it
0.58
a) for
DO
=-iz- I:
or+=-&F
L!$L+
or p =
loot
E$
r-
L
14.4
b) for Do7.-or>
W) 6
0.053
K&
(
DO
1E.
...
(3.11a)
0.075p.
$- . K
...
(3.12)
...
(3.12a)
1OOt 8
( D, )
LX.-
3.3.3.3
Thickness of spherical shells under external
thickness of spherical shells under
pressure -The
external pressure is given by equation 3.13:
t5PD0
800
...
(3.13)
(3,13a)
80ut
orp=D
3.3.3.4
StzjTem?zgrings
16
has been
used
in
= moment
of inertia in cm4 of the ring
section around an axis extending through
the centre of gravity and parallel to the
For a stiffening ring,
axis of the shell.
welded to the shell all around, a part of
the shell, equal to 4t may be included in
the moment of inertia when calculating
the stiffening ring;
. ..(3.10)
. ..(3.10a)
= diameter through
of the section of
stiffening ring or
the shell in the
located stiffening
)I
)I
iGO?-
___
Do
than
--.A
DO
L-0
0.053
13.3
Do )
or < -.-- (
-PF=-.
(3.11)
loot #
38
...
0.91
K
The distance
t = -f&
length in mm.
In the case of cylindrical shells, it is the maximum of the following values and is measured
parallel to the axis of the shell:
t = 1.03 x go x (pK)i
or
.:.
(3.14)
15
IS:2825- 1969
of inertia of the ring is maintained
Fig.
_ 3.1 ).
,
CYLINDER
SECURELY WELDED
ETED TO SHELL
Lx
L SUPPORT CRADLE
(A)
(B)
+TlFFENER
CHANNEL FIXED
WlfH FITTING BOLTS
(OR RIVETS) AND
FILLET WELDED TO
STIFFENER RING
-l_
/
DRAIN SLOT
(Fl
(El
Fro. 3.1
16
STIPPENINO RINQSFOR
Length
SPACE TO REMOVE
SCALE AND DEPOSIT
Effrctlvr
of the
( SCI
Vessel
Section
CYLINDRICALVESSELSSUBJECT TO EXTERNAL
PRIWIRI
lS:2825=1S!J
suitably
moment
required
/
/
,I
I/
25
0.10
045
I/I
I YI
,I
I IA!J
VIlll/
I/
I A
II/II
IIII
/
A
/I
30
A
0*2
Oa3
@& 0*50*6
0*8
l*O
1.5
I
5
IIII
6789x)
15
20
25
+f
FIO. 3.2
17
IS : 2825- 19fi9
600
E
$100
.z
.
60
z
2
60
50
a.
40
5
$
30
0
20
I I
2
ALLOWABLE
a) Hemispherical
(-see Fig. 3.3A ),
b) Semi-ellipsoidal
( see Fig. 3.3B ).
The ratio of major axis to minor axis should
not be greater than 2.6 : 1.
18
for formed
ends
for tanks
and
10
20
kgf/mm2
3.4.2 Limitations
of Shabe Ends shall conform
to one of the following shapes ( see IS : 4049-1968* ):
*Specification
vessels.
STRESS,
pressure
c\ Dished
1) The
not
Do,
2) The inside corner radius rr shall preferably be not less than 10 percent of
the inside diameter and in no case less
than 6 percent nor less than 3t.
(A)
tfcmispherical
----A
Do
FIG. 3.4
Ends
j-------------A
FIQ. 3.5
(B)
(C)
Semi-Ellipsoidal
Dished
FIG. 3.3
3.4.3
Ends
and Flanged
Ends
DOMED ENDS
Openings in Ena!s
3.4.3.2
Uncompensated openings - Flanged-in
and other openings shall be arranged so that the
distance from the edge of the end is not less than
that shown in Fig. 3.5.
In all cases the projected
width of the ligament between any two adjacent
openings shall be at least equal to the diameter
of the smaller opening as shown in Fig. 3.6.
3.4.3.3
Compensated
0pCnings- Openings,
where compensation is provided otherwise than
by general thickening of the end ( over and above
that required for an unpierced end ), shall comply
with the requirements of 3.8.
Ends containing
only
openings.
compensated
in
accordance
with 3.8 shall be regarded as plain ends for the
purposes of applying Fig. 3.7.
WHICH EVER
SMALLER
IS
FIO. 3.6
Fro. 3.4-3.6
3.4.4
TYPICALUNICBINFORCED
OPENINGS
Xotation -The
following
notation
has
been employed:
= minimum
&Do=
hE
calcdated
end in mm;
thickness of the
of the end
is the least
--
of the end
in mm;
r1, ro
knuckle
( corner )
19
ls : 28!&.- 1969
&,Ko =
=
f
J
flange;
2.5
5-o
3.0
1.0
O-01
045
0*25
0*20
hE
Do
Fro. 3.7
20
SHAPR
FACTOR
FOR
DOMXD ENDS
x3,2925-1%9
3.4.5 Thickness of Ends Concave to Pressure - The
thickness of the ends shall be determined by theequation:
(3.15)
=-design
pressure in kgf/cms;
in accordance
with 2.2;
Or!)--
d(R.
q)
X (R.++--2
rj
DI E: outside di?meter
of conical
end ( see Fig. 3.8 ) in mm;
I1
._ (3.17)
NOTE 1 _In the case of ends containing no uncompen;;t;~Dopcnmgs,. read C from full curves 1/&=@002
0 I 0.04 mtcrpolatmg as necessary.
NOTE
(3.16)
...
...
a,a+s
2 -
The thickness
of the ends dished to partially spherical form shall
be greater of the following thicknesses:
a) The thickness of an equivalent
sphere,
having a radius R. equal to the outside
crown radius of the end, determined in
accordance with 333.3.
3.4.6.1
section
( see
or
= difference
to
1.2 times
the external
thickness
ends of a true semi-ellipsoidal
shape shall
greater of the following thicknesses:
3.4.6.2
of
be
Conical
Ends
have
of co&al
shall be determined
t=,PD,C,
200fJ
by:
...
The
21
IS:!2855-1969
TABLE
3.5
VALUES
OF +
AS A FUNCTION
OF 2
( Claue 3.04.6.2 )
la
F0
PI67
o-178
0.192
0.208
0.227
o.25
o-278
o.313
0.357
0.417
o.50
&
li;,
1.36
1.27
l-182
1.08
0.99
O-90
0.81
o.73
0.65
0.57
0.50
NOTE -
The inkrmediate
(A)
(C)
Cone/Cylinder
Cone/Cone
(6)
with Knuckle
with Knuckle
FIG. 3.8
by interpolation.
(D)
Conc,/Cylinder
Cone/Cone
without
without
Knucklr
Knuckle
1
20&T~_px -Cosa
..*
(3a*g)
3.5.4 Conical Ends Subject to External Pressure For a conical end or conical section ( frustum )
under external pressure, whether the end is of
seamless or butt welded construction, the general
a)
Shallow
tea-5(De--1)
xGo
TABLE
$..,
3.6
(3.20)
VALUE6
OF C AS FUNCTION
rip
chUS6
OF * AND rl/Da
3.5.2 )
O-01
0.02
O-03
0.04
0.06
O-08
O-10
015
0.20
o-70
0.65
0.60
0.60
o-55
o-55
o-55
O-55
O-55
0.55
O-55
O-55
055
O-55
O-30
O-40
O-50
\-- 0
10.
20
1.00
0.90
O-85
0.80
0.70
O-65
0.60
O-55
O-55
055
3o
195
I.2
1-l
1-O
0.90
0.85
O-80
0.70
o-55
0.55
055
O-55
450
2.05
l-85
l-65
l-5
l-3
l-2
1-l
o-95
0.90
o-70
055
0.5:
6!Y
3-2
2.85
2.55
2.35
2.0
175
I.6
1.4
l-25
100
0.70
0.55
75.
6.8
5-85
5.35
4-75
3.85
3.5
3.15
2.7
2.4
155
la0
o-55
-I
Di
I-l
(A)
Fxo. 3.9
Cone Section
(6)
(C)
Reversed Curvr
Se&on
EXCEEDS D/2
23
ss12825-1969
3.5.5 Constructional Details - Connections
between cylindrical
shells and conical sections and
ends shall preferably he by means of a knuckle
Typical permitted details are
transition radius.
shown in Fig. 3.8. Alternatively
conical sections
and ends may be butt welded to cylinders without
a knuckle radius when the change in angle of
slope P between the two sections under consideration does not exceed 30.
3.6 Unstayed
3.6.1
Flat Heads
and Covers
General -
been
used
ho
:
t
=
=
=
tr, te =
FB
l-60
1*60
N
2
1.60
w
u
&A
&y 1*30
00
1'20
flotation -
1.10
0
O-2
04
RATIO
0-6
P
..
2/ 7
When the head or cover is attached by .bolts
causing an edge moment, the thickness t shall be
calculated for both initial tightening and design
conditions
and the greater of the two values
selected.
f_
CZt2
10
3.6.3.1 Spherically dished covers - The thickness of spherically dished ends secured to the shell
through a flange connection
by means of bolts
shall be calculated by:
3@h
...
(3.23)
t=BOqfJ
(3.21)
3.6.2
.. .
24
IS : 2825- 1969
TABLE
3.7
VALUES
OF D AND C FOR
TYPICAL
UNSTAYED
FLAT
HEADS
DESCRIPTION
_ --.__...
__
REMARKS
TYPICAL EXAMPLE
--___
1. Forged heads
c-o*5
--rib-r-o-25
t HIN
(a)
c10.5
ri,.,l,MIN
(b)
b--
CENTRE
OF WELO
TANGENT
r-31
C = 0.45 when
C = 0.35 when
C = 0.5 when
LINE
MIN
D =
D=
I--CENTRI
OF
TANGENT
r 231
D = D, - I and
Di-rand
taper is
taper is 1 : 4
1: 4
LAP
LINL
Di and
0.25f(r<21
132;
r>2t
C=
0.45 when
I>
I.1 - 0.8 %)
d/or
and
MIN
( Continued )
25
IS : 2825- 1969
TABLE
SL
DESCRIPTION
3.7
VALUES
OF D AND
c FOR
TYPICAL
UNSTAYED
FLAT
TYPICAL EXA~LE
HEADS -
Con!d
REM.AHEI
No.
4. Plates welded
to
the inside of the.
VCSSCI
--It
c=
0.7
c=
Q-7
--
I--
(b)
5. Plates welded to
the end of the
rhell
6.
Plates welded to
the end of the
shell
with
an
additional
fillet
the
weld
on
inside
C = 0.7
( Cohwd
26
IS t 2825- 1969
TABLE 3.7 VALUES
OF D AND c FOR TYPICAL
_.
______..
_.-.-.._-.- .-. ..~--- --..-----
~_~_.
SL
T\.PiC.\l.
J)ESCRIPTIOS
UNSTAYED
FLAT HEADS
.~________
_~.. _.~
Contd
12OMARKS
EX.1&IPLr,
X0.
8.
with
a
n a r r o \Y face
b o I t e d ilange
joint
Covers
---
-_it
t +--
where 4
is
(b)
(a)
9.
i--
Autoclave
manhole covers
D ,> 610 mm
10. Plates
inserted
into the end of
vessel
aud
hacld in place by
a positive
me.
chanical locking
arrangement
---It!-(a)
THREADED
RING
c = 0.55
( Contbwd )
27
IS : 2825 - 1!369
TABLE
3.7
VALUES
OF D AND C FOR
TYPICAL
UNSTAYED
FLAT
HEADS -
Contd
REMARKS
_- .._ ________..___~
_..______ _____. ___~~
;nsrrted
11. Plates
into the vessel as
shown
and rhe
end of the vessel
crimped over
4SVMAX
)OPYIN
D >GO ~,ni
Crimping
shall be done cold only when the operation
will not injure the metal.
In other cases crimping
shall be done when the entire circumfcrencc
of the
cylinder
is uniformly
heated to the proper
forging
temperature
for the material.
Crimping
angle shall
not he less than 30 but need not exceed 45.
c = 0.7
MIN tl=
WHICH
OR ts
EVER
.IS
(a)
AS*MAX
30HIN1
/SEAL WELD,
Di&
or 4ZO.05
and p>ZOf
@I
Stayed
3.7.1 General-Plates
which are braced
by
being connected to each other by means of stays,
tubes, blocks, etc, shall be designed in accordance
Though the method
with the following formulae.
of calculation used is primarily applicable to flat
parallel plates., it may, when suitable, be applied
to slightly inclmed plates or surfaces which because
of their smaller thickness than required under the
clauses of this code are to be stayed as flat plates.
3.1.2
Design
3.7.2.1
Stays may be attached to the plate
stayed by screwing, welding, expanding, bolting
or by a combination of any of these methods.
3.7.2.2
Stays made up of more than one bar
welded into the body, that is composite bars,
shall not be used.
28
Thickne.rs
of
the Stqzd
3.7.3.1 The
thickness
of the stayed and
braced plates shall be calculated by the following
formula :
(3.24)
where
t = minimum
thickness of the plate
in mm;
p = design pressure in kgf/cm*;
D = diameter of the largest circle in
mm which may be inscribed between the supporting points of the
plate ( see Fig. 3.11 ) ;
5
allowable
stress value in kgf/mmz;
f
and
C = a factor
depending
on
the
mode of support and is given by
Fig. 3.12A to 3.12F.
When the
plate is supported
in different
ways on the circumference
of the
inscribed circle of diameter D, a
mean value is to be adopted for C.
Fra.3.:!
(A) FLANGE
OF A FLANGE0
c= 0*45
(8)
HEAD
WELDED
BRACE
c = o-45
/
yy
.p
.4
___-_a-___--__--
(C)
(E)
WELDED TUBE
c= 0*55
STAY
___---_-_
-_--_--
(0)
EXPANDED
AND BEADED
c= o-55
TUBULAR
STAY
IS : 2825 - 1969
3.8 Openings,
Branches
and Compensation
where
L = distance
3.8.1 General
3.8.1.1 Openings in the shell or end plates
of a vessel shall be circular, elliptical or obround
with a ratio of major to minor inside diameter
not exceeding 2.
3.8.1.2 It is preferable
clear of welded seams.
3.8.2
Limitation
of Formulae
3.8.2.1
The formulae and rules given here
for the design of compensation
around openings
are intended to apply directly to openings and
branch connections not exceeding:
4 one-third the inside diameter of the shell
for cylindrical and spherical shells;
one-third
the inside diameter of the conical
b)
section measured
where the nozzle axis
pierces the inner surface of the conical section, and for conical sections; and
one-half the outside diameter of the end for
ends.
Compensation
of larger openings should be
the subject of special consideration
and, if necessary, the adequacy of the proposed design should
be demonstrated
by means of model tests or
hydraulic proof test in accordance with 8.4.
In the case cf large openings
of a conical or reversed curve
( see Fig. 3.9 ) is recommended.
4 taIt, 1
L = ( t,/t,
0.95 )
***
X = a
factor
equal
to
--PDO
( see
18%
3.8.5.1
Genwl - At all planes through the
axis of the opening normal to the vessel surface
the cross-sectional area requirements for compensation as calculated below shall be satisfied:
Material in added compensation,
or in a
branch, should have similar mechanical
and
physical properties to that in the vessel shell or
end. Where material having a lower allowable
stress than that of the vessel shell or end is
taken as compensation
its effective area shall
be assumed to be reduced in the ratio of the
allowable design stresses at the design temperature. No credit shall be taken for the additronal
strength
of material having a higher stress
value than that in the shell or end of the vessel.
...
.a.
(3.26)
where
d=
IS : 2825 - 1969
(Cl
(E)
(D)
FIG. 3.13
TYPICAL COMPENSATEDOPENINGS
where
hi
1) For dished and JIanged and hemispherical en& - When the opening and its compensation
are
located
entirely
within
the
spherical portion of a dished
end, tr js the thickness required
for a sphere having a radius
equal to the spherical portion of
the end.
2) For semi-ellipSoida ends - When
the opening and its compensation are in an ellipsoidal end and
are located entirely within a
circle having a radius, measured
from the centre of the end, of
040 of the shell diameter,
tr
is the thickness required for a
sphere having a radius R, derived from the following:
= depth
b)
1) The
. . . (3.27)
2) The
( t -
t, -
c)
(3.28)
..* (3.29)
31
where
of shell or end
whit-11 is clB~ti\-e as wmpensation mm2;
of branch
pipe
30 -
50000
*Oo
lOO@xJ
32
3.14A
MAXIMUM
DIAMETER OF NON-REINFORCEDOPENINGS
i
fnm2
IS : 2825 - 1969
tr
Hz
I90
and
the
actual
K=*20
K=*30
K--.&O
K**99
AN0
OVER
D&i
Fm.3.14B
DlAMETERx THICKNESS(DXt)
MAXIMUM DIAMETER
OF NON-REINFORCED
OPENINGS
1969
IS : 2825,-
F corrosion
allowance
in mm;
where
A, d and tr are as defined above.
2) Flat plates having an opening with a
diameter
exceeding
one-half
of the
end diameter shall be designed as a
flange ( see 3.10 ).
and
in cor-
--KJT
TC LXCEED
2a
.----T
I
Compensation
of jlanged-in
openings - ( see
3.4.3 ) . Compensation for openings of this
type, as shown in Fig. 3.17, shall be calculated as above except that:
1) The depth of flanging which may be
counted as compensation
shall be in
accordance with equation 3.30:
Hs =
2/ W( t-c)
. . . (3.30)
where
AREA OF COMPENSATION
70
BE NOT LESS
THAN AREA=
r-- ---
-NOT TO EXCEED
2d
ne ssary
The
area of compensation
shall be determined by equation zr.31:
A =
&,.t
. . . (3.31)
where
A = area of compensation
in mms;
required,
L-J.-.-._._
AREA
OF COMPENSATION
INSIDE OF VESSEL
-l-
Y
AREA H
Thickness exaggeratedfor
clarity and weld profllrs
shown diagrammatically only.
t, = calculated
thickness
in mm,
and, if the opening is located
clear of a welded joint, ,I= 1-O.
NOT TO EXCEEO 1W
1)
34
...
(3.32)
AREA OF COMPENSATION
Additlonal
Fro.
3.17
i0
compensation
provided.
If necessary.
ISr2825-1!969
3.8.5.3
Com@r.fation
to external pressure-This
cent of that required
the required minimum
pressure.
for
0pCnings
subject
rings
3.8.6 Tell-Tab
Holes -- Compensating
and similar constructions which may have chambers sealed in by the welding construction
shall
have at least one tell-tale hole tapped to P ) size
( see IS : 554-1964* ).
36.7
Screwed Connections
3.8.7.1
Screw threadr - Threads
shall be in
accordance
with IS : 554-1964*,
IS : 2643-19641;
IS : 3333 ( Part I )-1967:;
and IS : 4218-19688.
The following constructions
are permitted
( see
Fig. G.l to G.5 ) :
b)
Studded Connections
3.8.8.3
Stud holes should not penetrate to
within 0.25 times the wall thickness from the inside
vessel surface, after deducting corrosion allowance;
but when stud holes penetrate to within 0.25 times
the wall thickness from the inner surface of the
vessel, additional metal. shall be provided on the
inside.
gas list tubes
and
Branch Pipes
3.8.9.1
The thickness of the branch
pipe
shall be adequate to meet the design requirement
and shall in addition take into consideration
the
following factors:
a) Corrosion,
b) Loads transmitted
ing piping; and
c) Accidental
loadings
that
during transit and erection.
may
happen
Minimum Thickness*, mm
r-
Carbon &
Ferritic
Alloy Steels
Austenitic
Stainless
Steels
51 & smaller
65, 80, 90
100, 150
203, 254
10
305
11
10
356
13
10
406,457
16
13
Opedngs
General
3.9.0.1
All vessels subject to internal corrosion
or having
parts
subject
to erosion shall be
provided with suitable inspection and/or access
openings so located as to permit a complete visual
examination of the interior of the vessels. In the
case of vessels, in which vapours and/or fumes
are likely to be present in such concentration
as to
be dangerous to persons entering the vessel for
inspection
and/or maintenance,
manholes
of
adequate dimensions shall be provided?.
3.9.0.2
Manholes,
where provided, shall be
at least 450 mm in diameter if circular and if
elliptical its dimensions shall not be less than
450 x 400 mm.
3.9.1Requirements for
Insrpection Ojenings
and
Manhole
31.9
3.9.1.0
All vessels required
by 3.9.0.1
to
have inspection and/or access openings shall be
provided with handholes, mudholes and manholes
in number and sizes as follows; to facilitate cleaning and inspection:
Inside Vessel
Diameter
a) Up
to
230 mm
Requirement
Two openings each not
than 30 mm clear bore
less
condition.
35
IS : 2825 - 1969
Inside Vessel
Diameter
Requirement
b) 230 mm to
400 mm
c) 400 mm to
600 mm
openings
of
Two circular
minimum 90 mm diameter or
two elliptical
openings
of
minimum
dimensions
90 x
76 mm
d) 600 mm to
900 mm
e)
at least
two
manholes
3.9.1.1 Openings
for
pipe
connections,
removable
ends or cover plates may be used in
place of inspection openings provided they are
equal at least to the size of the openings permitted
and can be conveniently
removed for inspection.
A single removable end or cover plate can be used
in place of all other inspection openings if it is
of such a size and location that a general view of
the interior is given at least equal to that obtained
with inspection openings otherwise required.
3.9.1.2 Handling gear - Lifting gear shall be
provided to facilitate the handling of manhole
covers which are in the vertical plane and which
weigh more than 60 kg. A manhole cover located
in the horizontal plane shall be fitted with lifting
handles provided its weight does not exceed 100 kg.
When the cover weight exceeds 100 kg, supporting
gear shall be provided.
3.9.2
Location
3.9.2.1
Manholes shall be so located as to
permit ready ingress and egress of a person.
3.9.2.2
Manholes or handholes in cylindrical
shells shall, where practicable,
be placed away
from any welded seam.
3.9.2.3 Non-circular
manhole
or handhole
openings shall, wherever possible, be arranged
with their minor axes parallel to the longitudinal
axis of the vessel.
3.9.3 Minimnrn Gaske! Bearing Width and Clearance
-for Manhole Corer PiatPs -- Manholes of the type in
which the internal pressure forces the cover plate
36
Bolted
Flange
Connections
b)
Ligament
HEciency
3.11.1 General-Where
a shell is drilled with
multiple holes, for example, in tube plates, its
strength is reduced in proportion
to the metal
removed and according to the relative arrangement of the holes.
In such cases it is necessary to
calculate the strength of the ligaments between
the holes.
In the clauses that follow, methods
for calculatinq the ligament efficiency are given.
The shell thickness and the working pressure
shall be based on the ligament having the lowest
efficiency.
__-__-_
*Dimensions for pipe threads for gas list tubes and
screwed fittings.
tDimcnsions for pelroleum industry pipe threads : Part I
Lint pipe threads.
$Sprcilicalic,n for stwl pipe flanges ( under@$arn!io?t).
YDimcnsions for shell flanges for wssrls and equipment.
IS : 282!5 ,- 1969
3.11.2 Drilling Parallel to the Axis - When the
tube holes are drilled in a cylindrical shell parallel
to its axis, the efficiency J of ligaments shall be
determined as follows.
3.11.2.1
Regular drilling - When the holes are
regularly spaced along the line in question, the
following equation
shall apply:
(3.93)
where
p = pitch
of tube holes,
d = diameter
of tube
and
holes.
3.11.2.2
Irregular drilling - When the pitch
of holes along the line in question is unequal, the
following equation shall apply ( Fig. 3.18 ):
..
J=
(3.34)
A+B+2/(A-B))2+4C2
where
where
P = totai length between centres corresponding to n consecutive ligaments.
This length
should
conform
to
conditions specified in 3.11.5;
n = number
p; and
of tube
holes
d = diameter
of tube holes.
in
length
( sinea + 1 )
t_
>
cosa =
d 1++
sina = ___
2/l++
3.11.4.2
The same rule shall apply
case of drilling holes to a regular saw-tooth
as shown in Fig. 3.2OC.
3.11.4.3
In
spacing of tube
efficiency J of
circumferential,
Fig. 3.21 by the
When
bending
stresses
due
to
negligible
and the tube holes are
T CENTRE
sina cosa
d cosa
l--
C=
3.11.4.1
cos2a + 1
A=
weight
either on
line after
for the
pattern
PL
or - d
a
/d
LINE OF CYLINDER
PtP1+p,~~3+p4~
Fra.
3.18
IRREGULAR
DRILLING
37
I-00
l-00
o-95
0.95
o-90
0.90
O-80
0.80
0.75
0.75
0.70
O-65
0.60
0.50
0.45
0.40
0.35
O-60
IS:2825-l%Y
TCENTRE
LINE Of CVLbNW?
,-CENTRE
LINE OF CVLINDER
r d
over a shorter
If the unequally spaced holes form a symmetrical pattern over a length greater than the inside
diameter of the shell with a maximum of 1 500
mm to give a greater efficiency over such length
than is obtained above: then this greater efficiency may be used.
When holes spaced longitudinally along a drum
are not in a straight line, the equivalent longitudinal pitch for each spacing may be used in the
application of the above rules. This equivalent
pitch is obtained by multiplying the actual longitudinal pitch by the equivalent efficiency obtained
from Fig. 3.19 for each spacing.
3.11.6 Tube plates in heat exchangers and pressure vessels shall be designed in accordance with
the requirements of IS : 4503-1967*.
Aatalc
3.12 Jacketed
Vessels
39
IS : 2825- 1969
3.13
supports
(,Seealso Appendix C ).
Vertical Vessels
3.13.2.1
Bracket support - Where vertical vessels are supported on lugs or brackets attached to
the shell (, Fig. 3.22A ), the supporting members
under the. hearing attachments
ihall preferably
be as close to the shell as clearance for insulation
will permit.
The choice between a number of
brackets and a ring girder will depend upon the
conditions for each individual vessel.
3.13.2.2
Column support -- \ertical vessels supported on a number of posts or columns may require bracing or stiffening by means of a ring
girder, internal partition or similar device in order
to resist the force tending
to buckle the vessel
wall.
f max =
. . . ( 3.35)
where
E = elastic
Tables
modulus in
3.1 to 3.4 ),
kgf/mm*
( see
in mm, and
Horizontal
Vessels
3.13.3.1
Horizontal vessels may be supported
by means of saddles, equivalent leg supports or
ring supports
as shown in Fig.
3.22D
and
Fig. 3.223.
The welds attaching ring supports to the vessel
should have a minimum leg length equal to the
thickness of the thinner of the two parts being
jslned together.
3.13.3.2
Saddles may be used for vessels of
which the wall is not too thin.
Saddles should
preferably extend over at least 120 degrees of the
circumference
of the vessel.
For thin vessels it
may be desirable to place the saddles at points
near the ends of the vessel.
3.13.3.3
For thin-walled
vessel whtre
excessive distortion due to the weight of the vessel
may be expected,
ring supports as shown in
Fig. 3.223, are recommended.
Where practicable,
two ring supports only are preferable,
3.14
Internal
Structures
3.13.2.3
Skirt sup,bort - This type of support
as indicated in Fig. 3.22B and 3.22C should be
not less than 7 mm thick in corroded condition.
( mm ),
\\here the product of skirt diameter
thickness ( mm ), and temperature
at the top
of the skirt above ambient
( deg )
exceeds
16 x 106 ( mm% deg ) account should be taken
of the discontinuity
stresses in both skirt and
vessel induced by the temperature
gradient in
the upper section of the skirt.
It is recommended
that these stresses should be assessed
by the criteria of 3.3.2.4 and Appendix C.
41
ANCHOR SUPPORT
(A) BRACKET
SUPPORT
(B) SKIRT
SUPPORT
W
(0) SADDLE SUPPORT
NEUTRAL AXIS OF
T STIFFENING RING
42
Is:!uWi-1969
4. FLANGE
CALCULATIONS
NON-STANDARD
FLANGES
FOR
4.1 General
4.1.5 The
derations of
consideration
from leakage
4.2 Fasteners-It
is recommended that bolts
and studs have a nominal diHmeter of not less than
12 mm. If bolts or studs smaller than 12 mm are
used, bolting material shall be of alloy steel.
Precautions shall be taken to avoid over stressing
smaller diameter bolts. Bolts and studs shall
not have a thread of coarser pitch than 3 mm
pitch except by special approval by the purchaser.
4.3 Classification
of Flanges-For
design
purposes, flanged facings shall come .mder one
of the fdllowiig categoGes:
a)
b)
4.4 Flanges
Subject to Internal
Pressure
( Narrow-Faced Flanges ) - Ttle,ufnge
desigrl,
methods
outlined
in this
together
with 4.5, 4.6, 4.7 and 4.8 are apblicable to
circular flanges under internal pressure.
bolt spacing
2 ( bolt diameter ) + t
*Rcfcrmce.
Murray N,.W. and Stuart D.G. Bchaviour
in large taper hub flange . Symposium on premrc vascl
research towards better design.
Inst. Mech. E. 1961.
43
IS:2s25-1969
b = effective gasket or joint-contact-surface
seating width, mm ( see Note in 4.5.2 ).
26 = effective gasket
pressure width,
or joint-contact-surface
mm ( see 4.5 ).
diameter,
( from
mm
mm
+-
hogo
for integral-type
e=--for loose-type
flanges
F
ho
A = factor =
b=ho
F = factor for integral-type
Fig. 4.4 ).
G=
loose-type
flanges
1
( from
( from
hub stress-correction
factor for integral
flanges from Fig. 4.8 ( when greater
than 1 this is the ratio of the stress in the
small end of hub to the stress in the
large end ) ; ( for values below limit of
figure use f = 1 ).
diameter
at location
of gasket load
reaction.
Except as noted in sketch-A
of Fig. 4.1, C is defined as follows
( see Fig. 4.2 ).
when b. < 6.3 mm, C = mean diameter
of gasket contact face, mm:
when b > 6.3 mm, G = outside
meter
of gasket
contact
face
26, mm.
dialess
-&-
hydrostatic
end
force,
kgf =
G2p.
Hn = hydrostatic
end force on area
of flange kgf = x/400 B2P.
inside
between flange
design bolt load and total hydrostatic
end force ), kgf HG = Wm, - H = HP
for operating condition,
HG = W for
gasket seating condition.
compression
HP = total joint-contact-surface
PxbGmp
load, kgf =
100
between
total hydrostatic
HT = difference
end force and the.hvdrostatic
end force
on area inside of flakge, kgf = HHD,
44
t3
+d
x SF,
nf*t,
from Table
4.1
design
stresses
for
flange
temperature
design
at
condition ), kgf/mm* from
pagp;;5
.
& = calculated
.
longitudinal
stress
in hub,
kgf/mm2.
te+
to
SFA
A&,
flanges
flanges
FI
for
FL = factor
Fig. 4.6 ).
mm
c = factor,
flanges
= calculated
mm2.
Sr = calculated
kgf/mm3.
s,
7 = factor
radial
stress in flange,
tangential
involving
stress
( from
kgfl
in flange,
Fig.
4.3 ).
t = flange thickness, mm
*The above definitions are based on the assumption that
the materials for the flange ring and neck are not signiiicandy different in their appropriate mechanical properties.
If they are different, either the lower values should be used or
special consideration given to the design.
IS:m25-1%9
U - factor involving X ( from Fig. 4.3 ).
4.5 Bolt-
V, = factor for
Fig. 4.7 )
loose-type
flanges
( from
4.5.1 .l Opcrcrtingcondition- To retain a leaktight joint under pressure the minimum bolting
required W,,,, shall be given by equation 4.1:
Klr
...
H+H,
(4.1)
HP-
2 x bGmj
1oo
4.5.1.2 Bolting-u&cona%ion
- For gasket seating the minimum bolt load required W,, shall be:
W,=,bGy
...
(4.2)
...
(4.3)
...
(4.4)
go =16mm,;
NOTE - See Table 4.1, Table 4.2 and Fig. 4.2 for
mggecd valuu dm, b andy.
4.5.3
ends )
W = Wmt
sea4.9.
For
mbjcct
Ani+Ab
2
to cxUrnal
x S
preuure
45
LOOSE-TYPE
FLANGES
Loading and dimensions not shown arc same BI shown in Sketch (B)
GASKET
RIVETED
OR SCREWED FLANQE
WITH OR WITHOUT
HUB
GASKET
+,t +x4
tn+6*3mtn. MAX
0*7tn
MIN
w
GASKET
6 OR
(0)
-I
I
Al
p
f
hD
C
HD
(El
(F)
GASKET7 p-t-1
To FLANO~
OR (FZ)
Ih
O=1)
91 J B0 UNIFORM THICKNESS
F2)
MAX
42s~g
b-C OF WELD
BUT NOT
LESS
THAN
64mmn
.-
(G)
FIG. 4.1
CLM~$FIOATION
OF
FLMOU ROR
C~CULATION
hpOSRS
(CIIJlmud)
46
OPTIbNAL-TYPE
FLANGES
6*3mn
LESS THAN.603mm
(HII
(HI
tn
(J)
(H2)
NOTE-Fillet radiur I to be at l&t @25 gl, but not laa than ( +5 mm ). Raked, tongue-6rcovq
male and fanale, and ring joint facinga shall be in cxccn of the required minimum Range thkknas :.
FIG. 4.1
CLASSIFICATION
OF FLANCUUFOR CALCULATIONPURPOSES
J?.tTectivegasket
and-2*5~b,,,whenb.>6-Smm
NW -The gasket factoraliaed only apply to #at@
attWy withintheitma edgeaafthe boltholes.
Fm. 4.2
Ra~cmon
T =
u=
Y =
K*(l+8*55246 log,K)-1
W04720+1~9U6K2)(~-l)
K2(1+6*5524610g,,K)-1
1*36136(K'-l)(K-1)
&
(066845+5*71690*
Kc;
6.0
2.5
13
I _^
I I I I I .._
I I I I I ..^
lIllll~IIllIlIIIJ
^_
.wJ
LU
K+
K=AB
Fro. 4.3
JU
L3
K=$
._
4-o
.-
4.5
__
5-u
IS : 2825- 1969
**lo
O*?O
0*25
0*30
0*35
o-40
o-45
0*50
0*60
o*70
0*60
O-90
PO0
r
0.6
1.25
1.50
Fm. 4.4
VALW
0.6
E
0120
v o-3
O-25
o-30
0.35
0.40
0.45
O-50
^
^
FIG. 4.5
VALIJSS OP Y (
49
r15:2825-1969
'90
8
7
6
--5 ~__...~._..
I--,
r
4
_-L---c?T
I
,_-.i----0.16
~_._
-_. ._ o,,8
I
..__
I
c--- z
i
0.20
0.25
FL
0*30
0.35
0.40
0945
0.50
0.60
0.70
0.80
.
?%
@4<
I.0
1.5
2.0
3.0
4*0
5*0
%Igo
FIG. 4.6
100
8
0.10
O=l?
ioo
20
0.14
O-16
0*18
0920
'!
6
0*25
i
VL
0*30
0*35
0*40
o-45
0*50
O-60
o-70
O-60
8:;
8:';
o-2
01
0.i:
8
KE.
KG
gls:
l*O
1*5
30
3*0
4*0
1950
2*00
5'0
%/eo
IS:28!I5-l%!I
25
z.05
O*lO
20
o-15
0*20
15
0.25
0*30
o-35
o-40
10
9
o-45
o-50
O-60
o-70
5
O-60
0.90
3
l-00
2.5
1.10
2
l-20
1.5
1'30
1*5
/go
91
Fxc.
4.8
TABLE
[ Gasket factors
OF f
VA&U
4.1
GASKET
( HUB
STRESS CORRECTION
MATEKIALS
conditions
AND
FACINGS
CONTACT
and minimum
FACTOR )
design
stress (y ) ]
seating
Nora - This table gives a list of many commonly used gasket materials and contact facings with suggested design
values of m and y that have generally proved satisfactory in actual service when using effective gasket seating width j
given in Table 4.2 and Fig. 4.2. The design values and other detads gtven 111thus table are suggested only and are not
mandatory.
~..
DI~~~NSI~N
N
GASKET
FACIQR
m
GASKET MATERIAL
MINIMWd
DESION
SEATING
ST==%
(Z)
kgf/mm
10
6.50
l-00
i Use Facing
/
Sketch
*Y
2.00
275
3.50
Use
Column
_-
: l(a,4b,jc,d),
--
II
&zd
1.12
260
457
NOTES
0
0.14
.- -Asbestos
with a] 3.2 mm thick
suitable
binder 1 1% mm thick
for the operating )0*8 mm thick
conditions
J
AND
~-
--
__-Y
Rubber without fabric or a high
percentage of asbestos fibre:
Below 70 IRHD*
70 IRHD* or higher
_.__-
SKETCHES
rubbers. * Part
II Hardness;
and
IS
: 638-1965
(
Sheet
continh~)
51
Is: 2825-1969
TABLE
4.1
GASKET
MATERIALS
AND CONTACT
FACINGS -
Contd
[Gasket factors (m) for operating conditions and minimum design seating stress (y) ]
NOTE - This table gives a list of many commonly used gasket materials and contact facings with suggested design
values of m andy that have generally proved satisfactory in actual service when using effective gasket seating width 6
given in Table 4.2 and Fig. 4.2. The design values and other details given in this table are suggested only and are not
mandatory.
DIMENSION
Jv
(Mill)
GASKET
GMICETMATERIN.
FACXOR
m
mm.
MINIMUM
DESIGN
SJZATINQ
&Zl~
fabric
1.25
0.28
asbestos [B-ply
Rubber
with
fabric insertion, with ,or 2-ply
without wire reinforce- l-Ply
ment
225
250
275
1.55
204
268
Vegetable fibre
175
877
Rubber
with
insertion
cotton
1( a,4b,5c,
d ),
,
204
3.16
10
Soft aluminium
S;F;opper
or
Corrugated metal,
asbestos
inserted
;:%i
;:it
3-00
316
325
387
350
457
Soft aluminium
S;r=zopper
or
275
388
268
316
Iron
or
soft
steel
Monel metal or
percent
4-6
chrome
steel
Stainless steel
325
387
3.50
457
375
534
3.25
3.50
387
457
3.75
534
350
5.62
Iron
or soft
steel
Monel metal or
percent
46
chrome steel
Stainless steels
metal,
jacketed
asbestos filled
Corrug~ed
--
Corrugated
metal
1 (a, b)
II
--
1 ( a, b, c, d 1
-_
Soft aluminium
Soft copper or
brass
Iron
or
soft
steel
Monel
metal
or 46 percent
chrome
steel
Stainless steels
Flat
met a 1
jacketed
asbestos filled
3.75
-I
633
*The surface of a gasket having a lap should not be against the nubbin.
52
Use
Column
IS : 2825 - 1969
TABLE 4.1
[Gasket
GASKET
AND CONTACT
MATERIALS
FACINGS -
Confd
factors (m) for operating conditions and minimum design seating stress (y) ]
NOTE - This table gives a list of many commonly used gasket materials and contact facings with suggested design
values of tn andy that have generally proved satisfactory in actual service when using effective gasket seating with b
given in Table 4.2 and Fig. 4.2. The de&n values and other details given in this table are suggested only and are not
mandatory.
--_
DnreNs10~
N
(Mitt)
GASKET ~~ATERLAL
GASKET
FMTOR
m
I
MINIMUH
DESIGN
SEATING
ST=%J ,
kgf/mm I
_-
SKETCHES
REFER M
TABLE 4.2
N%~s
Use Facing
Sketch
-_
Use
Column
-r
10
Grooved meta!
Soft aluminium
S;Fa;pper
or
3.25
3.50
3.87
4.57
Iron
or
soft
steel
Monel metal or
4-6
percent
chrome steel
Stainless steels
3.75
5.34
3.75
6.33
4.25
7.10
1 ( a, b, c, d 1,
II
l(a,b,c,d),
2, 3
_..
Soft aluminium
Sdft copper or
brass
or soft
Iron
steel
Monel metal or
4-6
percent
chrome steel
Stainless steels
400
475
6.19
9.14
5.50
12.66
6.00
15.33
6.50
l&28
2, 334, 5
__
Ring joint
Iron
or
soft
steel
Monel metal or
percent
4-6
chrome
steel
Stainless steels
5.50
1266
6.00
15.33
6.50
l&28
_-
Rubber O-rings :
Below 75 ItiD*
Between 75 and 85 IRHD*
0.07
@I5
_-
__
8 only
II
S:.<.\.
--
@IO
0.211
Q
+:
..
67
7 only
:::J
..
0.10
0.28
_-
9 only
@
li..
4.6.1
Operating
Condition - The
total flange
moment is given by equation 4.5,
... (4.5)
MOP = HD~~D + HT~T + H&c
where HD = =$$$f
HT=H-HD
HG z-H,and hD, hx and hc are obtained from Table 4.3.
53
TABLE
4.2 EFFEGTIVE
GASKET
WIDTH
BASIC
GASKET
&%~INOWIDTH be
FACINOSKETCH
( ExaooERATED )
la
N
2
lb+
lc
w+25T
2
Id*
w+N
4
Mary
,
w+25T
2
4
W-4-3N
w+N
b--d-N
3
+;
(+
Min)
w+N
4
;
(
-y
Min
NUB&N
4.
3N
.v
6
7N
-ii-
54
1s : 2825- 1969
TABLE 4.2
GASKET
EFFECT
WIDTH -
Chid
Bmc GASKKTSEATINQ
WIDTH b.
FACING SRBTCH
( EXAOQERATED)
5+
-3N
8
6
-+iWi--
IT///////*/,,
8
N
2
,,,x,,,
TABLE 4.3
Type of Flange
hD
R + 0.5 81
C-B
2
6-r
h,
C-G
2
+ hc
2
C-G
2
R+gl+h,
iP
Lap joint langes
---
( JM Fig. 4.1A )
C-B
C-G
C-G
I
55
IS : 2825 - 1969
4.6.2 Bolting-Up
Conditian -The
moment is given by equation 4.6:
Matm =
where
W -
total
flange
. . . (4.6)
Whc
and hc = --
or MO = -
Matm
SFA
4.7.1
flanges:
For
integral-type
Longitudinal
Radial
whichever
flanges
and
flange
stress
is larger.
tively.
The shearing srress shall
the basis of HP or W,, as defined
is greater.
Similar cases where
subjected to shearing stress shall
the same requirements.
4.9 Flanges Subject to External Pressure The design of flanges for external pressure only
shall be based on the equations given in 4.7 for
internal pressure except that for operating conditions:
A&o, = HD(hD-hhc)+HT(hT-hc)...(4.11)
for gasket seating Matm = WhG
in the above equations
( 1*333te _1- 1
Sa = __
+
2
. ..(4.12)
Ab x
H = x/400 G2pB
pe = external design pressure, kgf/cm2.
)M
At2
. . . (4.8)
Tangential
W =
&,
HD = x/400 B2pe
HT=H-HD
hub-type
. . . (4.7)
be calculated on
in 4.4 whichever
flange parts are
be governed by
where M = A*
5.
For loose-type
ring flanges ( including
optional
type calculated
as loose ring type )
having a rectangular cross section:
4.7.2
S T =yM
..*
ta
s, = s, =
MO CF
where M = --_B
4.8 Allowable
4.9.1
above,
Flange Stresses
l/2
(SH
SR =
SF0
ST =
SF,
t SR)
l/2(sH+sT)
=sFO
=sFO
4.8.2
56
PRESSURE
RELIEVING
DEVICES
5.1 General
5.1.1 Every pressure vessel covered by this
code shall be provided with, a pressure relieving
device in accordance with the provisions of this
section, except where otherwise provided for as
in 5.1.1.1.
5.1.1.1 When the source of the pressure. is
external to the vessel and under such positive
control that the pressure in the vessel cannot
exceed the maximum working pressure for the
vessel at the operating temperature,
a pressure
relief device need not be directly provided on the
vessel.
5.1.2 Vessels that are to operate completely
filled with the liquid shall be equipped with a
liquid reliefvalve unless otherwise protected against
over-pressure.
5.1.3 When a vessel is fitted with a heating coil
or element whose failure might increase the normal
pressure in the vessel, the designed relieving capacity of the protective device shall be adequate to
prevent this increase.
5.1.4 Vessels intended to operate under vacuum
conditions, unless designed for full vacuum, shall
be provided with a vacuum break relief device.
5.1.5 Vessels intended for internal pressure, but
which are likely to be subjected to partial vacuum,
say, due to the cooling ofcontents, shall be provided
with a combined pressure-vacuum
relief device
unless the vessel is designed for full vacuum.
TABLEI.
l-
la01
::Ez
l-91
1.91
1000.50
::z
:tf
l-91
-
::z
l-008
:I.
l-91
::E!
1.91
-.-.*1
I1
::8y
i-9:
l-91
l-91
::x
::z
%
fflcl~
a*.
l-020
::g
g::
250%
200-50
16717
143%
125-50
111.61
100-50
1899.43 207885
951.81 1052.80
637.56
700-80
478-04
525.45
383.67
42 l-72
319-71
174.11
239-95
213.40
192.19
351.42
301.30
263-75
23442
211.19
174.83
!92!3
VALUES OF r,Z,
YAND U(TJUUW6INVOLVINGK)
Ii-
l-061
1.062
I.063
l-064
l-065
1.89
l-89
1.89
l-89
1<89
16.91
16-64
1640
16.15
1590
32.55
32.04
31.55
31.08
30-61
35.78
3521
34.68
34-17
33.65
l-121
l-122
I.123
1.124
1.125
1.87
1.87
I.87
l-87
1.87
8-79
8.72
8%
8.59
853
1790
16.87
16-74
1662
16.49
1868
16.54
,&40
18.26
l&11
l-066
l-067
l-068
1.89
l-89
1.89
15.67
15-45
::z
:P;;
14.80
33.17
32.69
32.22
31.79
31.34
I.126
I.127
I.128
l-129
l-130
l-117
GE
30-17
29-74
2932
28.91
28.51
l-87
1.87
l-87
1.87
8.47
8.40
8-34
8-28
8.22
16.37
l&25
16-14
16.02
15.91
::*z*
17-73
17-60
17.48
I.111
a I.#.
3@11
2972
2934
l-132
l-133
I.134
l-135
!*8?
1.87
1.86
1.86
1.86
&!6
8-11
805
7-99
7.94
1
~.-I(1
1d
,.a
15.68
15-57
!7-35
17.24
17-11
15.36
154.6
:t: .
15.26
1515
15.05
14.95
14.86
1677
16.65
16.54
16-43
16-35
14-66
1476
:t::*
1448
1457
14-39
:t::*
1583
t%
71.93
67.17
-160.38
148%
137-69
128-61
176.25
162.81
151.30
141.33
,.n,,
1 IS
1.072
l-073
l-074
1.075
!*89
1.89
1.89
l-88
1.88
!+6!
14-41
14-22
14tM
13-85
120.56
111.98
107.36
101.72
96-73
13249
12481
118.00
111-78
106.30
l-076
l-077
1.078
1.079
la80
1.88
1.88
1.88
1.86
l-88
13-68
13.56
13-35
13-18
13.02
26.36
-.
_.
f-2
_*__
1.90
6500
59.33
56%
53-14
50.51
26-03
25.72
25.40
25.10
28.98
28.69
__
__
28-27
27.92
27.59
1.136
1.137
l-138
1.139
1.140
l-86
1.86
1.86
1.86
1.86
7.88
7.83
7.78
7-73
7.68
I-021
1.022
;:g
48.12
4596
1-o23
:%f
:z
l-90
*
:E
40.51
1.081
1.082
1.083
1.084
l-085
l-88
l-88
l-88
1.88
1.88
12.87
12.72
12.57
12.43
12.29
24-81
24-52
24.24
24m
2369
27.27
26.95
26.65
2634
2605,
l-141
1.142
1.143
1.144
i.145
l-86
1.86
l-86
1.86
1.86
7.62
7-57
7.53
748
7.43
:%
l-028
la90
::g
2344
:%I;
23.18
11-89
22.93
tzt
::g
1.146
1.147
1.148
1.149
1.150
l-86
1.86
1.86
1.86
1:86
7.38
7.34
7-29
7-25
7-20
1429
1420
1412
1403
13.95
l!Y71
15-61
15-51
15.4s
15.34
1.031
1.032
190
1.90
1*o33
FE
:z
190
*
l-036
I.037
l-038
l-039
:_Ogj
1.90
1.90
1.90
l-90
!*90
la1
1.90
9:-e:
3897
37.54
36-22
3499
33-84
74-70
71.97
69-43
67.11
64.91
KEz
.
76-30
7375
71.33
32.76
31.76
30-81
2992
29-08
62.85
60-92
59-11
57.41
55-80
69-06
6694
63-95
63.08
61.32
5429
52-85
51.50
50-21
43.97
5966
58.08
56.59
55.17
53.82
47.81
28.13
27.76
27-39
27.04
26-69
11.76
1 l-63
22.68
2244
2557
2948
25.20
24-93
2466
Il.52
:%I
1140
l-88
2441
2416
23.91
23-67
2344
l-151
1:152
l-153
1.154
1.155
1.86
1.86
1.86
1.86
l-86
7.16
7.11
7,07
7.03
6.99
13.86
13-77
13.69
13.61
13-54
152?
15-14
15.05
23.20
l-86
l-86
l-86
1.86
I.66
6.95
6-91
6.87
6.83
6.79
13.45
13.37
13.30
13.22
;3.;5
14-78
14-70
1461
1453
14.43
1.88
1.88
::%
11.05
22.22
21-99
21.76
21.54
21.32
yl9;
yg
1.098
1.099
!*!OO
1.88
pfl
I.
10.94
1083
10-73
1062
!@52
21.11
2091
20.71
20-51
20.31
EZ
22.39
22*!8
1.156
1.157
1.158
1.159
!.I60
l-101
1.102
1.103
1.104
1.105
1.88
1.88
1.88
1.88
l-88
10.43
10.33
10-23
10.14
1005
20.15
1994
1976
19.58
1938
22.12
21.92
21.72
21.52
21.30
1.161
l-162
1.163
1.164
1.165
1.85
l-85
l-85
1.85
1.85
6.75
6-71
6.67
6-64
6.60
13.07
13al
12.92
12.85
12.78
14-36
14-28
14-20
14-12
14-04
19.33
1907
18.90
18.74
18.55
21.14
2096
20.77
20.59
20.38
1.166
1.167
1.168
1.169
1.170
l-85
1.85
1.85
1.85
1.85
6.56
6.53
6.49
6.46
6.42
12.71
!2*64
12.58
12.51
12.43
13.97
! 3.69
13.82
13.74
13.66
::i;:
1.093
l-094
1.095
KE*
lTM2
1.043
l-044
l-045
:z*
1.90
1.90
2490
24-32
23.77
2323
22-74
f:E
_ __.
1.048
:1a49
I.050
l-90
190
1.90
1.90
l-89
2205
21.79
21.35
20.92
20.51
42.75
41.67
41.02
40-21
39.43
46.99
46.03
45.09
44.21
43.34
l-106
1.107
y;
1.88
1.87
yE$
I.110
l-87
996
987
9.78
970
9-62
1.051
:::z
1.054
i-055
1.89
l-89
1.89
l-89
1.89
20.12
19-74
1938
1903
18.69
38.68
37.96
37.27
36.60
3596
42.51
41.73
40.96
4023
3964
1.111
l-112
l-113
1.114
1.115
1.87
l-87
1.87
1.87
l-87
9.54
9-46
938
9.30
9.22
18.42
18.27
18.13
17.97
17.81
2025
2008
19-91
19-75
1955
1.171
1.172
1.173
1.174
1.175
1.85
1.85
1.85
1.85
l-85
6.39
6.35
6.32
6-29
6.25
12.38
12.31
12.25
12.18
12.10
13.60
13.53
1346
13.39
13.30
l-056
1.057
l-058
1.059
la60
1.89
l-89
l-89
1.89
1.89
18.38
18.06
17.76
17-47
17-18
35.34
3474
34-17
38.84
38.19
37.56
3634
36-95
l-116
1. s 7
1.11
l-119
l-120
1.87
4.87
1.87
I.87
l-87
9-15
9.07
900
8.94
8.86
17.68
17.54
17.40
17.27
17.13
1943
1927
19.12
18.98
18.80
1.176
1.177
1.178
1.179
1.180
1.85
1.85
1.85
l-85
1.85
622
6.19
6-16
6-13
6.10
12.06
12.00
11.93
Il.87
1 l-79
13.25
13.18
13.11
13.05
12.96
2:;:
M64
4369
55%
5015
49.05
4802
( Continued
57
IS : 2825- 1969
TABLE
4.4
VALUES
OF Z, Z, Y AND
V ( TERMS INVOLVING
K ) -
Confd
1.85
1.85
1.85
1.85
1.85
6-07
6.04
@Ol
5.98
5.95
1 l-76
11.70
11.64
11.58
11.50
12.92
12.86
12.79
12.73
12.64
5.92
589
11.47
12.61
I.188
1.189
1.190
1.85
l-85
l-85
1.85
1.84
11.42
11.36
11.31
11.26
:zi .
12.43
12.37
I.191
l-192
1.193
1.194
I.195
1.84
1.84
1.84
1.84
1.84
5.78
5-75
573
5.70
5.67
11.20
11.15
12.31
12.25
11.10
11.05
ll+O
KS*
12.08
l-196
1.84
t:fz
1.199
l-200
1.84
1.84
1.84
I@95
10-90
IO-85
1080
1075
12.03
11.97
11.92
11.87
11.81
l-201
1.202
I.203
1.84
1.84
1.84
5.52
550
547
1070
EE:
:%i
1.84
:E
:11.56
t*it
*
1.206
l-207
I.208
1.209
1.210
l-84
1.84
l-84
1.84
1.84
1.211
1.212
1.213
1.214
1.215
1.83
1.83
1.83
1.83
1.83
529
5.27
5-24
522
5.20
1.216
1.217
1.218
l-219
1.220
1.83
l-83
1.83
1.83
l-83
518
5.16
K
1.181
1.182
1,183
1.184
1.185
f:E
%
581
X:2:11.51
11.46
Il.41
t
10.38
.
c:
5;;
l-
1.241
1.242
l-243
1.244
1.245
1.82
1.82
1.82
1.82
1.82
470
4.69
4-67
465
4-64
912
908
905
9.02
8.99
1002
9-98
995
991
987
1.301
l-302
l-303
1.304
1.305
1.80
1.80
l-80
l-80
1.80
3.89
I.246
1.247
1.248
y;;
1.82
1.82
1.82
;;3
4-62
460
459
4.57
456
895
8.92
8.89
8.86
8.83
984
9.81
9.77
974
970
1.306
1.307
1.308
1.309
l-310
l-251
1.252
1.253
l-254
l-255
1.82
1.82
1.82
1.82
1.82
4-54
452
4.51
449
448
8.80
8.77
8.74
8.71
8.68
9.67
9.64
960
9.57
9-54
f;;;
p3t3
1.81
1.81
1.81
8.65
8.62
8.59
8.56
8.53
951
947
1.258
l-259
l-260
4.46
4-45
443
442
440
tz
938
l-261
;a;
1.81
p;
8-51
8.49
8.45
8.42
8.39
935
932
9-28
9.25
923
919
9-16
914
9-11
9.08
l-264
l-265
1.81
1.81
4.39
4-37
4-36
4-35
433
1.266
1.267
1.268
I.269
l-270
1.81
1.81
1.81
1.81
l-81
432
430
4.29
4.28
4.26
8.37
8-34
8-31
8-29
8.26
823
8.21
8.18
8-15
a.13
;:2
3.84
7.44
1.80
1.80
1.79
l-79
1.79
3.83
3-82
3.81
3.80
3.79
7.42
7-40
1.311
1.312
l-313
1.314
1.3r5
1.79
l-79
1.79
1.79
1.79
3.78
3.77
3-76
3.75
3-74
7.32
7-30
7-28
7.26
7.24
1.316
1.317
1.318
l-319
1.320
1.79
1.79
1.79
1.79
l-79
E
3.71
3.70
3.69
7-22
7.20
7-18
7.16
7.14
;*;a;
f;;
I.323
p;
l-79
y;
I.326
1.327
1.328
p;
l-79
1.79
l-78
;;;
3.64
3.63
3.62
3.61
3.60
1.331
1.332
1.333
1.334
1.335
1.78
1.78
I-78
1.78
1.78
3.59
3.58
3-57
3-57
3.56
:z
7.34
7-12
7.10
::t
7.05
:z:
11.22
11.27
1.271
y;
1.81
yg
I?s
lo-09
:t:::
11.09
1*2i4
1.275
1.81
1.81
425
424
422
4-21
4.20
tX:E
9:::
11.03
10-99
1094
10.90
10-87
1.276
1.277
1.278
l-279
1.280
1.81.
1.81
1.81
l-81
1.81
418
4.17
416
4.15
4-13
8.11
8.08
8.05
803
8-01
8.91
8.88
8.85
882
8.79
1.336
1.337
1.338
l-339
l-340
1.78
1.78
I.78
l-78
1.78
3.55
3.54
353
3-52
3.51
1081
IO-77
1.281
1.282
1.81
1.81
Ki.
10-65
z::
1.285
zi
l-80
E
4.10
408
4.07
7.98
7.96
7-93
7.91
7.89
8.77
8.74
8.71
8.69
8.66
l-341
1.342
1.343
1.344
1.345
1.78
1.78
1.78
1.78
1.78
9.51
3.50
3.49
7.86
7.84
7-81
7-79
7-77
8.64
8.61
8.59
8.56
8.53
1.346
l-347
1.348
1.349
1.350
1.78
l-78
1.78
1.78
1.78
8.51
1.78
1.78
1.77
1.77
1.77
3-42
3-42
3.41
;z
t:zi
6-55
l-77
l-77
1.77
1.77
1.77
3.38
3.38
3.37
3.36
3.35
6-53
6.52
6-50
6-49
6-47
989
5.07
505
5.03
5.01
5m
9.84
1.226
1.227
1 1.228
1.229
l-230
K*
1.83
1.83
1.83
t :;i
4-94
4.92
4-90
t:::
957
9-53
950
lo-60
1056
1052
1048
1044
1.286
l-287
1.288
l-289
l-290
l-80
1.80
1.80
1.80
1.80
1.231
I.232
1.83
l-83
1.233
I.234
1,235
%.
1.83
4-88
4-86
4-84
4.83
4.81
9-46
9-43
9.39
1040
10-36
10.32
%;
10.24
10.28
l-291
1.292
1.293
1.294
l-295
1.80
1.80
1.80
1.80
1.80
4.00
3.99
3.98
397
3.95
7.75
7.72
7.70
7.68
7.66
8.43
8.41
1.351
l-352
l-353
1.354
l-355
1.236
1.237
1.238
1.82
1.82
I.82
479
477
4-76
4.74
4-72
929
9-25
9.22
9-18
915
1020
10.17
10.13
1009
10-05
1.296
l-297
1.298
1.299
1,300
1.80
1.80
l-80
1.80
1.80
3-94
3.93
3.92
3.91
3-90
7.63
7.61
7-59
7.57
7-55
8.39
836
8.33
8.31
8-29
l-356
1.357
l-358
l-359
1.360
z
9.72
9-69
;:;
s::
::g
2
7.87
7.85
3::
7.79
7.77
7-75
:::3
5.10
8-05
8-02
&a0
7.73
7-71
7.69
t::::
l-83
l-83
1.83
1.83
1.83
58
3-68
3.67
3-67
3.66
3.65
753
7-50
fi
1.221
1.222
1.223
1.224
1.225
Ii
6-89
6-87
7-63
7-61
7.59
7.57
7-55
6.77
6-76
6.74
6.72
6.71
77:z
7.41
7.39
7.37
7.35
7-53
7.32
7.30
7.28
6.61
6-60
IS:2%25-1969
TABLE
1.361
1.362
1.363
1.364
1.365
1.77
1.77
1.77
1.77
1.77
::E
l-3@
1.77
,1*77
4.4
VALUES
1.421
1.422
lr423
1.424
l-425
1.75
1.75
1.75
1.74
1.74
2.96
2.96
2.95
2.95
2.94
5.69
5.68
5.67
5.66
5.65
7.01
7.00
6.98
6.97
S.95
1.426
1.427
1.428
1.429
1.430
l-74
l-74
1.74
1.74
1.74
;:iz
2.92
2.92
2.91
;7;
6.93
6.91
6.90
6.89
6.87
1,431
1.432
1.433
1.434
1.435
1.74
l-74
1.74
1.74
1.74
3.35
334
3-33
3-32
3-32
6-45
:z
6.41
639
7.09
7.08
7.06
7.04
7.03
3.31
330
330
3-29
3.28
6.38
637
6-35
6.34
632
K) -
Confd
l-
&26
625
6-23
6.22
621
1.481
1.482
1-483
1.484
l-485
1.72
1.7%
1.72
1.72
1.72
2.68
2.67
2.67
2.66
2.66
5.11
5.10
5.10
5.09
5.08
5.60
5.59
5.59
5.58
5.57
5.60
6-20
6.19
6.17
6.16
6.15
1486
1487
1.488
1489
1.490
1.72
1.72
1.72
1.72
l-72
2.66
2.65
2.65
2.64
2.64
5.07
5.06
5.06
5.05
5.04
5.56
5.55
5.55
5.54
5.53
2.91
2.90
2.90
2.89
2.89
5.59
5.58
5.57
5.56
5.55
6.14
6.13
6.11
6.10
6.09
1.491
1.492
1.493
1.494
1.495
1.72
1.72
1.71
1.71
1.71
2.64
2.63
2.63
2.62
2~62
5.03
5.02
5a
5.01
5w
5.52
5.51
5.51
5.50
5.49
5.54
5.53
552
5.51
5.50
6.08
6.07
6.05
6-04
6.03
1.496
1.497
1.498
1.499
1.500
1.71
1.71
1.71
1.71
1.71
2.62
2.61
2.61
2.60
2.60
4.99
4.98
4.98
4.97
4.96
5.48
5.47
5.47
5.46
5.45
5.64
f%
1.77
1.371
1.372
1.373
1.334
1.375
lt77
1.77
1.77
1.77
1.77
3.27
3.27
3.26
;::i:
6.31
6-30
6.28
6.27
6.25
I.376
1.377
1.378
1.379
1.380
1.77
1.77
1.76
1.76
1.76
3.24
3.23
3.22
3.22
3.21
6.24
6.22
621
6.19
6.18
6.86
6.84
6.82
6.81
6.80
1.436
1.437
;*:a;
1.74
1.74
;;:
1440
1,74
2.88
2.88
2.87
2.87
2.86
1.381
1.382
1.383
1.384
1.385
1.76
1.76
1.76
1.76
1.76
E
3.19
3.18
3.18
6-15
6.16
6.14
6.13
612
6.79
6.77
6-75
674
6.73
1.441
1.442
1443
1444
1.445
1.74
l-74
1.74
1.74
1.74
2.86
2.85
2.85
2.84
2.84
5.49
5.48
5.47
5.46
5.45
6.02
6.01
6.00
5.99
5.98
1.501
1.502
1.503
1.504
1.505
1.71
1.71
1.71
1.71
1.71
2.60
2.59
2.59
2.58
2.58
4.95
494
4.94
4.93
4.92
5.44
5.43
5.43
5.42
5.41
1.386
1.387
1.388
1.389
1.390
1.76
1.76
1.76
1.76
1.76
3.17
3-16
3.16
3.15
3-15
6.11
6.10
6-08
6.07
6.06
6.72
6.70
6.68
6.67
6.66
1446
1447
1448
1449
1.450
1.74
1.73
l-73
1.73
1.73
2.83
2.83
2.82
2.82
2.81
%z
5.42
541
5.40
5.97
5.96
5.95
594
5.93
1.506
l-507
1.508
1.509
1.510
1.71
1.71
1.71
1.71
1.71
2.58
2.57
2.57
2.57
2.56
4.91
4.90
490
4.89
488
5.40
5.39
5.39
5.38
5.37
l-391
1.392
l-393
1.394
1.395
1.76
1.76
1.76
l-76
1.76
605
6.04
602
6.01
6-00
664
663
6.61
6.60
659
1.451
1.452
1.453
1.454
l-455
l-73
l-73
1.73
1.73
1.73
2.81
2.80
2.80
2.80
2.79
5.39
538
5-37
5.36
5.35
5-92
5.91
z:g
588
i.511
1.512
l-513
1.514
1.515
1.71
1.71
1.71
1.71
1.71
2.56
2.56
2.55
2.55
2.54
487
486
4.86
485
4.84
5.36
5.35
5.35
5.34
5.33
1.396
1.397
1.398
l-399
1400
l-76
1.76
1.75
1.75
l-75
5-99
5-98
5.96
5-95
5.94
6.58
656
635
6.53
6.52
f;;;
y;
1.458
1.459
1.460
l-73
l-73
l-73
2.79
2.78
2.78
2.77
2.77
Z:E
532
5-31
5.30
5.87
5.86
585
$84
5-83
1.516
1.517
1.518
1.519
1.520
1.71
l-71
1.71
1.70
1.70
2.54
2.54
2.53
2.53
2.53
4.83
4.82
4.82
4.81
480
5.32
5.31
5.31
5.30
5.29
1401
1402
l-403
1.404
1405
1.75
1.75
1.75
1.75
1.75
6.50
6-49
6.47
6.46
6.45
1.461
1462
t-g;
1.73
1.73
f;:
1465
1.73
2.76
2.76
2.75
2.75
2.74
5.29
5.28
5.27
5.26
5.25
5.82
5.80
5.79
5.78
5-77
1.521
1.522
1.523
1.524
1.525
1.70
1.70
1.70
1.70
1.70
2.52
2.52
2.52
2.51
2.51
4.79
479
4.78
478
477
5.28
5.27
5.27
5.26
5.25
1.406
1.407
1408
1-75
1.75
1.75
1.75
5.87
586
5.84
583
582
f:G
6.41
640
6.39
t:z
1.468
1.469
1.470
::::
1.72
1.72
1.72
2.74
2.74
2-73
2.73
2.72
5.24
5-23
5.22
5.21
5.20
576
5.74
5.73
5.72
5.71
1.526
1.527
1.528
1.529
1.530
1.70
1.70
1.70
1.70
1.70
2.51
2.50
2.50
2.49
2.49
477
4.76
476
4.75
4.74
5.24
5.23
5.23
5.22
5.21
1.411
l-412
1.413
1.414
1.415
1*75
1.75
1.75
1.75
1.75
581
5-80
5-78
5-77
576
638
637
6.35
6.34
6.33
l-471
l-472
1.473
1.474
l-475
1.72
l-72
1.72
1.72
1.72
2.72
2.71
2.71
2.71
2.70
5-19
518
5.18
5.17
5-16
5.70
969
5.68
567
5.66
1.531
1.532
1.533
1.534
1.535
1.70
l-70
1.70
1.70
1.70
2.49
2.48
248
2.48
2.47
473
472
4.72
4-71
4-70
5.20
5-19
5.19
517
5-17
;a;
y:
5.75
5-74
5.72
6-32
6.31
629
6-28
6.27
1.476
i.477
1.478
1.479
1480
1.72
1.72
l-72
1.72
1.72
2.70
2.69
269
2.68
2.68
915
914
5-14
213
5.12
565
1.536
l-537
1.538
1.539
l-540
l-70
1.70
1.69
1.69
1.69
2.47
2.47
2.46
469
468
4-68
467
4.66
5.16
5.15
5.15
5.14
5.13
1.418
l-419
l-420
1.75
l-75
l-75
3-05
::Ez
303
3.02
5E
:::
5-62
5-61
( Confind
IS : 2825- 1969
VALUES
TABLE 4.4
K
1.541
1.542
1.543
1.544
1.545
169
1.69
1.69
1.69
1.69
2.45
2.45
2.45
2.45
244
1.546
1.547
1.548
I.549
1.550
1.69
1.69
1.69
1.69
1.69
1.551
1.552
1.553
1.554
1.555
1.69
1.69
1.69
1.69
1.69
::z
455
454
5.02
501
5.00
499.
499
1.571
1.572
1.573
1.574
1.575
1.68
1.68
1.68
1.68
1.68
2.36
236
2.36
2.35
235
2.38
454
4.53
452
4.51
451
498
497
497
4.96
495
1.576
1.577
1.578
1.579
1.580
1.68
1.68
1.68
1.68
1.68
2.35
2.35
2.34
2.34
2.34
2.38
2.37
2.37
2.37
2.37
450
450
449
448
448
495
494
493
492
492
ym&
y;
2.41
457
l.558
1.559
1.560
1:69
1.69
1.69
464
4.63
512
511
5.11
5.10
5.09
;:;
2.44
244
2.43
2.43
2.43
463
462
4.62
461
460
5.08
507
507
5.06
505
1.561
1.562
;;%i
1.69
1.69
;;tx$
2.39
2.39
2.38
2.39
1.565
1.68
2.42
242
2.42
2.41
2.41
460
459
505
584
503
5.03
5.02
i-z%;
1.568
1.569
1.570
;*6$
1.68
1.68
1.68
::::
457
ALLOWABLE
STRESSES
DIAMETER
(mm)
MATERIAL
FOR FLANGE
K) _ anid
2:::
464
INVOLVING
(I
TABLE 4.5
OF
BOLTING
MATERIAL
447
447
446
446
445
491
491
490
489
489
$2
::z
487
486
486
443
442
442
kgf/ansy$
__--
ALLOWABLESTRESSkgf/mm* FORDESIGN
METAL TEMPERATURE
NOT EXCEEDING( OC )
S~GCIFIED
.TENSILE
300
350
408
--up to 150
44-52
1 5.87
--1:/o Cr MO steel
Up to 63.5
86 Min
1968
18.5
17.1
162
16.66
15.47
1476
5% Cr MO steel
1% Cr Mo V steel
13% Cr Ni steel
18/8 Cr Ni steel
17.79
71 Min
66 Min
1 Up to 63.5
86 Min
82 Min
71 Min
117.93~1645(1434~13*64
up to 102
17/10/2f Cr Ni MO steel
18 Cr 2 Ni steel
79 Min
up to 102
I
55Miain
softened conditionorupto88
Min if cold
drawn
11.53
--13.18
86Min
1819
9.4s
-11.53
j 1318) ll*IsI
I
I
13.18
1819
9.561
9.4s
88ti
15.541 14.69j
12.94
NOTE1 -
Austenitic steel bolts for use in pressure joints shall not be less than 10 mm diameter.
Nuns2 - For bolts up to 38 mm diameter torque spanners or other means of preventing the application of excessive stress
during tightening are necessary.
NATE3 - High strengths are obtainable in bolting materials by heat treatment of the ferritic and martensitic steels and
by cold working of amtenitic steels. These should not, however, be usedfor bolting with tensile strengths greater than 110 kgf/mm*
fm~~~a;mr~ martensitic ) or 100 kgf/ mm* ( austenitic ) unless special agreement is reached between the purchaser and the
Nom
60
4-
Other
suitable materials may be used for bolting by agreement between the purchaser and the manufacturer.
IS I 2825 - 1969
5.2 Design
5.2.1 The protective device used shall be suitand shall be
able for the conditions of service
adequate for duty.
5.2.1.1 In general, relief valves are preferred
for vessel protection but bursting discs or a combination of relief valves and bursting discs may be
preferable in certain circumstances ( see 5.2.3.1 ).
5.2.2 Relief Valves
5.2.2.1.,Spring
loaded relief valves are preferred but other types like valves fitted with a
weight or with lever and weight loading are
acceptable, provided that they are equally safe.
5.2.2.2 Pilot valve control or other indirect
operation of relief valves is not permitted unless
the design is such that the main valve will open
automatically
at the set pressure and discharge to
the full capacity, should the pilot or auxiliary device
fail.
5.2.2.3 The relief valves shall be so designed
that they cannot be inadvertently
loaded beyond
the set pressure.
5.2.2.4 The design of valves shall be such that
breakage of any part will not obstruct the free
and full discharge of the fluid under pressure.
5.2.3 Bursting Discs
5.213.1 The use of a bursting disc as a pressure
relieving device is preferred:
a) where pressure rise may be so rapid as to
be analogous to combustion or explosion,
so that the inertia of a relief valve would be
a disadvantage;
b) where service conditions may involve heavy
deposits or gumming
up, such as would
render a re!ief valve inoperative; and
c) where even minute
be tolerated.
Manufacturers
identification,
Nominal inlet and outlet sizes,
Design pressure and temperature, and
Certified capacity in kilograms of saturated
steam per hour or in the case of liquid
relief certified capacity in litres of water per
minute.
b) Size
cl Bursting pressure
4 Coincident disc temperature,
e) Capacity at discharge
Unless the size
case the disc
envelope prior
shall be clearly
and
CKAp
$(
where
W = rated
capacity in kg/h,
= a constant for gas or vapour which
is a function of the ratio of specific
heats, y ( see Table 5.1 ),
heat at constant pressure,
CP = specific
C, = specific heat at constant volume,
A I= actual discharge arti in nuns,
fi = accumulation
pressure ( l-10 x
set pressure ) kgf/cm* abs,
c
61
112825-1969
hf = molecular weight,
I r= inlet temperature in degree Kelvin,
and
which
K = coefficient of discharge
depends on the shape of the inlet
and of the disc and lift characteristics of the valve and is specific to
any particular relief valve.
TABLE 5.1 CONSTANT
RELATED TO RATIO
(1)
(2)
(1)
(2)
(1)
(2)
190
234
1.26
2.55
1.52
2.72
1.02
2.37
1.28
2.57
l-54
2.74
l-04
2-38
l-30
2.58
1%
2.75
1.32
2.60
1.58
2.76
2.77
l-06
2.40
l-08
2.42
1.3:
2.61
l-60
l-10
2.44
I.36
2.63
1.62
278
1.12
245
1.38
2.64
l-64
2-80
l-14
2-46
1.40
2-65
I.66
2.81
l-16
2.48
l-42
2.66
l-68
2.82
1.18
2.50
I.44
2.67
I-. J
2.83
l-20
251
1.46
2.68
2.00
298
1.22
2.52
1.48
270
2.20
3.07
l-24
2-54
l-50
2.71
5.43 LiquidRelkf- Assumingthat no vaporization occurs and that the flow through the relief
valve is dependent only on the pressure drcip and
the theoretical area, the general equation for
liquid flow may be written as:
Q=8N4xlO-KA
2/-
;orW=50.42KAfiP
where
Q = flow in cubic metre per minute,
W x flow in kg per hour,
p = pressure drop in kgf/cms,
P = ape&c gravity at inlet temperature,
A = actual discharge area in mm*,
and
K = overall coefficient of discharge
specific to any particular relief
valve.
5~PreMsresetdngofaPresmureRelitving
Device
Lines
62
SECTION
6.
7.
II
FABRICATION
MANUFACTUREAND
ANb
WELDING
WORKMANSHIP
...
65
. ..
65
..
65
6.1
Approval of Design
6.2
Welded Joints,
6.3
...
65
6.4
Preparation
...
67
6.5
...
71
6.6
Alignment
. .
71
...
72
..
74
...
74
General Considerations
of Parent Metal
and Tolerances
6.7
Welding Procedure
6.8
Welding of Non-ferrous
6.9
Rectification
6.10
...
75
6.11
Repair of Cracks
*..
75
6.12
...
75
Metals
of Welds
WELDINO QUALIFICATIONS
7.1
Welding
Procedure
Qualifications
7.2
Welders Performance
Qualifications
...
79
...
79
.*.
85
IS : 2825 - 1969
6. MANUFACTURE
AND WORKMANSHIP
b)
Specification(s)
conform.
to which
C! Welding
process(es)
parts of the vessel.
materials
to be adopted
shall
for all
Large-scale
dimensional
details of
weld preparation for the longitudinal
circumferential
seams and details of
joints for branch pipes, seatings, etc,
the position of these joints relative to
longitudinal and circumferential seams
other openings.
the
and
the
and
the
and
and
f)
g)
Test ,pressure(s)
h)
i.2 Welded
Joints,
General
if any,
specified
Considerations
of pressure vessels
general conditions.
6.2.1.1
All details of design and construction
shall generally conform to the provisions of this
code.
( Examples
of typical designs of welded
connections
are given in Appendix G. )
6.2.1.2
The materials shall conform to the
requirements of the appropriate Indian Standards
or shall be any other approved material.
6.2.1.3
The welders shall be qualified for the
type of welding concerned
in conformity with
the welders performance qualification ( see 7.2 ).
6.2.2 Nozzles, pads; branches, pipes, tubes, etc,
and non-pressure parts may be welded to pressure
parts provided that the strength and the characteristics of the material of the pressure parts are not
affected adversely.
If heat treatment
is mandatory
under
the
requirements of this code, the attachment of parts
mentioned
above by welding shall take place
before the final heat treatment.
6.2.3 The manufacturer
of a pressure vessel
built according to this code, shall be responsible
for all the welding work done under this code.
The manufacturer
shall conduct
the tests
required in this code ( see 7.1 anJ 7.2 ) to qualify
the welding procedure employed and to judge
performance
of the welders who
apply this
procedure.
6.2.4 The manufacturer shall maintain a record
of the results obtained in welding procedure qualilocation tests ( see Appendix H ).
These records giving an acctuate
description
of all the particulars of the materials and procedure
concerned shall be certified by him and shall be
accessible to the inspecting authority who should
be permitted to witness the tests if he so desires.
6.2.5 Any person who wishes to qualify for a
welders performance
test under this code shall
not be below the age of 18 years and shall have
been employed as a welder in a workshop or firm
for a period of not less than two years.
A record shall be kept to show that the welder
has been employed on work of the kind covered by
his performance
tests, during the previous six
months.
These records shall contain the results of the
welders performance
tests and the identification
mark assigned to each welder.
T!rey shall be
certified by the manufacturer and be accessible to
the inspecting authority ( see Appendix H ).
The welds made by each welder shall he marked
with a stamp showing the welders identity at
intervals of one metre or less, Care shall be taken
to avoid notching or stress concentration
due to
Deep stampdeep stamping of welders identity.
ing as a means of identifying welded seam is not
recommended
on carbon steel plates less than
7 mm thick or vessels subject to low temperatures
or on austenitic and alloy steels.
When deep
stamping is not permitted, a record shall be kept
by the manufacturers
of welders and welding
operators employed on each joint which shall be
available to the inspecting
authority;
suitable
stencil or other surface markings may be used
additionally.
6.2.6 The inspecting authority shall have the
right to disqualify a welder any time during the
fabrication of a vessel, when there is a specific
reason to question his ahility to make welds that
meet this code requirements.
Such a disqualified welder at the option of the manufacturer may
be put up for retests, under the conditions
specified in 7.2.8.1.
6.3 Design of Welded Joints
6.3.1 Single fillet welded lap joints should not
be used without previous consent of the inspecting
authority.
6.3.2 In the design of all details the aim shall
to avoid disturbances in the flow of the lines
force, in particular in constructions subjected
fatigue stresses.
Holes and openings shall not
positioned
on or. in the heat affected zones
be
of
to
be
of
65
IS:2825-1969
Where such openings are unwelded joints.
avoidable? such holes can be located on circumferential Joints provided the weld is radiographitally solmd for a length of three times the
diameter of the hole on either side.
6.3.2.1 Further,
welded joints
should be
positioned in such a manner that they are subjected
to lowest possible bending stresses. *Joints between
cylindrical shells and domed end plates shall not
be located in the curved part of the domed end
( gee Table 6.2 ). When dished end plates are
assembled from a number of plates, the welded
joints bettveen these plates shall preferahly cross
the corner curvature
for the shortest possible
length.
6.3.2.2 Attachment
of parts by welding
which cross or which are in the immediate vicinity of existing main welds in pressure parts should,
as far as possible, be avoided. If such welds cannot he avoided, they should cross the main weld
completely rather than stop abruptly
near the
main weld so that stress concentrations
in these
areas are avoided.
Further, such a part should be
subjected to local radiographic
examination
or
other approved non-destructive
tests and stress
relief, where necessary.
6.3.3 The entire assembly as well as the individual welded joints shall be designed after giving
P
t2
I---+--4c
6
c
f---
4C
1cd
t1
(A) PREFERRED
L TAPER MN
CC)
BE INSlOE OR OUTSILX
PREFERRED
Fro. 6.1
LTAPER
MAr
(0)
BE
IWM
OR
oulsloE
PERMISSIBLE
due consideration
to the method of welding and
the specific character of the joints.
The aim shall
be to avoid welding in dificult positions.
Further, welded joints shall be so positioned that they
permit visual and other methods of inspection
and re-welding of the root side of the welds
wherever posslblb.
Welded joints should be free
from undue restraint.
6.3.4 Concentration
of welded joints should be
avoided and the design should he made in such
a way that no two main seams come together under
an acute angle or cross each other.
Where it ir
IS : 2825 - 1969
from undercuts,
valleys.
overlaps
or
abrupt
ridges
or
6.3.6.2
Typical
end connections
to
shells
are given in Tabie 6.2.. Types of connections
shown in Fig. 6.2 are not permissible.
(A)
b) Flame-cutting
( see 6.4.2.2 ) which includes
plasma arc, oxy-gas with or without flux
fusion
cutting
injection
or equivalent
processes.
6.4.2.2
Carbon steel may be cut by any of
the methods described in 6.4.2.1 but alloy steels
and non-ferrous
metals shall not be flame-cut
unless otherwise agreed to between the purchaser
and the manufacturer.
Attention
is drawn to
the necessity of providing special inspection for
cracks on the cut surfaces and heat affected zones
in flame-cut alloy or high carbon steels; preheating
may be required in order to ensure satisfactory
results.
(B)
(0)
FIG. 6.2
6.4
PROHIBITED END
Preparation
6.4.1
of Parent
CONNECTIONS
Metal
6.4.1.1
Plate identification- In laying out and
cutting the plates, the manufacturers
brand shall
be so located as to be clearly visible when the
vessel is completed.
Where
the cast number:
quality of plate, tensile strength and manufacturers
name or trade-mark are unavoidably cut out, they
shall be transferred by the vessel manufacturers.
The form of transferred markings shall be readily
distinguishable
from the plate manufacturers
stamping.
The arrangement
for the transferred
markings should be agreed with the inspecting
authority
6.4.2.3
After the edges of the plates have been
prepared for welding they shall be given a thorough
visual examination for flaws, cracks, laminations,
When plates
slag inclusions or other defects.
are flame-cut, the edges should be examined after
this operation.
6.4.2.4
Care
weld preparations
the
6.4.2.5
Edges which
have been flame-cut
by hand shall be cut back by machining or chipping
for a distance of one-quarter of the plate thickness,
but in no case less than 3 mm.
6.4.3 Edge surface discolouration
which may
remain on'flame-cut
edges shall not be reggrded
as detrimental,
but burnt metal, slag and scale
shall be removed.
Brushing of stainless steel edges
shall be done with stainless steel brushes only.
67
IS t !2s!&1969
TABLE
6.1
SOME ACCEPTABLE
TYPES
OF
BLTT
WELDED
JOINTS
AND THEIR
LIMITATIONS+
If:.
-i]I
APPLICATION
FIGURES
JOINT DETAIL
I >oubIe-welded butt
join t with single
*V
(b)
(a)
Lii$?a.
(C)
-ii),
,$
4810do
I )oublc-welded butt
(b)
(0)
(d)
--
1)oublc-welded butt
joint with single
U
iii)
sm
MN
010
1.5mm-lC Ls TO SJnm
(a)
(b)
-iv:)
13oubIe-welded butt
joint with double
U
al layers.
(b)
20
ts
7mmR
--IId
4*mm
V)mm arm
(d)
( Confind
68
IS : 2825 - 1969
TABLE
6.1
SOME ACCEPTABLE
TYPBS
OF BUTT
WELDED
JOINTS
AND THEIR
LIMITATIONS*
Conrd
2.
APPLICATION
JOINT DETAIL
.4
Single-welded
butt
joint with backing
strip
(b)
$0)
8 mm UP
TO 8 mm THiCKNESS ( ts )
mm ABOVE 8 mm THICKNESS ( fs I
de
Single-welded
butt
joint
with
V
without
groove,
backing strip
Vii)
Single-welded
.butt
joint
with
V
without
GGZg
strip
Butt welds
exceeding
ness.
in plates not
10 mm thick-
-I-
1.5 mm UP TO IO mm THICKNESS
3.0 mm ABOVE IO mm THICKNESS
tx
= T
100
where
t=
D-
IS : 2825 - 1969
TABLE
6.2
TYPICAL
( Uauw
END CONNECTIONS
TO SIiBLLS*
-- --
-FIGURES
SL
No.
RBMAX~KS
_-
-ii)
L-STRAIGHT
FL -NGi
Taper
may include
or external.
weld, if desired.
I
_:_
_.._
iii)
z;
STRAIGHT
FLANGE
Tapers
_Suitable
ior
hemispherical
shell.
the
connection
of. a
and thinner
than the
for recommended
weld
-)i
PARALLEL LENGTH IF
DESIRED T3 FACILITATE
ADlOGRAPHlC EXAMINATION
OF SHELL/END
SEAM
between
l
&tA,NTAlN
INTERNAL
PROFILE OF END
OVER THIS AREA
70
shape concave
the thlckncss
Is:282501968
Cold-forming
shall not .be undertaken when
the temperature of the metal is less than 0C.
If the forming or bending operation takes place
in hot condition, no subsequent heat treatment
is required, if the final shaping process terminates
within the correct temperature
limits for the
particular material.
6.4.11 Plates Welded Prior to Forming - Seams
in plates may be welded prior to forming provided
they meet the specified mechanical test requirements and that they are examined radiographically
throughout
the entire
length
after forming.
After forming, the surfaces of such seams; in alloy
steel parts, also in carbon steel parts over 25 mm
in thickness, shall be ground smooth and inspected
for cracks by magnetic crack detection, dye penetrants or other agreed means.
6.4.12 Cold-rolling of a welded shell to rectify
a small departure from circularity is permitted,
subject to the concurrence
of the inspecting
authority provided that the radiography
( see 8.7 )
takes place after such cold-rolling, where radiography is called for.
6.4.13
Butt Welds Between Plates of Unequal
Thickness- Where two plates at a welded joint
differ in thickness by more than 3 mm the thicker
plate shall be trimmed to a smooth taper as
stipulated in 6.3.5.
6.5 Assembly
welding.
Domed ends which are inserted
shell shall be a good fit.
in the
Alignment
and Tolerances
of completed
limits defined
shall be made
and not to a
b)
IS:!26!25-1969
the actual plate thickness
following amounts:
by
more
than
the
Outside Diameter
( Nominal Inside Diameter Plus
Twice Actual Plate Thickness )
Circumfcential
Toleratue
f5
Over 600 mm
f0.25
mm
percent
Notwithstanding
the requirements
of this
clause, the misalignment tolerances for two mating
parts given in 6.6.2 shall be the governing factor.
6.6.4 Out of Roundness of Vessels -- The difference
between the maximum and minimum diameter
at any cross section of a drum or shell welded
longitudinally
shall not exceed 1 percent of the
nominal internal diameter with a maximum of
Di+ 1 250
200
of
tcmpeiMure%
procedure
for
welding
at
low
ambient
IS : 2825 - 1969
work, complete fusion without lack of penetration
at the root of the joint shall be ensured.
6.7.5 Each run of weld metal shall be thoroughly cleaned and all slag removed before the next
run is deposited.
6.7.6 The use of a filler material that will deposit
weld metal with a composition and structure as
near as that of the material
being welded is
recommended.
be subjected
to cIose inspection,
whereby
a
distinction is made between the irregularities and
defects as shown in Fig. 6.4.
(A) CWCAVIlV
IN ROOT
(8) EXCESSIV$..ETRATiON
(C) EXCESSIVE
PENETRATION
(D)
INCOt4PLEtE
ROOT FUSION
WAX
(E) LACK
OF SIDE FUSION
(A)
NORMAL
FILLET WELD
--I
(B)
DEEP
Ao.
6.3
PENEfRATlOFi
TYPES
BEYOND
+PENETAATW)N
ROOT IS 2*Smm OR MOW
FILLET
OF
WELD
FILLET WELDS
6.7.13.1
Irregularities
of the types (A), (B)
and (C) shown in Fig. 6.4 may be accepted subject
to approval of the inspecting authority.
Defects of
the types (D) and (E) ( unfused corners in the
root ) are not permitted.
6.7.14 Plug or slot welds shall be formed by
depositing a fillet around the inside edge of the hole
and leaving the centre open for inspection. The
hole or slot shall not be filled flush with weld metal
except where this is required
to complete
a
corrosion-resistant
surface.
6.7.15 The surface of the welds shall be smooth
and have gentle transition to the plate surface.
The weld metal shall fill the groove completely
forming a smooth connection
with the parent
metal on both sides and shall be free from pronounced surface irregularities, such as undercuts,
cracks, overlaps,
abrupt ridges or valleys, or
irregular beads.
6.7.16 Additional weld metal may be deposited
as reinforcement on each side of the plate so as to
ensure that the weld grooves are completely filled
and the surface of the weld metal at any point does
not fall below the surface of the adjoining plate.
The thickness of the reinforcement on each side
of the plate shall not exceed the following thickness
in case of severe and medium duty vessels:
Plate Thickness
mm
Thickness of
Reinforcement, Max
mm
up to 12
1.5
Over 12 up to and
including 25
2.5
Over 25 up to and
including 52
3.0
Over 52
4.0
73
IS : 2825 - 1969
In case of light duty vessels, the reinforcement
shail he not more than 5 mm.
6.7.17 The reinforcement
need not be removed
except when it exceeds permissible thickness or
when required under 8.7,
6.7.18 Cracks,
lack of fusion,
undercutting,
incomplete root fusion, porosity or slag inclusions,
which affect the strength of welded joints shall
not he permitted
beyond
the limits permitted
in 8.7.5.3 and 8.7.5.4.
6.7.19 Tf backing strip is used, it shall be of such
weld
material that it dues not influence
the
adversely.
Wherever possible the backiqg strip
shall be removed after \\.elding but @ior to carrying
out the required non-destructive
tests ( see 8.7 1.
6.7.28 If backing rings or cocsumable
insert
backing rings are used for pipes and tubes, these
shall be of such material and design and be so
fitted that their use does not cause defect in the
If non-consumable
Sacking rings are left
weld.
in place these shall be properly secured and when
necessary
they shall have a contour OII the inside
to minimize the restriction to flow and permit
the passage of a tube cleaner.
6.7.21
of Non-ferrous
operate at
pipes and
ground to
complete.
Metals
of Welds
*Kwxmnendations
welding of aluminium
wrlding
proccdurc
here is non-mandatory
for repairing
the.
and is subjected
inert-gas
arc-
arc welding.
IS : 2825 - 1969
to the approval of the inspecting authurity.
A hole of
about 10 mm diameter, depending
on the plate thickness
is drilled and countersunk at each end. The edge of the
hole shall be about 50 mm away from either end of the
crack.
The distancr
between the h&s &all be opened
out by a V- or U-groove
to the required
depth and
rr~eldrd.
The holes shall be fil!ed last.
It shall be
rnsurctl
by radiographic
examination
that no further
Repairs
6.10 Repair
of Drilled
Holes -- Hoier drilled
throttgtl the vessel wall for measuring thickness
should be closed by welding w-ith penetration for
Alternatively,
these
the full depth of the hole.
holes may bc treated as unreinforced openings and
closed by any method permitted under the rules
specified in this code.
6.11 Repair
of Cracks - Cracks or grooving
in plates on which forming operations have been
carried out may be removed to sound metal and
welded subject to prior agreement
between the
purchaser and the inspecting authority.
6.12
Post
Weld
Heat
Treatment
6.12.1
Post weld heat
treatment
shall be
carried out as the last operation
prior to the
prcssurr test in the case af carbon and low alloy
ferritic steels either by normalizing or by stressSpecial heat treatment in the case of
relieving.
high alloy steels and in the case of non-ferrous
shall be subject
to
nrcessary
metals
lvhere
agreement
between the manufacturer
and the
in\pc~cting authority.
stress-relieved by one
in 6.12.3 when:
of the
procedures
toxic
given
or inflarn-
b)
cl
subjected to excessive local stress concentration which may give rise to cracking or
subjected to changmg loads and subsequent
risk of fatigue failures;
e)
f)
it is necessary to maintain
dimensional
accuracy and shape in service; and
below 0C;
6.12.2.1
When
the welded joint
connects
plates that are of different rhickness the plate
thickness to be used in applying the requirements
of stress-relieving
in 6.12.2 (gj
shall be the
following:
in
IS : 2825- 1969
TABLE
6.3 M_QXIMUM
PLATE
POST
WELD
HEAT
TREATMENT
MATERIAL
GROUP
(1)
0
(3)
(2)
Carbon 0.2\) Max
Manganese I%0 Max
Residual elements 0.80 Max
Specified minimum yield strer@l
&fax
26 kgf/mms
la
Ib
Carbon 0.3!1 Mu
Maoganesr i.20 A&x
Residual element 0.10 MQX
Spe;lfied minimum yield strength
2a
2b
PLATE THICXWESS
38 kgf/mm2
20 mm ( SM Notes 2 and 3 )
All thicknesses
44 kgf/mms
All thicknt-rsrs ( ;ec Note 4 )
Nom 1 - Fine grained steels are here considered to be those having C!larpy V impact
28 kgfm at -20C ( longitudinal direction ) which have been proved by impact testi.
or
ROTE 2 - For vessels cf thickness over 15 mm and of steel which is not fine grained and whrre post-weld heat treatment is not carried ol!t, the steels shall be Charpy V impsct tested at 0C and have an impact value* of 3.5 kgfm/cma
or 2.8 kgPm (longitudina! direction).
NOTE 3-treated.
A!1 vessels with a wall thickness over 5 mm, designed for service below --20C
NOTE 4 - For circumrelential butt weld in pipes or tubes and for fillet welds attached with throat
exceeding 8 mm, post-weld heat treatment is not mandatory under the following conditions:
Maximllm thickness
76
1757-1961
content of 3 percent
>I
0.15 percent
102 mm
P mm
150C
450C
thicknesses
not
IS : 2825 - 1969
arising with the heating and
with the normalizing process.
cooling
associated
b)
Circumferential
seams in shells, piping
and other tubular products may be locally
stress-relieved
by heating
uniformly
a
shielded circumferential
band around the
entire circumference. The w,idth of the heated band shall be not less than 5 &?, where
r and t are the radius and the thickness
of the part stress-relieved, the weld being
in the centre of the band.
Sufficient insulation shall be provided to ensure that the
temperature
of the weld and heat affected zone is not less than that specified and
the temperature at the edge of the heated
band is not less than half the peak temperature.
In addition the adjacent portion
of the material outside the heated zone
shall be protected by means of thermal insulation so that the temperature gradient
is not harmful. A minimum width of insulation of 10 d/;t is recommended
for the
purpose of meeting these requirements.
The vessel may also be heated internally
for heat treatment, in which case the vessel
shall be fully encased with insulating maThe internal pressure should be
terial.
kept as low as possible and should not be
such as to cause appreciable
deformation
at the highest metal temperature expected
during heat treatment.
Shell sections or any other portion of a
vessel may be heated to stress-relieve Iongitudinal joints or complicated welded details
before being joined to make the completed
vessel.
When it is not practicable to stresrrelieve thd completed vessel as a whole ox
6.12.3.2
Where
a welded production
test
plate is required, it shall be placed inside the drum
during heat treatment, or where this is impracticable, the test plate may be placed alongside the
drum in the furnace in such a position that it will
receive similar heat treatment.
The test plate may be heat-treated separately
from the drum provided that means are adopted
to ensure that the conditions are the same for the
test plate as for the drum, namely, rate of heating,
maximum
temperature,
soaking
temperature,
soaking time, and rate of cooling.
6.12.4 Stress-relieving
of welded pressure parts
shall be effected by any of the following methods.
6.12.4.1
The
temperature
to which
the
material shall be heated for stress-relieving purposes shall be within 580 to 620C with the
following requirements:
a) The temperature of the furnace at the time
the vessel is placed in it shall not exceed
300C.
b) The rate of heating above 300C shall not
exceed 220 deg per hour up to and including 25 mm shell or end plate thickness.
For shell or end plate thickness over 25 mm
the rate of heating above 300C shall be
5 506
deg per hour
Max shell or end plate thickness in mm
is greater.
IS : 2825 - 1969
heated than 150 deg within any 4.5 m
interval of length, and when at the holding
temperature, the temperature not more than
50 deg throughout the portion of the vessel
being heated shall be within the range
580 to 620C.
When it is impracticable
to stress-relieve
at a temperature
of 580 to 62OC, it is
permissible to carry out the stress-relieving
operation at lower temperatures for longer
periods of time in accordance
with the
following:
Time of
Minutes/mm
Metal
Temperature C
Heating,
of thickness
575
3.5
550
6.0
525
9.0
For intermediate
temperatures, the time of
heating shall be determined by straight line
interpolation.
6.12.4.2
When the vessel has attained a uniform temperature as specified above, the temperature shall be held constant for a period of 2.5
minutes or longer
as may be necessary per
millimetre of the maximum thickness of the shell
or end plate subject to a minimum of one hour.
6.12.4.3
During
the heating
and holding
period the furnace atmosphere shall be so controlled
as to avoid excessive oxidation of the surface of
There shall be no direct impingement
the vessel.
of the flame on the vessel.
6.12.4.4
The vessel shall be cooled
furnace to 400C at a rate not exceeding:
Up
to and including
25 mm Max thickness of shell or end
plate
Over
25 mm Max
thickness of shell or
end plate
in the
7 000
6.4
HEAT
TYPE OF STEEL
TREATMENT
STEELS
RANGE OF
TEMPERATURE
FOB
ALLOY
TIME IN MINUTES
PER mm OF
THICKNESS
620~6tiWC
2.3
( I hour
Min)
1 Cr-4 Mo
I& Cr-+ hlo
620-660C
2.5
(1
Min)
2f Cr-1
( 2 hours Min)
C-4 MO
4 Cr-zJ MO
Mo*
hour
600-750%
2.5
5 Cr-4 MO
700-740C
2.5
( 2 hours Min )
34 Ni
580-62OC
2.5
( 1 hour
Minj
*This
wide range for the Iost-weld
heat
treatment
temperature
is necessary because of the marked dependence
of the mechanical
properties of this strel on the tempering
temperature.
In production
a definite temperature
with a tolerance
of *20C
would be selected to ensure that the mechanical
properties
upon which the design WDS based are in fact
achieved.
thickness in mm
6.12.6
OI
6.12.4.5
The temperatures specified shall be
the actual temperatures of any part of the vessel
and shall be determined
by thermocouples
in
contacts with the vessel.
All temperatures shall
ously and automatically.
be recorded
continu-
6.12.6.1
If a normalizing heat treatment has
to be carried out, the part to be normalized shall
be brought up to the required temperature slowly
and held at that temperature for a period sufficient
to soak the part thoroughly.
If the geometry of
the part causes insufficiently homogeneous cooling,
a stress-relieving
heat treatment shall be applied
after the normalizing heat treatment.
6.12.4.6
A temperature-time
diagram of the
stress-relieving operation shall be provided with all
the vessels requiring stress relief according to this
code.
6.12.6.2
Other heat treatments ( tempering,
quenching and tempering, etc ) have to be carried
out in conformity with the procedure agreed by
the manufacturer, purchaser and inspecting authority, according to the type, grade and thickness of
the steel.
6.12.4.7
The
atress relief given
considered
78
minimum
above shall
temperature
for
be the minimum
accurate.
is
not
IS:2825-1969
7. WELDING QUALIFICATIONS
positions falling within the limits of any fundaQental welding position given in IS : 815-1966*.
7.1
7.1.1
When
a manufacturing
firm furnishes
satisfactory to the customer in conjunction
with his inspectibg authority, that it has previously
made successful procedure qualification
tests or
successfully undertaken the manufacture
of boiler
components, in respect of method, base and filler
metal or thickness within a period of 3 years, in
accordance with the requirements of an approved
standard, such a firm shall be deemed exempt from
the necessity of requalifying
under the requirements of this code within the range covered by the
previous tests. When
the manufacturer
commences any welding not previously qualified and
succkssfully undertaken by him as regards methods,
parent metal, filler material, thickness and equipment, he shall prove to the inspecting
authority
that his organization
is capable of welding the
materials to be used.
For this purpose, test welds
shall be made in accordance with the limitations
stated in the following clauses.
proof,
&
7.1 A-l
7.1.2.1
Test positions for
butt wcldr - Butt
welds for making tests for procedure qualification
and welders performance
qua!ification
shall be
made in the f6llowing basic-positions:
and pipe in a
a) Downhand position-Plate
horizontal
plane with the weld
metal
deposited from above ( see Fig. 7.1 A-l and
7.1 A-2).
position - Plate
and pipe in
b) Horizontal
a vertical plane with the axis of the weld
horizontal.
Welding shall be done without
rotating
the pipe 7 see Fig. 7.1 B-l and
7.1 B-2 )
c) Vertical position - Plate in a vertical plane
with the axis of the weld vertical
( se#
Fig. 7.lC)
d) Overhead position - Plate in a horizontal
plane with the weld metal deposited from
underneath ( see Fig. 7.1 D )
e) Horizontaljixed position - Pipe with its axis
horizontal and with the welding groove in
a vertical plane.
Welding shall be done
without rotating the pipe so that weld metal
is deposited from the flat, vertical, and overhead positions ( see Fig. 7.1 E )
____*Classification and coding of covered electrodes for
metal arc welding of mild steel and low alloy high tensile
steels ( ~CU~JC~).
00>
Test Position
Dlate Vertical,
Axis of
Weld Vertical
FIG. 7.1
( Flat )
Plate Horizontal
( Flat )
( Horizontal-fixed
7.1 F Inclined at 45
to Horizontal
79
..
IS : 2825 - 1969
pressure containing
parts suitable for
high temperature
service ( fusion welding quality )
An additional
test position in case of butt
welded pipes is the pipe inclined at 45C to the
horizontal ( see Fig. 7.1 F ).
7.1.2.2
Qualification in the horizontal, vertical, or overhead position shall qualify also for the
downhand position. Qualification in the horizontal
fixed position, shall qualify for the dawnhand,
For pipes qualivertical, and overhead positions.
fication in the horizontal, vertical and overhead
positions shall qualify for all positions.
7.1.3 Apart from what is specified in 7.1.X
and 7.1.2, procedure qualification
test welds for
all preSsure parts of pressure vessels shall be made
in such a manner that the welds are considered
representative of those made in production, taking
into account the following essential variables.
7.1.3.1
for carbon
9. IS : 1914-1961 Specification
steel boiler tubes and superheater tubes
Specification
for boiler
10. IS : 2416-1963
and superheater tubes for marine and
naval purposes
11. IS : 2004-1962 Specification
steel forgings for general
purposes
Specification
for struc12. IS : 3039-1965
tural steel ( shipbuilding quality )
Specification for steel for
13. IS : 3503-1966
marine boilers marine
pressure vessels
and welded machinery structures
14. IS : 3945-1966 Specification
naval purposes
a) S/~el-The
procedure
qualification
test
plates or test pipes shall be made from steel
with a tensile stren,gth in the same range
as that of the steel to be used in the
construction
and a chemical composition
approximately
corresponding
to the most
unfavourable analysis from the standpoint of
weldability
and within the limits of the
material specification of the steel concerned.
A procedure qualification
made on steel
with a certain tensile strength and a certain
chemical analysis shall also cover the use
of steels having a lower strength and a more
favourable chemical analysis. In the case of
plain carbon or carbon-manganese
or alloy
steels, these requirements are considered to
be met, as long as the steel used for production and for the procedure qualification,
both fall within the limits of one of the
follo\vin,g groups:
i) Low alloy and carbon steels
1. Grade St 42 IS : 226-1962 Specification
for structural steel ( standard
quality )
( third. revision )
IS : 961-1962 Speci2. Grade St 55-HTW
fication for structural steel ( high tensile )
(Jirst revision )
NOTE - Carbon over 0.23 percent is rubject to agreement between the manufacturer and the inspecting
authority. In these caseS preheating is recommended.
ii) Alloy steels ( other than high alloy heat resisting
and stainless steels )
Alloy steels conforming to material group
2, 3 and 4 of Table
6.3 and group
0 and group 1 steels to be used at low
temperatures
IS : 3609 - 1966 Specification for chrome
molybdenum
steel, seamless boiler and
superheater tubes
IS : 2611 - 1964 Specification for carbon
chromium
molybdenum
steel forgings
for high temperature service.
iii) High alloy corrosk~ and heat resistant steels
1. Grade 07Crl3
7. IS : 2002-1962
Specification
plates for boilers
for
steel
1 and
2 of IS : 3038-1965
8. Grades
Specification
for alloy steel castings for
IS : l570-196l*
4. Grade 04Crl9Ni9N@
7. Grade
1961*
IS : 1570-1961*
3. Grade 04GrlSNiSTi?&!
Cl5Mn75
IS : 1570-1961
Sche4. Grade
dules for wrought
steels for general
engineering purposes
steel
IS : 1570-1961*
2. Grade 04Crl9Ni9
5. p9r;Fl
for
and carbon-manganese
steels
15. Carbon
conforming
to material group 0 and
1 of Table 6.3 except those used for low
temperature operation.
Specification
5. IS : 2041-1962
plates for pressure vessels
for carbon
engineering
07Crl9Ni9Mo2T@
6. Grade 05Crl8Nil
8. Grade
IS : 1570-196li*
lMo3
05Crl8NillMo3Tiz
lOCr25Nil8
IS : 1570IS : 1570-1961*
IS : 1576-
IS : 1570-1961*
P"rp-.
IS : 2825- 1969
undertaken
by him as regards methods,
filler metals,
thickness
of parent
metal
and equipment.
For this purpose
test
welds shall be made in accordance
with
the limitations as agreed to between the
manufacturer
and the inspecting authority.
c)
d)
7.1.3.2
Electrodes, Jiller ro&, JIux and shielding
gas - The specification and if there is no suitable
specification, the type and mark of electrode and
the composition of the filler rods, flux and shielding gas, shall be the same for the procedure qualification and production
welds.
7.1.3.3
Type of joint preparation - For manual
metal arc welding process, the type of joint preparation, for example, single V, double V, single
U, double U or square edge, may be changed in
production welds without the necessity of making
a new procedure qualification
test, provided that
the form of the preparation is in agreement with
good practice.
For semi-automatic
or automatic
welding process, any important change in edge
preparation requires a new procedure qualification.
7.1.3.4
qualification
b)
if in metal
arc welding
with covered
electrodes a change in the type of electrode
or a change in the composition of the weld
metal, and in gas welding, a change in filler
metal type or a change
in weld metal
composition is made;
if in arc welding a change is made from dc
source to ac or vice versa;
Cl if
in
joints
e) if
f)
81
IS : 2825 - 1969
DISCARD
- -___
--_-_____
-----___--_-__
REDUCED
I=
I
SECTION
TENSILE
==
LONGITUDINAL
SPECIMEN
FACE
============:
-_=
:
11
ROOT
BEND
FACE
----_-__---_-----____------
REDUCED
SPECIMEN
___I
____
-----___--__-
BEND
FACE
SPECIMEN
BEND
REDUCED
Itzi======
SECTION
====A==4
DISCARD
-- -____
---------
__--_
TENSILE SPECIMEN
--------_-_----_
---_;---__
THIS
PIECE
I_
----
____--__--__-_
--- __ __-REDUCED
FIG. 7.2
SIDE
____
----_
-_
______-_---____ _ ---__.__
___---__
DISCARD
SPECIMEN
BEND
_ -___--____--__ _____
==.._____-
__ --_-_
- -_==
SECTION
SPECIMEN
_______
FACE
LONGITUDINAL
SPECIMEN
THIS PIECE
=======r====
BEND
-_______---
ROOT
----------_-__
__---_-_---___--_._-~~-~~~-~~~~-
DISCARD
-------_________
_-----_--__-__----..=~
TENSILE
LONGITUDINAL
SPECIMEN
-__-----_-___.
-_--__-_-_-__
SECTION
LONGITUDINAL
SPECIMEN
SPECIMEN
I
I
----_
--======q=q
--_--z=-_-__
F====--
-____
_____
------------____-__-__~~-----~~~
------------_
-_----.
-----------_-_
---------_--
BEN3
SPECIMEN
BEN6
ROOT
SPECIMEN
----------_-__
__-_--_---__-_
1 1
====1==5====
THIS PIECE
-__-___--- ____
____--
___.,___
___..__
___
BEND
= =========z
TENSILE
SPECIMEN
-______---__-__
ROOT
BEND
___.-______-_
______-_______ _______
THIS PIECE
-_-_
_--_--_
==L=======---_=_----___===========
REDUCED
SECTION
._----_--_-__
._-_
--~_-_~-~._I-_--~--~~
TENSILE
..
SIDE BEND
-_-------__--~.
_----__--_
__---___----
- --_--_-
REDUCED
----._--
SIDE
----_-..------._----
------- ---____
TENSILE
--__---_==
_____ -_
SPECIMEN
..____
__-___
.--_--_-_=______=
BEND
.--__-__-___--____-______
DISCARD
SPECIMEN
SECTION
----- _---
==--_============
BEND
Cl Two
SPECIMEN
- __..
_ -- ---==_------------THIS
-__-c__
PIECE
b)
82.
___-_
_____
SPECIMEN
___..
SIDE
SPECIMEN
- ------
other than
IS:282501999
REDUCED SECTION
HORIZONTAL PLANE
(WHEN PIPE IS WELDED
wl HORIZONTAL FIXED
LRED&ED
Fm 7.5 ORDER
SECTION TENSILE
PIPE
REDUCE0 SECTIOR
HORIZONTAL PLANE
(WHEN PlPE IS WELDED
IN HORIZONTAL FIXEO
SECTION TENSILE
Fro. 7.6
ADDED
FIG.
7.7
WELD
METAL
l8:2825-1969
TABLE
7.1
TYPE
FOR
[Clauses
RANGE
QUALIFIED
r-------
_
&I(
10 and over
All-Weld
Metal
Reduced
BY
Section
TeXlde
Test
TEST PLATE
IN mm
c_--7
%l*;IY$
ing 10
C.&r*;;
op
THICKNESS
m ,mm
7.1.3.1 (c) a*
Tensile
QUALIFIED
7.1.X?]
PUUNBER
OF TF.ST SPECIMENS
--*
------_--~--_-___
Face Ber.d Rout Bend
Side Bend
(MC 8.5.9)
( JCI8.5.9 ) ( JCC8.5.9 )
TrJt
__Macro and
impact
Test
Hardness
I *cc 8.5.8 )
Test
( WC8.5.11 )
Mill
Max
: SEC
8.5.7 )
( s#e8.5.6 j
0*75r
2t
3t+,
0.75 t
2I
3$
0.75 t
2t
20
3:
tFw
#Either the face and root bend or the side bend tests may be used for thicknessfrom 10 to 20 min.
THIS PIECE
------
~-___-~--,,--~----EDUCED SECTIDN
.-__
____ ^_______
TENSILE SPECIMEN
mm_- _-_-..
(50: ZiY
_______
____
-___--_
SPECIMEN*
a -----
:Ag zEW,D
__ __-__
--_
---..-----
SPECtMEN*
------
7.1.5.3
Pipes and tubes-The
test pieces Lr
procedure qualification for butt welds in pipes and
tubes shall consist of two pieces of the pipe or tube
joined by a circumferential
butt weld and shall
provide for the number of test specimens given in
Table 7.2.
TABLE
Prr~
7.2
DIAMETER
CRoss
( OUTSIDE)
TENSILE
TEST
IJp to 50 mm
I*
Over
FACE
BEND
TEST
8!&?)
50 mm
1
*The cross trnsik test pirce for small
welded pipe as a wholr.
ROOT
BEND
TEST
( *cc
k5.9 )
SIACRO
ETCI
(III
8.5.11)
3
I
tubes shall be the
_-L-F
_---_--_
~---------.
NOTCH BAR
_____
-____~-~-..----NOTCH BAR
______
-_-_NOTCH BAR
______
_____--_,
MACRO TEST
__-__-_
,- ----_
IMPACT SPECIMEF4
m-c-IMPACT SPECIMEI I
------------.
IMPACT SPECIME!N
b_----
----.
SPECIMEN
-_______-
,_
7.3
PlPE$WTE3R
THIS PIECE
DISCARD
Up to 50 mm
84
7.8
Over
50 mm
THKXNESS 1 OP
PIPE
SPECIMENS
WIDTH olr BKND
TEST P~sca
I+
D
1%
_~
with a maximum
of 40 mm
IS : 2825 - 1969
The bend test pieces shall be out with the edges
parallel as in Fig. 7.9 and shall have the corners
rounded or dressed to a radius of approximately
2 mm.
db
Fr&. 7.9
for
steels
of
group
material
2
group
procedure
case there
described
3
M
MACRO
1
2
TENSILE
FACE BEND
ROOT BEND
FIG. 7.10
ETCH
group 0 and
SPECIMENS
FROM TUBES
AND
PIPES
Performance
Qualifications
at 7.2.1 holds
in the employ-
7.2.4 Test welds for welders performance qualification shall be carried out in exactly the same
way and under the same conditions as laid down for
the welding procedure qualification, except for the
type of joint in the case of fillet welds and branch
welds ( see 7.2.6 and 7.2.10 ).
7.2.4.1
Welding operators - Each welding operator who welds on vessels constructed under the
rules of this code shall be examined as follows for
each welding procedure under which he does welding with machine-welding
equipment
in which
both the rate of travel and the position of the
welding head with respect to the work are controlled mechanically,
except for minor adjustments
for such factors as plate-uneveness,
out-of-roundness, and lead-angle:
A) A 900 mm length of weld made by the
operator shall be examined by radiography
or bv sectioning.
The length of weld ti
examined may be that of a test plate or of
production welding.
B) In order to ensure that the operator carries
out the provisions of the welding procedure,
the radiographs of the joint shall be made
in accordance with the technique prescribed
under 8.7 and shall meet the requirements
for spot radiographic
examination
given
in (a) or two transverse sections, taken at
approximately
the third point of the weld,
shall meet the requirement? for sectioning
given in (b):
a) Requirements for spot radiographic examination
1) Welding in which the radiographs
show any type of crack or zone of
incomplete
penetration
shall be
unacceptable.
2) Welds in which the radiographs show
slag inclusions or cavities shall be
unacceptable
if the length of any
such imperfection
is greater
than
86
b)
Requirements fw sectioning
1) When the welded joint is to be
examined by sectioning, the specimens
removed shall be such as to provide a
full cross section of the welded joint
and may be removed by trepanning
a round hole or by any equivalent
method.
2) The
IS t 2825 - 1969
cimens shall conform
of welded production
D> The
b)
up to 10
2t
20 and over
1.5 t
7.2.6 Test
welds for welders
performance
qualification in fillet welds shall be carried out to
check the size, contour and degree of soundness of
the fillet welds.
The test welds shall be broken
and the appearance of the rupture, as well as a
macro-etching
of a cross section of the weld,
examined.
7.2.6.1
The test fillet welds shall be made in
The limits of angular
the following basic position.
variation of the planes during welding shall be
as given in IS : 815-1966t.
b)
7.2.5.2
In
welds deposited
bend tests shall
the test coupon
TABLE
JOINT
case of oxy-acetylene
welds
and
from. one side only, as many root
be made in addition as the size of
The root bend test spec
permits.
7.4
*For gas welding the maximum range of thickness qualified shall be limited to 1.25 times the test plate thickness.
tClassification and codit?g of covered electrodes for metal
arc welding of mild steel and low alloy high tensile steel
( reuised) .
--T Min
Butt weld
Fillet weld
TYPES
THICKNESS OF TEST
PLATE
1, mm
t up to 10
t over 10 but LESS
than 20
t 20 and over
3
5
2:
I.5 t
All tbicknus
Range of Thickness
QualiJied, in mm
r----h--_~
Min
Max*
1.5
2t
TYPZOP
Thickness of Pipe, t,
as Welded, in mm
7.2.5.1
mens that
performance
OF' THICKNESS
NUMBER OF TB~T
^--__A_--_,
Root Bend
(see 8.5.9 )
SPECIMENS
Face Bend
( see 8.5.9 )
Nick Break
(see 8.5.10)
1
1
-
1
-
IS:2825-1969
of the weld shall show complete fusim
at the root and freedom from cracks;
7.2.6.2
Qualification
cal or overhead
flat position.
7.1 IB Horizontal
of Test Tee
Weld
of
c--,iXISOF
,r
I
VELO
l-5 mm
the
lee
b)
Position
Fillet
AXS OF WELD
HORlZONTA!_
shown
7.1 IC Vertical
Position
of Test Tee for
Fillet Weld
7.1 ID
Overhead
Position
of Test Tee for
Fillet Weld
7.2.6.3
The welds shall satisfy the following
test. The dimensions and preparation
of fillet
weld test specimen shall be as shown in Fig. 7.12.
The test specimen shall not contain any visible
Thr test piece shall be cut transversely
cracks.
to provide a centrc section of 25 cm length:
test a>Fructure
section shall
specimen
shall
not
fracture;
or
ii) if it fractures,
the fractured surfaces
shall show no evidence of cracks or
incomplete root fusion, and the sum of
the lengths of inclusions and gas pockets
visible on the .fractured
surface shall
not exceed 50 mm in length.
b)
cl
-.
/
MACRO
All dimensions
7.I2A
Fillot
Weld
Soundness
SURFACE
?C YERT!CAL
CONVEX
FILLET
SURFACE
THEORETICAL
Test
TI
in millimctreh
for Performance
Qualification
of Welders
KEMEEF!
THEORETICAL
WELD
OF
HCRltONiAL
MEMBER
SIZE
THROAT
EQUAL
SURFACE
CONVEX
LEG
OF VERTICAL
FILLET
FILLET
OF WELD
WELD
MEMBER
WELD
I
THEORETICAL
UNEQUAL
7.126
LEG
FILLET
FIO. 7.12
Leg Flllct
THROAT
WELD
Weld
Sizes
FILLET WELDS
89
13r!B!i?!i-1969
I----2OP~--l
\_-+__
+cll
\SAW
CUT
7.136
7.I3A
/-TEE
TO BE CUT INTO
4 PIECES ALL CUTS
s~ouL0 BE SAWN
ro,
7.13c
All dimensions
in millimetres.
OUTSIDE .OIA
OF MAIN
r!3:282!i-l!w9
welder or welding
the root pass shall
of a minimum of
of the face bends
Table 7.4.
7.2.8.1
Retests - A welder who fails to .meet
the requirements for one or more of the test speci* mens prescribed in Table 7.4 may be tested under
the following conditions:
a) When an immediate retest is made, the
welder shall make two test welds of each
type for each position on which he has
failed, all of which shall pass the test
requirements.
b) When the welder has had further training
or practice, a complete retest shall be made
for each position on which he failed to meet
the requirements.
7.2.9 Requalification
of welders performance
will have to take place in case of requalification
of the welding procedure due to a substantial
change in essential variables as listed in 7.1.3.
7.2.9.1
Essential variables - A welder shall be
requalified whenever one or more of the changes
listed below are made in the performance
specification:
b)
The addition
welding.
of
backing
strip
in
gas
f1 A
8)
Where
combination
welds
are
used,
the
h)
The
omission
of inert
gas backing.
7.2.10
A welder having carried out a welding
procedure qualification with good results will also
be qualified for welders competence in the procedure concerned, except in the case of branch
welds.
7.2.10.1
Welder who passes the tests for butt
welds shall also be qualified to make fillet welds
in all thicknesses.
Welder who passes the tests
for fillet welds shall be qualified to make filiet
welds only.
7.2.10.2
Renewal of qualijication - Renewal of
qualification
of a performance
qualification
is
required (a) when a welder or welding operator
has not used the specific process, that is, metal arc,
gas, submerged arc, etc, to weld either ferrous or
non-ferrous materials for a period of six months
or more, or (b) when there is a specific reason to
question his ability to make welds that meet the
specification.
Renewal
of qualification
under
(a) need be made in only a single test-plate
thickness.
7.2.11 Records of all tests shall be kept by the
manufacturer and shall be available for the inspecting authority for examination whenever required.
Suggested form for the records is given in Appendix
H.
7.2.11.1 Each qualified welder and welding
operator shall be assigned one identifying number,
letter or symbol by the manufacturer which shall be
used to identify the work of that welder or welding
operator.
91
SECTION
8.
9.
III
INSPECTION
INSPECTION,
General
8.2
Inspection
During
8.3
Inspection
of Completed
8.4
Pressure Tests
8.5
Mechanical
8.6
Requirements
8.7
Non-destructive
AND
9.1
Marking
9.2
Certificate
AND RECORDS
TESTS
AND
8.1
MARKING
TESTS, MARKiNG
Manufacture
Pressure Vessels
Production
and Repairs
RECORDS
of Manufacture
and Test
of Welded
Test Plates
Test Plates
Seams
. ..
95
...
95
. ..
95
...
95
...
95
96
I...
102
...
103
...
110
...
110
...
111
ISr2823-1969
8. INSPECTION
AND
TESTS
of
Completed
Pressure
8.3.1 Visual Znsfiection- During the final inspection of the whole vessel the surfaces of the
welds are to be inspected visually and judged as
stated under 6.7.15.
If irregularities are found, rectification
carried out ( see 6.9 ).
shall be
8.3.1.1
Records
of manufacturing
details,
inspection and tests shall be kept by the manufacturer and shall be available for the inspecting
authority
for examination,
whenever
required.
Manufacturer
shall furnish a certificate of manufacture and production
tests when requested in
the form given in Appendix
M.
8.2.2.1 The inspector shall witness the marking of, and place his own stamp on portions of the
parent plate intended to be used as test plates for
seams.
The mark should be so located that it will
not be cut out or obliterated during fabrication.
8.2.3
8.3.2.1
All austenitic chromium nickel alloy
steel welds in vessels whose shell thickness exceeds
20 mm,
shall
be examined
for cracks by a
suitable fluid penetration method.
8.4
Pressure
8.2.3.1
6.2.3.2
The edges of plates, openings
and
fittings exposed during
manufacture
shall be
examined for defects.
8.2.3.3
Before assembly,
all. shell sections,
ends, rings, etc, shall be examined for conformity
to prescribed
shape and checked for thickness
and dimensions.
8.2.3.4
The component
parts of the vessel
shall be assembled and checked for alignment of
Tests
95
Is:
2825
-1969
pressure
pressure
8.4.2.1
The test pressure specified in 8.4.2
includes the amount of any static head acting at the
If the weakest part of
point under consideration.
the vessel is not located at the lowest point of the
vessel, it may be necessary to give special consideration to the effect of such additional static head due
to the test liquid.
8.4.2.2
Vessels consisting of more than one
independent
pregsure chamber
operating at the
same or different pressures and temperatures shall
be so rested that each pressure chamber ( vessel )
receives the required hydraulic test with pressure
in the others.
It is important in the interest of safety that
NOTE the vessel be properly vented so as to prevent formation
of air pockets before the test pressure is applied. It is
recommended that during the test the temperature of
the water should not be below 15C.
Pneumatic
Tests
8.4.3.1
Pressure testing with air or gas may
be carried out in lieu of the standard hydraulic
test in the following cases:
a) Vessels that are so designed, constructed or
supported that they cannot safely be filled
with water or liquid;
b) Vessels that are to be used in services where
96
even small
tolerated.
traces
of
water
cannot
be
8.4.4
Combined
Hydrostatic
Pneumatic
Test
8.4.4.1
In some cases it may be desirable to
pneumatically
test a vessel partially filled with
liquid.
In such cases a pneumatic
test may be
applied to the space above the liquid level, the
pneumatic test pressure being as required in 8.4.3.2
less the pressure due to the static head of the
liquid contained.
8.4.4.2
When pressure testing small, massproduced pressure vessels, the length of time for
which the test pressure is to be maintained
may be reduced
upon
agreement
with
th{
inspecting authority in each individual case.
8.5 Mechanical
Tests
of Fusion
Seams - Production Test Plates
8.5.0 Fusion welded seams
following mechanical tests.
shall
Welded
satisfy
the
8.&l Vessels
subjected
to severe
duty
or
with a weld joint efficiency factor J = 0.9 to 1.0
shall be provided with two test plates to represent
the welding of all the longitudinal
seams of the
first six shells or part thereof.
Vessels with more
than six shells shall have a test plate for every
third additional
shell or part thereof.
No test
plate need be provided for circumferential
seams
except in cases where a pressure vessel has circuml
ferential seams only or if the welding process,
procedure
and technique
is different in which
case two test plates are to be provided, each
having a joint as far as possible a duplication of
the circumferential
seam.
8.5.1.1
Test plates shall be attached at one
end of the longitudinal seam in such a manner that
the edges to be welded are a continuation
and
duplication of the corresponding edges of the seam.
Welding shall be effected in one reasonably continuous operation
by the same process and the
operator
or operators.
Location
of test plates
shall be as agreed to between the inspecting
authority and the manufacturer.
.
IS:2825-1969
8.5.1.2 Test plates shall be of a size sufficient
for the preparation of all the production test specimens indicated in 8.5.1.3 and should include provision for retests, if any tests fail. Recommended
layout of test pieces is shown in Fig. 8.1.
70
________
_-1
FOR RETESTS
NECESSARV
r
1.
2.
3.
4.
*
5.
) Specimen
Face
*6.
7.
8.
FIG. 8.1
a>One
b)
).
%r
b)
).
IS:2825-1969
nominal thickness as that of the work piece,
and may be taken from any part of one or more
plates of the same lot of material that is used in
the fabrication of the welded vessel.
same
8.5.4 The test plates shall be supported or reinforced during welding in order to prevent undue
welding
( see
warping
and distortion
during
Fig. 8.3 ).
8.5.4.1
If it is desired to straighten test plates
which have warped during welding, they may be
straightened at a temperature below the temperature of heat treatment of the shell to which they
belong.
Straightening
shall take place before
The test plates shall be
fina1 heat treatment*
subjected to the same heat treatment as required
for the work piece they belong to. .
--50
mm
FOR RETESTS
1.
l2.
*Set Table
FIG. 8.2
l3,
4.
Face
7.1 and
Root
Clause 7.1.5(c).
REY3:w
w@ol?ARv SuPPofmNG
STRUTS
I&e tat plater are to be suitably rupported and reinforced to prevent dirtortion during
welding.
FIG. 8.3
98
to the shell.
the
\I.99P-----cl
rT=30mm
WV
MAX
-I
I--L
(A)
--i!-6mm
TABLE
8.1
WIDTH
bhO.25 mm
DIMENSIONS
OF REDUCED
TENSILE
TEST SPECIMEN
Gauoe'
LENT
mm
MZNIMUM
PARALLEL
LENGTH
P
mm
60
125
250
200
+G, Min = W+
MINIMUM
RADIUS AT
SHOULDER
R
mm
58
50
FIG. 8.4
APPROXIMATE
TOTAL
LENGTH
L
mm
200
300
375
IF]%]
(A)
12 mm.
(B)
SECTION
l------55_1
(B)
I404
V-Notch
Test Piece
IMPACT
TEST SPECIMENS
IS:292!i-1969
V OR U NOTCH
--.
I
\YI
/I
2 SPECIMENS THUS
l--
ROOT SlCJ~L
MACHINING OF THESE
SURFACES TO BE A
MINIMUM
VORUNOTCHY
ROOT SIDE
/--,
I
\/
fl
2 SPECiMENS THUS
LMACHINING OF THESE
SURFACES TO BE A
+++I
FIG. 8.6B
SPECIMEN THUS
IS : 2825 - 1969
All dimensions
FIG.
8.7A
in miliimetres.
AlI dimensions
TRANSVERSE
FACE AND ROOT BEND
SPECIMEN
WELD NORMALLY
OQESSE 0 FLUSH
$10.
8.7C
METHOD OF TESTING TRANSVERSE
BEND TEST SPECIMEN ( see TABLE 8.2 )
in millimetres.
FIG. 8.7B
METHOD OF CUTTING TRANSVERSE
BEND TEST SPECIMENS FROM ACROSS FULL
PLATE THICKNESS
-
-._.
-,--
+,I
-I-
MAX
RADIUS
10X0-,
&
All dimensions
FIG. 8.7D
in millimetres.
0=3a
FIG. 8.7E
METHOD
OF
( Clam
TENSILE STRENGTH
OP PLATE
AND
8.5.9.5 )
DIAMETER
OF
FORMER
FREESPACZ
BRTWEEN
SUPPORTSA'J
THE END OF
TEST, Max
Below 44 kgf/mm2
21
4.2
From 44 to 54 kgf/mm2
3r
5.2 1
Above 54 kgf/mma
41
6-2
of Welded
Test Plates
200 MIN
All dimensions
FIO. 8.8
NOTE- Thevalues
10 x 10 mm teat piece.
in millimetrcs.
are equivalent
I-W
8.9
+ 25 MINr EACH
TESTSPECIMEN
*AS
f-AS REQUIRED.j
LTAPPED
TESTING
SIDE--I
FOR MACRO
REQUIRED
EXAMINATION
------_I
HOLE TO SUIT
MACHINE
FEMALE
MEMBER
MEMBER
r
FIG. 6.10
102
TO BE
BY SAWING
FIG.
be
in
IS : 2825 ; 1969
elongation of not less than 20 percent at the section
in the base metal 6 mm from the edge of the weld,
shall show no sign of disintegration after bending.
8.6.4 jVick Break Test-The
fracture
on inspection shall sh ow complete penetration throughout the entire thickness of the plate, absence of
from
oxide or slag inclusions
and
freedom
excessive porosity.
macro-etching
of
Test - The
8.6.5 Macro
of the weld shall
a complete
cross section
show a good penetration and absence of lack of
fusion, significant inclusions and other defects.
In case of doubt, the doubtful zone shall be investigated by micro-etching.
8.6.6 All- Weld Metal iensile Test - The tensile
strength R obtained shall be at least equal to the
s ecified minimum
tensile strength of the base
The elongation
A in percent obtained
n! aterial.
shall be at least equal to that given by the following equation, in the case of carbon and carbon
manganese steels:
A =
R being measured
IOO-
Examination
8.7 Non-destructive
Repairs of Welded Seams
8.7.0 For general
guidance
in
technique,
reference may be made
1963*.
no radiographic
examination
is required
where the thickness does not exceed 6 mm;
b)
no 1adiographic
examination
is required
where the thickness is greater than 6 mm
but does not exceed 12 mm and the outside
diameter does not exceed 102 mm;
c)
in constructions
where the thickness and
outside diameter
are greater than those
specified in (a) and (b) above, but do not
exceed 20 mm or 170 mm respectively,
five welds selected at random from each
welders work, but with a maximum
of
5 percent of the total length of welds, shall
be radiographically
examined;
and
for constructions exceeding the limits specified in (c) above, all the welded joints shall
be radiographically
examined.
Figure 8.11
clarifies graphically
the requirements
aa
formulated under (a), (b), (c) and (d).
in kgf/mms.
shall con-
8.6.8 If the results of a test on welded production test plates are unsatisfactory,
the causes shall
be investigated making use in particular of the
If the unsatisfactory
results
results of new tests.
of the original tests are proved to have been caused
by local or accidental defects, the results of the
retests shall be decisive.
radiographic
to IS : 2595-
2.2
and
8.6.8.1
Retests-Should
any
of the test
pieces fail to meet the specified requirements,
retests shall be allowed for each test piece that fails,
as follows:
Tensile tests - Where any result of the tensile tests is not less than 95 percent of the
specified value one retest shall be made.
Where the result falls below 95 percent,
two retests shall be made.
b)
c)
8.6.8.2
Should any of the retests fail to meet
the specified requirements,
the welded seams
represented by these tests shall be deemed not to
comply with this standard.
12
19
THICKNESS
INmm
FIG. 8.11
RADIOGRAPHIC EXAMINATION
8.7.1.2
Butt welds in furnaces, combustion
chambers and other pressure parts under external
pressure, are subject to check radiographic examButt welds in fully sufiported end plates
ination.
are not subject to radiographic examination.
*Code of practice
for radiographic
testing.
103
IS : 2825- 1969
8.7.2 Radiography B - Spot or check radiographic examination of the welded joints in question,
comprising at least 10 percent of their whole length.
The individual radiographs should not be shorter
than 25 cm unless this is necessitated by the shape
of the joints, the radiographic
examination
shall
in all cases comprise all points of intersection with
other joints, unless these points have already been
examined by the radiographic examination of the
other joints. At least one radiograph for the work
of each welder or welding operator used in the
fabrication of the vessel is necessary.
8.7.2.1
If the results of the examination
of
check radiographs
of the selected welds are not
satisfactory,
the cause shall be investigated and,
if considered necessary, the percentage of radiographic inspection increased by agreement between
the manufacturer
and the inspecting authority.
Radiographic
8.7.3 Preparation of Wt$ds for
Examination - All butt welded joints to be radiographed shall be free from weld ripples or weld
surface irregularities
on both the inside and the
outside, to a degree such that the resulting radiographic contrast due to any remaining irregularities
cannot be confused with that of any objectionable
defects.
Also the weld surface shall merge smoothIy into the plate surface.
8.7.3.1
The finished surface of reinforcement
may be flush or have a reasonably uniform crown
not exceeding the limits stipulated in 6.7.16.
8.7.3.2 Welded buttjoints of the backing strip
( see Table 6.1 ) type may be radiographed without
removing
the backing
strip provided that the
image of the latter is not significantly detrimental
to the interpretation
of the radiographs.
8.7.3.3
Radiographic
examination
conducted before final heat treatment.
In the case of
may be provided,
to the sum of the
forcements passed
should be
check
the
image
8.7.4 Penetrameters - To
quality of the radiographs,
use shall be made of
either a wire type or stepwedge type ( see IS : 36571966* ) image quality indicator or penetrameter.
At least two penetrameters shall be used for each
radiograph.
One penetrameter
shall be placed
at each end of the length of weld shown on each
radiograph,
Further, the penetrameters shall be
laced on the source side and not on the film side.
! ,he radiographic examination shall be capable of
revealing a difference in metal thickness equal to
not more than 2 percent of the thickness of weld
under examination.
b)
Any elongated
ceeding:
8.7.4.1
The penetrameter
should be placed
parallel with and close to the weld with the wire or
hole which is the smallest in diameter positioned
away from the centre of the length of weld under
Each section of the weld shall be
examination.
marked so that the radiographs
can easily be
correlated
to the particular
part of the joint
represented.
*Specification for radiographic image quality indicators.
104
incomplete
inclusion
fusion
of a length
ex-
75 mm;
than
that
given
in
IS : 2925- 1969
NO. OF
DIMEN-NIONS
-.
.
.:.:.
.4: .
.:.
ASSORTED
LARGE
-.-
PORES
,,.
FIG. 8.12A
MEDIUM
DIMENSIONS.
NO. OF
.:.*
0.6Yrn
. .*.
.
0.66
3.12
*....
*.
. *
.
l
.
:
PORES
35
. .
..*;.._
. ._
ASSORTED
LARGE
MEDIUM
..
FIG. 8.12B
J
I
DIMENSIONS
0-70
l.(jO
NO. OF PORES
.
312
. .
. *
:..
. 0
.
--
*:
I
Fro. 8.12C
DhE.SIONS
.
.. . .
_...
FINE
0.
l *.
. .
38
21
1
fGED!UM
. *.
-.
. .
l .
.
0
. .
.
.
.
..*...
. . . .
l
l
. .* . .
1.. ** * : *.
.:.
*
ASSORTED
. . .
r*coJ
.
. .*
. *.*
.
.
.
150
.
.
.
.
.
l
.
.
..--*
44
iy
l;)::-:i:l
~:
FIG.
106
8.12D
IS:2825-1969
DIAMENSIONS
NO. OF PORES
mm
1.40
2.00
3.12
l
40
.
.
0.
0.
.
. .
0
0.
l *
0..
0.
ASSORTED
l .
a-
l:
L50
le.
MEDIUM
~-;I~
I
I
FIG. 8.12E
FINE
Radiography B
or areas
a>orCracks
penetration;
W
4
POROSITY CHART,
having incomplete
fusion
Any inclusion or cavities of a length exceeding two-thirds of the thickness of. thinner
plate welded;
Any group of inclusions in alignment, the
total length of which exceeds the thickness
over a length of six times the thickness,
except when the distance between the
successive defects exceeds three times the
length of the longest defect in the group.
The maximum length of elongated inclusions permitted shall not be more than
12 mm; and
Porosity is not a factor in the acce tability of welds not required to be Pully
radiographed.
PLATE OVER 64 mm
1, where 5 is the highest and 1 is the lowest obtainable mark. As a basis for the interpretation, the
:f-raW;fisW Collection of Reference Radiographs
, Atlas Issued by the International
Institute of Welding shall be used.
Marks II W Colour
Black
Blue
Green
lS:!28!25-1969
imrks
Brown
IICV c010ur
Gross deviations
from homogcneity in the form of one or
more of the following defects,
namely:
Red
(a)
gas cavities,
(1~) slag
inclusions, (c) undercut, (d) incomplete penetration,
(c) lack
of fusion, and (f) cracks
Welded joints in pressure, vessels which are
required to be made in accordance with this code
shall obtain a minimum of 4 marks in the radiographic examination.
b)
Where radiographs
are required
of the
entire length of a welded seam, sufficient
overlap shall be provided to ensure that the
radiographs cover the whole of the welded
seam, and each radiograph shall exhibit a
number near each end ( see Fig. 8.13 ).
Lead numerals
shall be placed on the
opposite side of the weld to the appropriate
stamped numerals to provide ready identification of the radiographs with the portion
of welded seam represented ( see Fig. 8.13 ).
Isolated
films getting
lower
marks may,
however, be accepted with the permission of the
inspecting authority in each individual case.
8.7.6 Any repair to a weld carried out by the
manufacturer
shall be reported to the inspecting
authority.
If the repair is made as a consequence
of a radiographic
examination,
the films of the
original defects and after repiar of defects, shall
be made available to the inspecting authority. If
the defects form a continuous line, the extent of
repair shall be agreed upon between the manufacturer and the inspecting authority.
8.7.7
If a longitudinal
seam fails to meet the
of the code and it is desired to effect
a repair by removing the whole weldand rewelding
.it, the original test plate shall becut and repaired
to simulate condition of main seam weld. If it is
not possible, a new production
plate shall be
provided.
. requirements
8.7.8 If a circumferential
seam fails to meet
the requirements
of the code and it is desired to
effect a repair by removing the whole weld and
rewelding it, the inspecting authority shall be entitled to call for a new production plate, if required.
8.7.9 All repaired areas shall be subject to radio?
graphic
examination
where
radiography
was
originally required.
8.7
.lORadiographic
8.7.10.1
Zdentijcation of radiographs
a) Numerals
alongside
radiograph
portion of
impression
a stamp
108
Examination
1) The
bythe
2) The
3) For
IS:282511969
STAMPED
ON
VESSEL \
RADIOGRAPH
WELDED
NO. 4-5
SEAM
6 _______.
7&W
--------_--____-__-_--.-- 51 ---_---_.__
\
k
-- -------------_--.--_---_.~-J___-,_,-,_,,,,,,,,,
II
7
LEAD
CHARACTERS
RADIOGRAPH
d-r
NO. 5-6
EACH RADIOGRAPH
MIJST SHOW
A NUMBER
AT EACH END
d7
FIG. 8.13
MARKINGFOR IDENTIFICATION
OF RADIOGRAPHS
numbers
FIG. 8.14
seam is.........mm.
8.7.10.2
Testing technique - The radiographic
technique shall be capable of detecting difference
in metal thickness of at least 2 percent of the
thickness of the plate under examination, and this
shall be clearly indicated on each individual radiograph by means of an adequate indicator radiographed on to the films.
The width of the radiographs shall be at least
equal to the total width of the welded joints plus an
allowance of about 10 mm on each side of the
welded joint.
8.7.10.3
seam is . . . . . . . . .mm.
IS : 2825 - 1969
of
of
In addition to this, a further random radiographic examination shall be carried out on the
other joints of the vessel in question, unless these
joints have already been examined
throughout
their entire length.
This additional examination
shall comprise the same number
of radiographs
Should any of
as prescribed for Radiography
B.
these additional
radiographs
fail to meet the
requirements
of 8.7.5.3
or 8.7.5.4,
the joint in
question shall be examined throughout its entire
length and shall be repaired where necessary,
followed by renewed examination, until the quality
requirements
have been met with.
Should the random radiographic examination
of a vessel reveal. a larger number of systematic
defects of such character
that similar
defects
may be expected to occur to a greater or smaller
extent in the welds as a whole, or in all welds
of a certain category,
the inspecting authority
has the right to request an extension of the
examination
including a complete
examination
of all welds, or including all welds in the vessel
within the category
in question.
All parts of the welded joints, which do not
meet
the requirements
stated
under 8.7.5.3
or 8.7.5.4 shall be repaired and re-examined after
repair.
e) No repairs shall be carried out after the
radiographic
examination
without the prior consent of the inspecting authority.
f) Radiographic
films Ball be preserved by
the manufacturer
for a period of at least five years
after the acceptance
of the films.
8.7.10.4
Protection of jwsonnel- All persons
exposed to X or gamma rays and engaged in
radiographic work shall be suitably shielded against
direct and scattered radiations.
110
reference
may
be
8.7.11
Other Non-destructive
Testing MethA When special conditions make it expedient, radiography as specified in 8.7.1 and 8.7.2 may be replaced by other non-destructive testing methods, for
example, dye penetrant, magnetic or ultrasonic testing methods upon previous consent of the inspecting
authority, and on the condition that such testing
methods may be considered to render an equally
safe evaluation of the quality of the welding work.
Such non-destructive
testing methods may also
be employed to ascertain the quality of welds,
where radiography cannot be easily employed as
in the case of fillet and butt welds on branches
and fittings.
See IS : 3664-1966?,
IS : 4260-1967$,
19665 and IS : 3703-196611.
9. MARKING
AND
IS : 3658-
RECORDS
9.1 Marking-Each
name
Manufacturers
serial No.
Year built
Max W.P . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . at Temp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C
IS : 2825 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .FRT/PR**/SRtt
Hydraulic
pneumatic
test pressure...
. . . . . . . . . . . ...
Date of test.. . . . . . . . . . .
Inspecting
authoritys
official stamp
IS : 2925 - 1969
9.1.3 The stamping area shall be painted and
outlined in a contrasting colour.
The stam ing
or name-plate described in 9.1 and 9.13, sha P1 be
kept free of any covering.
9.1.4 Either of the following arrangements may
be used in marking vessels having two or more
independent
pressure chambers designed for the
Each
same or different
operating
conditions.
detachable
chamber
shall be marked so as to
identify it positively with the combined
unit:
a) The
marking may be grouped in one location .on the vessel, provided it is arranged
so as to indicate clearly the data applicable
to each chamber.
111
APPENDICES
APPENDIXA
. ..
APPENDIXB
...
115
ALLOY STEELS
124
APPENDIXC
STRESSES
FROM LOCAL LOADS ON, AND THERMAL GRADIENTS IN, PRESSURE
VESSELS
.. .
126
APPENDIX D
175
APPENDIX E
TENTATIVE RECOMMENDED
PRACTICETO AVOID FATI~VE CRACRINQ
178
APPENDIX F
180
APPENDIX G
195
APPENDIX H
. ..
224
APPENDIXJ
WELDING
APPENDIX K
...
231
APPENDIX L
. ..
232
APPENDIX M
233
235
APPENDIX N
LININGS
OF
...
226
APPENDIX
A
( CZause 2.2.1.1 )
ALLOWABLE
STRESS VALUES
FOR FERROUS
AND NON-FERROUS
MATERIAL
given in Table
2.1 and
B.
TABLE A.1
GRADE OR
DESIGNATION
MATERIAL
SPECWICATION
ALLOWABLE
MECHANICALPROPERTIES
F_--_--__-_--_-_
Tensile
Percentage
Yield
Elongation
Strength
Stress
Min
Min.
Min
on Gauge
kgf/mms
kgf/ mm2
Length
=5*652/K
&o
E20
STEEL IN TENSION
Plates
IS : 2002-1962
37
0.55
RzO
26
9.5
8.7
7.8
7.5
7.2
5.9
43
3%
IS : 2002-1962
2A
42
0.50 Rzo
25
9.8
90
8.1
7.7
7.4
5.9
4.3
3.6
IS
: 2002-1962
2B
52
0.50 Rzo
20
12.1
11.1
l@O
95
8.3
5.9
43
3.6
IS
: 2041-1962
20MdL
48
28
20
143
132
123
11.9
11.5
11.2
10.8
7.7
5.6
3.7
IS
: 204!-1962
20Mn2
52
30
20
140
128
11.6
11.0
8.3
5.9
43
3.6
IS
: 1570-1961
15Cr9OMo55
50
30
20
16.0
15.2
1+4
13.8
134
13.0
12.6
11.7
8.6
5.8
3.5
IS
: 1570-1961
C15Mn75
42
23
25
10.7
9.8
8.9
8.4
8.1
5.9
4.3
3.6
86
7.9
7.1
6.8
65
5.9
4.3
3.6
3%
-.
-
Forgings
IS : 2004-1962
IS
: 2004-1962
Class 1
Class 2
37
44
0.50 RzO
0.50 R20
15
102
9.3
&5
8.0
7.7
5.9
43
IS : 2004-1962
Class 3
50
@5U Rzo
21
11.7
107
9.6
9!
8.3
5.9
4.3
3.6
IS
: 2004-1962
Class 4
63
@50 Rzo
15
147
134
12.2
11.5
8.3
5.9
4?
36
IS
: 1570-1961
20M@
48
28
20
14.3
132
12.3
11.9
11.5
11.2
10.8
7.7
5.6
3.7
t:
..
IS
: 261 l-1964
15Cr9OMo55
50
30
20
16.0
15.2
144
13.8
134
13.0
12.6
11.7
86
58
IS
: 1570-1961
lOCr2Mol
50
32
20
17.9
17.3
16.4
16.1
15.8
15.3
14.9
12.7
9.6
7.0
ii
s
3.2
2.3
( Confinuad )
TABLE
MATERIAL
SPECIFICATION
A.1
GRADE OR
DESIGNATION
ALLOWABLE
STRESS VALUES
FOR CARBON
MECHANICAL PROPERTIES
~__________c___
Tensile
Strength
Mitl
kgf/mms
Yield
Stress
Min
kgf/mms
~520
R 20
Percentage
Elongation
Min
on Gauge
Length
=5*65dg
Tubes,
c--------
Up
STEEL IN TENSION-
Up
Up
Up
Contd
AT
DESIGN TEMPERATURE C
.-------__
--7
Up
Up
Up
Up
Up
20
4;5
4;o
:;5
L%l
535
L
86
UP
to
UP
UP
5%
UP
to
575
5.8
3.5
EZO
Pipes
.
le/&r J/:, Mq Tube
Nor aliaed and
Tern% red
44
24
950/&o
12.8
12.1
11.5
11.1
197
164
190
97
IS : 3609-1966
24% Cr 1% MO
Tube Normalized
and Tempered
49
25
9WK20
140
13.5
128
12-G
12%
12.0
Il.6
11.3
9.G
7.0
4.3
xs : 1570-1961
2OMoSS
46
950/&o
128
il.9
11.0
10.6
103
l@O
9.6
7.7
5.6
3.7
IS : 1914-1961
32 kgF/mms, Min,
Tensile Strength
32
@SO Rzo
95OlR2o
7.4
6.8
6.2
58
5.6
5.0
4.3
3.6
IS
: 1914-1961
43 kgf/mms, Min,
Tensile Strength
43
950 Rzo
95O/R,o
IO.0
9.2
8.3
7.9
7.6
5.9
4.3
3.G
IS
: 2416-1963
32 kgf/mms, Mitt,
Tensile Strength
32
0.50 R20
950,R20
7.4
6.8
6.2
58
5.6
5.0
43
3.G
IS
: 1978-1961
St 18
31.6
17.6
82
7.5
6.7
64
tXJ
5-9
4-3
3%
St 20
33.7
19.7
92
8.4
7.6
7.2
6.9
5-3
4.3
3.6
St 21
33.7
21.1
9.8
9.0
8.1
7.7
7.4
5.9
4.3
3.G
St 25
42.2
246
Il.5
10.5
9.5
9.0
8.3
5.9
43
3.6
St 30
42.2
295
13.8
12.6
11.5
10.8
83
5.9
4.3
3.c
-.
St 32
44.3
32.3
15.0
136
12.5
11.8
8.3
59
43
3G
-_
*-
St 37
46.4
36.6
17.1
15%
141
134
8.3
5.9
43
3.G
IS
: 3609-1966
IS : 1979-1961
25
-+
IS : 3038-1965
IS : 2856-1964
Grade 1
55
35
17
12.2
11.2
10.1
9.6
6.2
4.4
3.2,
2.7
Grade 2
47
25
17
9.6
8.8
8.2
8.0
7.7
7.5
3.1
5.8
4.2
2.8
Grade 3
52
31
15
Il.9
ll.0
10.2
9.9
9.6
9.3
8.4
5.8
4.2
2.8
Grade 4
49
28
17
11.2
10.6
10.1
9.7
9.3
9.1
8.8
8.5
6.5
4.4
2.6
Grade 5
52
31
17
13.0
12.5
11.9
11.7
11.4
11.1
10.8
9.5
7.2
5.3
3.7
2.4
Grade 6
63
43
15
17.2
16.3
15.5
14.9
14.4
14.0
13.5
6.7
4.9
35
2,6
1.7
0.9
C SW-G20
42
21
20
7.3
6.7
6.1
5.7
5.5
4.4
3-2
2.7
1.6
C SW-cm
49
25
18
8.7
8.0
7.2
6.8
6.2
4-4
3.2
2.7
l-6
Rivet
IS: 199or1962
r
37
O-55 RL,,
26
8.6
7.9
7.1
6.8
6.5
5.9
4.3
3.6
42
@55 Rl,,
23
9.8
90
8.1
7.9
7.4
5.9
4.3
3.6
Sections,
Plates, Bars
St 42-S
42
24
23
9.8
9.0
8.1
St 55 HTW
50
29
20
11.7
10.7
9.6
IS : 2062-1962
St 42 -W
42
23
23
98
9.0
8.1
IS : 3039-1965
Grade A
9.8
9.0
8.1
Grade D
11.7
10 7
9.6
1Sx 226-1962
IS
: 961-1962
IS : 3503-1966
IS : 3945-1966
Grade 1
37
0.55 Rl,,
26
86
79
7.1
6.8
6.5
5.9
4.3
3.6
Grade 2
42
0.55 Rzo
25
98
9.0
8.1
7.7
7.4
59
4.3
3,6
Gtidc 3
44
0.55 Rzo
23
IO-2
93
8.5
8.0
7.7
5.9
4.3
3.6
Grade 4
47
0.55 R,,,
22
11.7
10.7
9.6
9.1
8.3
5.9
4.3
3.6
Grade 5
50
055 R,,,
21
121
11.1
10 0
9.5
8.3
5.9
43
3.6
Grade A-N
44
24
23
9.8
9.0
8.1
Grade B-N
50
28.5
20
11.7
10.7
9.6
fi:
..
-
!i
ul
I
z
q
For additional inspection as detailed in Note to Table 2.1 a quality factor of @9 shall be used and the above stress
f
A-l.2
The allowable
stress values for high alloy steels are given in Table A.2.
;:
..
%
c?
TABLE
A.2
ALLOWABLE
PRODUCT
Plates, sections,
IS: 1570-1961
04CrgNig
04Crl9Ni9Tig
Bars, forgings
04Crl9Ni9Nb$
and seamless
1 05Crl8Nil lMo3
I
IS: 3444-1966
r
(
(
tubes
STRESS VALUES
REMARKS
MECHANICAL
PROPERTIES
~-_--_*_---___~
Tensile
Yield Elongation
Strength
Stress
Percent
kgf:rnms kgf/mms
Min
Min
Min
on Gauge
Length
Rzo
E20
5,651/s
STEELS
I
w
IN TENSION
c-.------_-_
up to
50
AT
DESIGN
100
150
200
250
300
350
400
Austenitic
55
24
281
16.00
14.20
12.40
1060
9.97
935
870
8.07
stainless
55
24
281
1680
1428
12.56
10.83
10.64
10.60
10.60
10.80
14.28
12.56
1@83
1064
10 60
10 60
1060
55
55
24
24
28
28
I
I
16.00
steels
16+8
1450
13.00
11.50
11.24
11.23
11.23
11.12
55
24
28)
16.00
1450
13.00
11.50
11.24
11.23
11.23
11.!2
12.94
11.88
10.83
10.64
10.60
10.60
10.60
13.17
12.34
11.50
11.24
11.23
Il.23
11.12
05Crl9Ni9Mo3Ti?!!
Grade 7, 8
*Castings
Grade 9, 11
For
47
21
211
1400
47
21
131
1480
additional
inspection as detailed in Note to Table 2.1, a quality factor of 0.9 shall be used and
TABLE A.3
MATERIAL
GRADE
AND
PRODUCTS
MECHANICAL
PROPERTIES
CONDITION
_---___A__,
Tensile
SbIIgth
Mi?J
w-2
0.2 ?roof
StrerS
Min
W/-2
Elongation.
on 41/S;;
Sheet, Strip
22
18.
IS : 733-1967
NE5
22
18+
IS : 738-1966
NT5
Drawn Tubes
22
18*
IS : 1285-1958
NV5
Hollow Section
22
18,
IS : 737-1965
NS6
Sheet, Strip
27
18*
18*
208
NTG DrawnTubes
27
IS : 736-1966
NP6
27
Plate
DESIQN
-_I
up to
50
TEMPERATUREC
--
7%
U2P$ -
Pcrcent
NS5
AJJLOWABUZ
STRESS VALLESIN kgf/mm2AT
fl-
Contd
ALLOYS IN TENSION-
Min
IS : 737-1965
IS : 738-1966
AI!ID AL-
5.49
6.68
IS : 733-1967
NE6
Bars, Rods
27
18*
IS : 1285-1958
NV6
Extruded Tubes
26.8
18* J
IS : 733-1967
NE8
27
16
7.02
IS : 1285-1958
HV9
Extruded
Round Tubes
Hollow Section
11
15
2.97
290
278
267
253
1.93
1.33
IS : 1285-1958
HV9
do
15.7
10
374
3.61
338
324
295
2.18
I.41
IS: 1285-1958
HV9
do
Wl
l&9
12
515
4.91
4.65
429
3.16
218
1.41
IS
: 736-IYG6
HP30
Plate
20.5
11.0
15)
IS
: 734-1967
HF30
Forging
190
11.0
I
8 I
IS
: 737-1965
$IS30
Sheet, Strip
20.5
11.0
15
518
5-01
4-86
4-71
4.50
394
281
729
7.10
6-85
6.60
5.56
436
310
8.82
8.45
7.95
7.30
506
309
211
IS
: 733-1967
190
11.0
r
I8 I
IS
: 738-1966
HT30
Drawn Tube
220
11.0
I
I6 J
IS : 738-1966
HT30
Drawn Tube
WP
31.5
250
71
IS
: 736-1966
HP30
Plate
WP
30
23.5
81
IS
: 7341967
HF30
Forging
WP
30
25
IS
: 737-1965
HS30
Sheet, Strip
WP
30
25r5
IS
: 733-1967
HE38
Bars,
Rods
and Sections
WP
30
25.0
WP
44
38.0
NB6
tH
31.5
23.5
7.65
WP
30.0
25.0
585
570
5.48
5-27
443
344
?32
M (sand
cast !
16.5
8.0.
259
236
2.25
2-14
1.90
1.72
1.55
M (chill
cast )
l&9
120*
296
2.68
2.56
2-46
2.18
1.97
1.76
IS: 1285-1958
S
: 1285-1958
IS : 1284-1966
IS : 617-1959
Bolting alloy
Casting alloy
!
10
8 i
i
IOi
1
*The elongation
:;:
A-1.4
Ailowable
stress values for copper and copper alloys are given in Table
A.4.
t:
..
E
TABLE
~IAT&IAL
SPECIFICATION
GRADE PRODUCT
A.4
ALLOWABLE
MECHANICAL
,__________h_________
STRESS VALUES
PROPERTIES
Tensile
Strength
Afin
kgf/mms
Yield
stress
Min
kgf/mms
IS : 410-1967
Cu Zn 30
Cu Zn 37
28
28
IS: 1972-19Gl
Cu Zn 40
All grades
28
22.5
: 288- 19GO
FOR COPPER
AND COPPER
ALLOYS
Elongation
rercent
Min
~__-_______--_______h------_--_--.----_
Up
Lz
Up
to
75
-7
UP
UP
UP
up
UP
UP
UP
lb0
2%
2:
2505
3;
3%
St500
7.03
879
7.03
8.67
7.03
8.30
7.03
7.81
6.96
7.28
5.70
5.38
383
2.00
246
-
30
35
879
4.71
8.67
4,GG
8.30
4.54
7.81
4.30
7.28
3.47
5.38
2.71
2.00
1.90
40
22
7.03
7.03
7.03
7.03
G.96
5.70
3.83
2.46
IS: 4171-1967
40
22
7.03
7.03
7.03
7.03
6.96.
5.70
383
2.4G
IS
40
22
1.76
l.iG
1.7G
1.67
1.54
1.48
1.41
40
-_
22
1.76
1.7G
1.7G
l.G7
1.54
1.48
1.41
--
IS: 291-1966
Grade
Grade
35
35
5:
8.67
8.67
8.30
8.30
7.81
7.81
7.28
7.28
5.38
5.38
2.00
2.00
IS
Alloy I
Alloy 2
7.03
8.79
7.03
8.67
7.03
8.30
7.03
7.81
6.96
7.28
5.70
5.38
3.83
2.00
7.03
8.44
8.76
7.03
8.44
8.67
7.03
8.44
853
7.03
8.44
8.34
6.96
8.28
8.09
5.70
5.43
7.09
3.83
2.58
4.64
1%
3.16
l-88
32
8.44
8.44
8.44
8.44
8.28
5.43
2.58
1.58
42
8.31
8.08
7.89
7.71
7.59
7.58
7.27
7.14
4.22
4.19
4.13
4.00
3.47
2.71
1.90
5.88
5.09
4.12
582
496
3.90
5.76
4.84
3.78
5.69
4.77
3.65
5.56
4.65
3.52
5.38
458
3.50
5.13
-
4- 78
-
400
-
Bolting Material
: 288-19GO
IS: 4171-19L7
Sections
8.79
8.79
Tubes
: 4u7-196G
IS: 1545-1960
IS
: 2371-1963
ISBT 1 ISBT 2
ISABT
IS?\BZT
CuZn2lAl2As
Cu Ni 31 Mn
IS
: 2501-1963
IS
: 318-1962
1 Fe
22
li.5
11
7.5
7.11
6.92
6.83
6.73
Castings
Grade 1
Grade 2
Grade 3
z.5
5;
12
;:;
5.94
5.2 1
4.30
IS : 2825 - 1969
A-2. LIST OF INDIAN STANDARDS
No.
Sl
.NO.
of the
IS : 288-1960
IS : 291-1961
3)
4)
5)
6)
1
IS
IS
IS
IS
IS
8)
IS : 733-1967
9)
IS : 734-1967
10)
IS : 736- 1965
11)
IS : 737-1965
12)
IS : 738-1966
13)
14)
IS : 961-1962
IS : 1284-1966
15)
IS : 1285-1968
16)
23)
24)
25)
26)
2)
28)
29)
IS
1s
IS
IS
IS
IS
IS
IS
.IS
IS
IS
IS
IS
IS
30)
31)
32)
IS : 2416-1963
IS : 2501-1963
IS : 2611-1964
33)
IS : 2856-1964
34)
IS : 3038-1965
35)
36)
3)
IS : 3039-1965
38)
IS : 3609-1966
39)
40)
IS : 3945- 1966
IS : 4171-1967
1)
SPECIFIED IN TABLES
A.1 TO A.4
l%le
Standard
1)
2)
18)
18)
20)
21)
22)
ON MATERIALS
: 318-1962
: 320-1962
: 407-1966
: 410-1959
: 617-1959
: 1385-1959
: 1545-1960
: 1570-1961
: 1914-1961
: 1972-1961
: 1978-1961
: 1979-1961
: 1990-1961
: 2002-1962
: 2004-1962
: 2040-1962
: 2041-1962
: 2062-1969
: 2371-1963
IS : 3444-1966
IS :3503-1966
Specification f;zr copper rods for boiler stay bolts and rivets ( revised)
Specification for~naval brass rods and sections ( suitable for machining and
forging ) ( reuis~d )
Specification for leaded tin bronze ingots and castings ( revised )
Specification for high tensile brass rods and sections ( revised )
Specification for brass tubes for general purposes ( second revision )
Specification for rolled ,brass steel plate, sheet, strip and foil ( revised )
Specification for aluminium and aluminium alloy ingots and castings for general engineering purposes ( revised )
Specification for wrought aluminium and aluminium alloys, bars, rods and
sections ( for general engineering purposes ) (jirst revision )
Specification
for wrought aluminium and aluminium alloys, forgings ( for
general engineering purposes ) ( jrst rezhiorz )
Specification for wrought aluminium and aluminium alloys, plate ( for general
engineering purposes ) ( rev&d )
Specification for wrouehr aluminium and aluminium
alloys, sheet and strip
( for general engineermg purposes ) ( revised )
Specification for wrought aluminium and aluminium alloys, drawn tube ( for
general engineering purposes ) ( revised )
Specification for structural steel ( high tensile ) ( revised)
Specitication
for wrought aluminium alloys, bolt and screw stock for general
engineering purposes ( revised )
Specification for wrought aluminium and aluminium alloys, extruded round
tube and hollow sections ( for general engineering purpose; ) ( revised )
Specification for phosphor bronze rods and bars, sheet and strip, and wire
Specification for solid drawn copper alloy tubes
Schedules for wrought steels for general engineering purposes
Specification for carbon steel boiler tubes and superheater tubes
Specification for copper plate, sheet and strip for industrial purposes
Specification for line pipe
Specification for high test line pipe
Specification for steel rivet and stay bars for boilers
Specification for steel plates for boilers
Specification for carbon steel forgings for general engineering purposes
Specification for steel bars for stays
Specification for steel plates for pressure vessels
Specification for structural steel ( fusion welding quality ) (Jirst revision )
Specification for solid drawn copper alloy tubes for condensers, evaporators,
heaters and coolers using saline and hard water
Specification for boiler and superheater tubes for marine and naval purposes
Specification for copper tubes for general engineering purposes
Specification
for carbon chromium molybdenum steel forgings for high temperature service
Specification
for carbon steel castings suitable for high temperature service
( fusion welding quality )
Specification
for alloy steel castings for pressure containing parts suitable for
high temperature
Specification for structural steel ( shipbuilding quality )
Specification for corrosion resistant steel castings
Specification
for steel for marine
boilers, pressure vessels and welded
machinery structures
Specification for chrome molybdenum
steel, seamless, boiler and superheater
tubes
Specification for steel for naval purposes
Specification for copper rods for general engineering purposes
123
xs:2s25-1969
APPENDIX
( Clause 2.2.1.1 )
ELEVATED
,TEMPERATURE
VALUES FOR CARRON AND LOW ALLOY
WITH UNCERTIFIED
HIGH TEMPERATURE
PROPERTIES
R-0. General
criteria
TYPS
steels
is given
in
_._
cr
MO
I pI sI
---~
0.25
of these
MI!
A&
2.1.
R-1. Typesof
_-
given in Table
STEELS
O-05
005
0.04
@04
_-
-.--0.20
1.50 Mu
060
-_
C
0.20
0.18
ado to 0.70
0.70 to 1.50
-_
E
0.15
0.40 to 0.70
290 to 3.25
o-t5
4*00 to 6ao
I-
0.40 to 0.70
0.04
0.40 to -0.70
0.04
0.90 to 1.15
0.04
~_.__
0.40 to 0.70
I
0.04
0.04
0.04
_
0.04
0.04
--
TABLE B.2 MINIMUM VALUES FOR THE RATIO OF 02 PERCENT PROOF STRESS AT ELEVATED
TEMPERATURES TO THE MINIMUM SPECIFIED YlELD STRENG~
AT ROOM TEMPERATURE,
Et/Es0
IN
kgf/mm2
iTYPE OF STEEL
TEMP,
.--
C and C-Mn
( Note 1)
_--
--
kZy
.-_-_-
--
1Cr-fMo
2tcr- 1Mo
-.p--
1.0
50
1.0
-I
150
0.89
0.80
o-92
0.85
-.-
0.71
0.77
0.93
og
W88
,200
0.82
0.88
0.82
124
1.0
1.0
1.0
.~-100
I--
gr-fM0
C-MO
0.93
O-89
0.85
I
I
cP94
o-89
o-90
_-
--
I
I
I
Q85
0.87
I
I
o-93
xs:2825-1969
TABLE B.2 MINIM&
VALUES FOR THE RATIO OF 02 PEIUXNT
PROOF STBESS AT ELEVATED
SPECIFIEl? YIELD STRENGTH AT ROOM TEMPBBATUBB,
TEMPERATURES
TO THE MINIMUM
Et/E20 IN kgfjmml - Confd
_________
._ .~___._____
TYPE OF STEEL
I
A
TEMP,C /
I
I
I
C and C-Mn
(Note 1)
(Except
Note 1 )
963
0.70
250
--~-
j_-
-/
/
I
I/
@58
0.49
-
400
0.53
-----__I
0.43
450
C-MO
E
__~~__F___
p-fM0
1Cr-1MO
ZfCr-1Mo
0%
0.81
I ----- 0.76
I
I
O-77
677
@&l
0.71
671
il.76
I__.
-
680
-.___-_
066
066
672
0.77
!
I
0.72
662
0.62
0.67
0.74
667
0.70
0.63
SCr-fMo
-..-_
--!
,I
i
/
300
350
@58
0.58
663
-___
0.66
1
0.59
column applies to fine-grain aluminium killed, and similar steels, ordinarily used for low temperatures
-
NOTE 1 -This
(bclow?T.j.
TABLE
B.3
AVERAGE
STRESSES
FOR RUPTUBE,
0.59
TYPE OF STEEL
TENP, C
C and
C-Mn
---
/
I
fCr-jMo
lCr-)Mo
65
169
163
.-
54
11.6
11.6
33
8-4
8.4
259
400
12.5
450
475
C-MO
!
i---
500
SCr-fM0
2&r-1Mo
--
I---
-__
190
184
13-O
144
99
@8
IQ6
7.6
7.4
53
17.6
----.__._-
-56
525
550
--35
56
35
._.
53
--___
575
,
I
21
21
32
49
3-5
660
__
21
95
2.8
125
IS : 2825 - 1969
APPENDIX
Criteria
INTRODUCTION
thernial gradients;
and
Methods
IN, PRESSURE
of Calculation
loads approaching
the plastic limit
to cause a kink to form in the shell.
of the vessel,
GRADIENTS
are liable
value of the
( see C-2.3,
<!L
... (C-1)
;[I _ (y>3
This equation
has been deduced for a beam of
rectangular
cross section subjected
to direct and
bending
loads; using the Tresca yield criterion
to
determine
equivalent
stresses it may he shown to
give the lower limit of stresses to produce
full
plasticity
in the case of biaxial stress systems.
It is, however, convenient
to use equation
(3.8) of 3.3.2.4 for the calculation of the equivalent
direct stress a,,d, that is :
and it is recommended
that the value
of n,,,,
calculated
from equation
(C.l) using this value for
a,,d should be reduced
by 15 percent
to allow
for the possible difference between the yield stresses
given by the Tresca and Maxwell criteria.
Therefore, for design purposes and provided
the highly
stressed
areas
are effectively
&r from welded
seams with a joint factor J less than 1, equation
(C.1) above should be replaced
by :
aej
...
= 1.91
is recommended
that this equation
should
continue to be applied even at temperatures where
the behaviour of the material no longer approximates to that of an elastic perfectly plastic solid.
It
test conditions
3
whereas under design conditions
The permissible
value of the bending
stresses
is, therefore,
affected by whether or not the stresses
are applied
when the vessel is under
test and,
IS:282511968
therefore, subjected to enhanced membrane stresses.
Examples of the two categories are :
local bending stresses present at 1test conditions, such as horizontal pressure storage
tank sapported on saddles ( the stresses at
the horns of the saddle ) ; and
b)
Loaded
Areas
Small
Loaded Areas-Large
C-2.3.1 Size of Areas - A loaded area is considered large when it extends over at least half the
circumference of the vessel.
G2.3.2
Permissible Value of Bending Stresses the loaded area is large as defined
by G2.3.1,
the permissible value of the bending
stresses shall be two-thirds tif the values given by
equation ( C.2 ).
When
6.4
Size
G2.4.2
Permissible Value of Bending Stresses When the loaded area is of intermediate size, the
permissible value of the bending stress shall be
interpolated linearly in respect of the size of the
loaded area between the values appropriate to
small and large loaded areas.
C-2.5 Biaxial Bending Stresses - Cases may
arise in which biaxial bending stresses are present.
In these cases the principal values of the bending
stresses shall be determined and the Tresca criterion
applied to determine
the equivalent
bending
stress, thus:
a) if the principal bending
same sign:
Qe,b = 1Jpb
b) if the principal
opposite sign
Ue,b =
l%bi+
bending
C.3a)
stresses are
...
I%bj
of
(C.3b)
stresses have
1, 2 and 3);
design
values
C.1
ALLOWABLE
LOCAL
STRESSES
IN SHELL
BENDING
045
< (2))
any
0.85
>(Bi))
allowable
local equivalent
bending stresses ( scc Note 5 )
0.5f.
043.5
f.
Design
conditions
controlling
(local
load
absent during test,
orf<05f
s1
1.3f
!27
lSr28!25-1969
Non 4 - If the loadcd area extcnda over more than t
the circumference of the vessel the allowable bending
rtnues arc reduced ( seeC-2.4 and 02.5 ).
Unit
Sjdtil
mm
mm
Zircumf&ential* length of
loading area for an external circumferential
moment ( see Fig. C.20 ).
mm
mm
NOTE 5 -The
equivalent bending stress is to be
calculated from equation ( C.3a ) or ( C.3b J as appropriate.
C.2
TABLE
NOTATION
FOR CIAUSE
SYMBOL
C&2
UNITS
f
f.
:
R
Design stress
kgf/mms
kgflmms
mm
mm
kgf/mms
Irgfbms
%b
Numerically
greater
bending stress
principal
Q8.b
Numerically
smaller
bending stress
principal
0e.b
II
or
Desc+tioa
Modulus of elasticity.
longitudinal
kgf/mms
Resultant
stress.
Resultant
stress.
circumferential
k&mm4
Rotation of a fitting by an
external moment.
Length of cylindiical
of shell.
kgf/mms
Equivalent
part
length of shell.
kgfbm
Longitudinal or meridional
bending moment per unit
circumference.
C-3.1 Introduction
Circumferential
bending
moment per unit lencth.
Longitudinal
membrane
force per unit circumference.
Notation
Unit
Symbol
Circumferential membrane
force per unit Jength.
mm
ypteye
mm
CI
C,
mm
of
cylinder
or
.
mm
Radius
kg
mm
Lpngitudina! distance of a
point in the vessel wall,
from the centre of the
loading area.
mm
Deflection of a cylinder at
load or at any point of a
sphere.
Deflection of a sphere at
the edge of the loaded
area.
radians
radians
Cyliudrical co-ordinate of
a point in the vessel wall.
Descripian
128
kgf/mm
of branch.
IS : 282: - 1969
The units given above in this clause are the
consistent units recommended for general use and
used in the worked examples. Any other system of
consistent units can be used when it is convenient.
Additional
numerical
subscripts are used to
distinguish values of Mx, M+, IV,, and Jv+ at
different positions when required.
C-3.2
Radial
Loads
on Cylindrical
Shells
C-3.2.1 Stresses at the Edge of the Loaded Area The maximum stresses are at the edge of the loaded
area. Figure C.l shows a cylindrical vessel subjected to a radial load distributed over a central rectangular area 2C, x 254.
The cylindrical shell wall of the vessel is assumed
to be simply supported at the ends, which means
that the radial deflections, the bending moments,
and the membrane forces in the shell wall are
FIG
~-EQUIVALENT
C.l
C-3.2.1.1
Of centre loading - If the loaded
area is distant d from the centre of the length of a
vessel of length L, the deflections, bending moments
and membrane forces may be assumed to be equal
to those in a vessel of length L, loaded at its pidlength.
L, is called the equivalent length and can
be found from:
LyL-y
ad=
d
L
against -
LENGTH
FIG. C.2
Lc+
VE~SSSLWITH
RADIAL LOAD OUT OF CENTRE
129
d/L
FIG. C.3
C-3.2.1.2
Determination
of
strenes - The
resultant longitudinal
stress in the shell is given
by:
fx=~*!z?$
the resultant hoop stress is given by:
f+=-i_
f7
6M+
Mx and M+ are positive when they cause compression at the outer surface of the shell.
These
quantities
depend
length
on the ratios
2CX
= z
group; 64 f
C-3.2.1.3
E$ect of internal pressure -A
conservative result is obtained for the total stresses
if the hoop and longitudinal stresses due to the
pressure are simply added to those due to local
radial loads calculated as above.
C-3.2.2 Stresses Away3om the Edge of the Lo&d
Area-Although
the maximum stresses occur at
the edge of the load, it is necessary to find those at
other positions when the effect of one load at the
position of another is required.
This happens:
circumferential
moment
130
The
numerical factor 64 is a scale factor without theoretical significance and the value of the
xpression can be found by calculation or from
Fig. C.4 when r, t and C, are known. The moments
and membrane forces are found by interpolation from the graphs of Fig. C.5, C.6, C.7 and
C.8.
Fig. C.5.
safe approximation.
Non-dimensional
of each can be expressed in terms of the
non-dimensional
The
The longitudinal
moment
MX is found from.
Fig. C.6.
The circumferential membrane force & is found.
+
from Fig. C.7.
The longitudinal membrane force .JV, is found from
Fig. C.8.
value
of
the
non-dimensional
factor
IS:2925-1969
VALUES OF r/t
Fxo. C.4
TABLE
0.4
10
C.3
VAIN=
OF FACTORS
A in the figure.
Kt AND
O-01
O-05
8
6
8
8
8:;
l-5
3
O-01
0.05
0.2
0.4
f.:
k!
3
2
1.5
200
3200
All values
K,
Negligible
5
2.5
l-75
Negligible
25
C-3.2.2.1
Variation of stress round the circumfncmc - No exact analytical treatment of the
variation of stress round the circumference away
from the edge of the loaded area is available. The
following treatment is an approximation sufficiently accurate for practical purposes.
For an experimental verification of it, see
Reference 17.
Consider a radial line load of length 2C,,
applied at the mid-length of a thin cylinder as
shown in Fig. C.9A. The maximum stressesdue
to this load at points away from it are on the
circumference passing through its mid-length as
b)
and
IS:2825-1969
c) The
substituting ( &/C,
- 5)
for the
value of 41r/Cx in the same graph.
The
other
quantities
MxjW,
actual
N+t/W,
and
O-4
0*3
M*
F
o-2
O*l
0P-T
10
a 100
1000
0.2
M+
F
0.1
0*4
l0
100
1000
Cx - 4
= Applied load
Fro. C.5
132
CIRCUMFERENTIAL
MOMENTPER
mm
WIDTH
IS : 2825 - 1969
Diagrams for hoop bending moments and for:es are printed up the page to distinguish them
Tram those for longitudinal
moments and forces
which are printed across the page.
When the centre of the load is away from
the mid-length
of the cylinder,
the equivalent
length L,, found as in C-3.2.1, should be substi-
TX, .X
4
found from the graphs
and C.16 respectively.
-0.4
10
and Nx at A can be
100
IO00
100
1000
64+(g)2
0.3
O*?
0*2
O*l
0
o*c
Kl
100
IO00
0
c 84
64#
1: f(4)
C$ - 4
IS : 2825- 1969
In these charts values of MeI W, Mx/ W, Net/W,
and .Nxt/ W are plotted against x/C, for given values
of 64 r/t(Cx/r)2 and 2&/L.
-0.4
Hoop stress f+
= $!
Longitudinal
stress fx
-0.4
loo
loo
= Circumferential
W = Applied
membrane
-04
10
100
wf(#
low
sea c&g..
64 X fX
C. = 4
Ce -
load
FIO. C.,7
134
loo0
C(9)
For explanation
Ng,
0.
lo
64
c#
and C.8.for -=
G
f ?!$_
Z,(#
4 X Circumferential
loading length
CIR~~MP~RENTIA~
MEMBRANE FORCE
PBR mm, WIDTH
1000
ISt2825=1!M9
w4
10
WOO
O-4
10
IO0
'Km0
64+&f
64+&f
O-15
O-1
0*05
0*4
IO
lo0'
For
.& = Longitudinal
membrane
m0
explanationsee C-3.2. 64 +
forcepcr
mni width
W = Applied load
Fro. C.8
LONQITUDINAL
MEMBRANE FORCEPER mm WIDTH
Diagrams for hoop bending moments and forces are printed up the page to distinguish them
from those for longitudinal moments and forces
which are printed across the page.
For a load distributed over an area 2Cx x 2C+
the moments and membrane forces at any value of
x/C, are reduced in the same ratio as the corresponding values at the edge of the load found from
Fig. C.5, C.6, C.7 and C.8 in the ratio:
Value for actual C+/C,
-V&G-fo~+/cx
loading length
= o-
Example:
A vessel is 2 540 mm diameter x 6.096
m long x 12.7 mm thick.
A-radial load W is applied to an area 304.8
mm x 3W8 mm at the mid-length of the
shell. Find the circumferential moment
at a position 609.6 mm from the centre
of the loaded area measured along the
axis of the vessel.
r= 1270 mm;
Cd = c, = 152.4 mm;
r/r=m;
C& = o-12;
= 90.
For a line load, interpolating in Fig. C.13
M&W = O-054 at x/Cx = 4.
From Fig. C.5, at the ends of a line load
when
C+lc, = 0; 64 r/t ( C,/r ) -90;
2 C,/L = 0.05
M+/ W = O-153 and when C+/ C,=
M4/W
1 0.072
304.8 mm x 304.8 mm
M+/W
I.0
over an area
atx=O.O54xE=
O-025
moment
135
___
-_
_
f!!TFt
C
--I-
I-L---WI
THE VARIATIONOF
2
FOR CHANGES
OF +
+o*os
t-44
lo
-0.050
tc
C.
FIG. C.9
HOOP BENDING
IS SMALL
O-35
W
0.3
0.25
FIG.C-1OA
l0*2
LONGITUDINAL
MOMENT F El?
UNIT CIRCUMFERENCE
Al A=M,,
0*2
M.
w
. 0.15
0.1
C!
! ! ! !\.
! ! ! ! IY!
! ! ! ! ! ! ! ! ! ! ! I
10
12
$1 r
c.
-0405
0
92
C*
FIG. C.10
LONQITUDINAL
MOMENTFROMRADIAL LINE LOAD VARIATION
ROUNDCIRCUMFERENCE
137
FIG.C-1IA
The
FIG. C.11
variation
Net
of 7
for changed
in F
ir amdl
values
of 64 f
ClRCUidFERENTlAC
MEMBRANE
FORCE PER
UNIT LENGTH AT A=N#
py.
IS t 2825- 1969
-6-2
.-0.2
Illll
III
2~. rllll
-r ! ( ! ( (
III
6#q2=0.L
-0.15
-04
hht
w
-0*05
_ _-
10
12
to*06
_ -_
0
10
2.5
3*5
- 0.1
I I
-0.15
N. t
Ti
-0.1
0905
-0*05
v
W
w
0
F&C-12A
bO6
#,r4
c-
Fm. C.12
LONOITUDINA~
MEMBUNB
LONGITUDINAL
MEMBRANE
FORCE PER UNIT CIRCUMFERENCE
AT A-NM
LOAD VARUTKW
ROUND
159
IS:2825-1969
0*3
o-2
!s
W
0.1
0.125
0e10
-0
w-i4-1
0
0
FIG. CGA
LONVTUOINAL
CIRCUMFERENCE
MOMENT
PER
AT A=Mx
mm
0.025
o-02
VALUES
y
CLOSE
0.015
FOR
so.01
ARE
TO THOSE
%
0.01
G
Fro. C.14
LONOITUDINAL
MOMENTSDUE TO A RADIAL LINE LOAD VARIATION
ALQNC CYLINDER
141
H*t
w
- 0.2
-0.05
-0915
- 0.025
NP
-Oil\
-m05
10
0.01
;(+qia
APPROX
TO THOSE
10
------I
0
FIG. C-15A
VARIATIONAL~N~CYLINDER
HOOP MEMBRANE
PER mm ?ENGTH
FORCE
AT A.=N$
-0.75
- 0.150
-0.125
- O*lOO
N,l
-W-0.075
FIG. C-16A
LONGITUDINAL
MEMBRANE
PER mm CIRCUMFERENCE
FORCE
AT A=Nn
-0.050
-0.125
- 0*025
0
.O
X
cY
la
- 0 llOO
-3.075
-0-200
$J
W
-0*!75
-0~050
-9.025
-0.125
x_
CT
;OR2c.=O.O,
I
-0.025
FIG. C.16
I
1C
143
IS : 2825 - 1969
C-3.2.3
The DeJIectiorrsof Cylindrical Shells Due
to Radial Loads - The deflections of a cylindrical
shell due to a local radial !oad are required for:
a) finding the movement of a vessei shell due
to the thrust of a pipe connected to it, and
b) finding the rotation of a branch due to a
moment applied by a pipe connected to it
( see C-3.3 j.
The deflection of the shell due to a radial load
is a function of the non-dimensional
parameters
ErB
and L/r which is given by the full lines
r/t, 7
in the charts as follows:
Fig. C.17A for values of r/t between 15 and 40.
Fig. C. 17B for values of r/t between 40 and 100.
Fig. C.18 for values of r/t greater than 100.
For a central load, L is the actual length of the
For a load out of centre: L is the equivalent
vessel.
length Le found as in C-3.2.1.
For a point load, the value of7
E.r 8
is given by
the
2C
x 2C,, where C
round branch
C-3.3.2
gitudinal
&when
...
Ci > C+
(C.4)
(C.5)
area
external
moments
are
circumferenarea Co x 2C,
W = y
acting
on
rectangles
of
sides
Ce =
centres.
For
applied
of%
C, = 1*7r,, = 2C
+*
C-3.3.3
M&mum
Stresses - The
maximum
stresses due to the moment occur at the outer edges
of the actual loaded area.
The circumferential
and longitudinal moments and membrane forces
are given by:
M = M+ -M
M4
1
dz
x = 1% - Mxz
N+ = N& - Jv+
= -
2CQ
by a distance of -3-between
For
Jvx = .G,
jY,:
7000
6000
clK)n
.V_
900
800
700
7000
600
6000
5000
c. 17c
&amble:
P
.__
15
C.17A
20
For r/t
r
i
25
30
40
4-d
FindfjEIw
1000
OIL
40
50
70
60
Less Than 40
of 8 are exclusive
i
C.17B
2 -10
on
UI.
For r/t
Between
40 and 100
80
90
100
L/r = 10,
load.
Enter L/r = 10 at right-hand
side of chart,
move ho&-on_
tally to C/r = 0 or point load,
proceed down sloping line 10
meet vertical line for r/t = 70,
then move horizontally
and
read
FIG. C.17
for
6 k=17
W
000.
1000000
900000
600000
700000
600000
500000
400000
3OoOOO
200000
150000
100000
90000
80000
70000
60000
FIG. C-16A
Example:
Find
Er
8 7
for
L/r = 5, C/r = 4,
250
= 55 000.
300
FIG. C.18
MAXIMUM
RADIAL DEFLECTION OF A CYLINDRICAL SHELL SUBJECTED TO A
RADIAL LOAD W UNIFORMLY DISTRIBUTED OVER A SQUARE
2C x 2C
Enter
the corresponding
graph in Fig.
C.9, C.10, C.11 and C.12 at this value.
The
intercept on the curve for 2CxlL
gives a value of:
&I_
= #7_
The values
for quantities with subscript
2 are tuen given by the ordinate for
%
41f
-=_-_LX
t.i,
Example:.
C-3.3.4
Rotation Due to External Moments -Y- It
is sometimes required to find the rotation of a
branch or bracket due to a moment applied to
it.
146
38
moment or i = --!_ for a longiCZ
tudinal moment, where 6, is the deflection produc1.5 M
or
ed by one of the equivalent loads W = Ct?
1.5M
acting on an area of 2C$ x 2C, as defined
G
6, is found R-om Fig. C. 17
in Fig. C.20 or C.21.
and C.18.
a circumferential
by i = - 3 t
Ce
for
A
vessel
is
2 540 mm
diameter
x 4 064 mm long x 12.7 mm thick.
Find the maximum
stress due to a
longitudinal
moment of 115 454 kgf
mm applied to a branch 356 mm
IS : 2825 - 1969
.i
and
the
For this area : c%
& 1*5/f_
z
G
-=---_=
r
la5 n;:;
- 2G
L
= f 567 kg
2C x 2C,,
4
where C, = $. = 50.8 mm
W acts
on
an
= X
area
152
= 3;
50.8
50.8
1 270
2 x 508 = 0.025
=__------4 064
096
04
c&
OgC
0.3
0.25
0.1
0*04
0.06
0.06
0.1
045
0.3
0*2
0.4
0.6
04
10
+f
4.0
Cl
c
3.0
2*5
I*0
2.0
C.IPB
FIG.
C.19
When
390
Ca
40
2
Is greater
6aO
8*0
0.04;
.
IO*0
than C.
Quantity
Values for
c@=
0
C.5
6.09
m55
x4
M
0.16
C.6
0.076
= 0.475
0.16
J$3 W
6.18
C.7
~
- o-155
0.18 = 0.861
JvxstlW
0.17
C.8
- 0.14
y
- 0.17
Hence M+s
w
IFIG. C.20
Correction factor
= value_for C@jC, = 3
Vaahiefor C@/C,aO
0.255
I._.--*_A
Figure
= 0.353
= 0.824
5cg-4
CIRCUPFERENTIAL
MOMENT
= -
Mc+
M+
=wC
w--w-
1
= 567 ( 0.09 - 0.023 )
= 567 x 0.067 = 38.7 kgfmm/mm
=w
+A!?$
1
= 567 ( 0.076 - 0.005 7 )
= 567 x 0.070 3 = 39.8 kgfmm/mm
q(
= +&
= -
LONGITIJ~N~LMOMENT
= $4
A&t/W
0,155
&t/W
0.14
x/&=5*0
and 2C,/L=O*O25 in the charts of
Fig. C.13, C.14, C.15 and C.16 for a radial line
load, and multiplying the results by a correction
factor for the circumferential width of the load as
in C-3.2.2.2.
The values interpolated from .Fig. C. 13 to
C.16 denoted by subscript 3, are :
= 0.065; Mx,/W = 0.012
M$h/w
N&/W
+ 0.025
J&t/W
0.085
t [
Nx,t
W_ 1
( - 0.14 + 0.07)
= - 3.12 kgf/mm;
. . Maximum hoop stress
-f4
148
7.88 kgf/mm
=_
W -
>
- 0.1765)
w ---~x,t
M$J
t/w
( - 0.155 - 0.021 5)
567
TX(
FIG. C.2 1
- J$
Jv+t/w
=t
Jv+
- 6Mq)
+7
..f4= -$$
= -0.62f
6 x 38.7
12.7 x 12.7
1.44
:.
f. F - - 12.7
=-
0.248 f
6 x 39.8
12.7 x 12.7
1.48
f,, 6%
IS : 2825 - 1969
Maximum
-1.728
compressive
longitudina!
kgf/mnl
Maximum
kgf/mm2
stress =
longitudinal
IC, = 3,
4
and from Fig. C.l9B, the half side of the equivalent square C, = 2*8C, = 2.8 x 50.8= 142 mm
For this area C
In Fig. C.l7B,
C,/Y 6
L/r
= 1 270/12*7 = 100;
It
whence 6Erj W = 17 000
= 0.372 mm
:. 8, = -
the slope i =
=
J-=
36,
1.82 x
Vrt
and
C7.
3 x 0.372
304.8
1.82 r,
u = --__
\GZ
= 0.003 66
radians.
C-3.4
d) Hoop
membrane force-acting
per unit
width on a meridional section ds defined
for the hoop moment M
d
A moment is considered as positive if it causes
compression at the outside of the vessel.
C-3.4.1 Initial
Development - This
clause
is
concerned with the stresses and deflections due to
local radial loads or moments on spherical shells.
Because these are local in character and die out
rapidly with increasing distance from the point of
the data derived from references
application,
8 and 9 can be applied to local loads on the
spherical parts of pressure vessel ends as well as
to complete spheres.
The full curves in each set of graphs give conditions at the edge of the loaded area where u a s.
The most unfavourable
combination
of bending
and direct stresses is usually found here.
distributed
The deflections,
moments
and membrane
forces due to the load W can be found as follows
from Fig. C.24 and C.25.
For explanation
of
these curves, s?e C-3.4.3.
For an example of their
use, see C-3.4.4.
( Fig.
C.23
and
Cl.26 ).
b)
Hoop
moment M+ -acting
cl
Mendional
numbrane force - acting
per
unit width on a normal section as for the
meridional moment M..
a) Deflection;
8 = ordinate
W.t
of curve x El,
149
IS t 2825 - 1969
a
0
o-01
0.02
0.03
@l
+
FIG. C.22
b)
4
o-3
0.L
O=!i 0*6
018
Meridional
moment M, per unit width
from Fig. C.25 and the relation:
M, = ordinate of M, curve x W.
Hoop moment M4 per unit width from Fig.
o-2
OR +
Deflections;
Mr
+6 = ordinate
b)
dt
of curve x -
Meridional
moment
use Fig. C.28 and
M,=
C) Hoop
ordinate
moment
M,
per
Eta
per unit
of M, curve x
M
co9
unit
width;
Mcos
&-width;
Mcos
of M+ curve
x ---=
use
0
z/rt
4 Meridional
width;
membrane
force
use Fig. C-28 and
Jvx = ordinate
of .Nx curve
per
unit
M cos 0
t. 47
IS : 2825 - 1969
of the branch
Et.2
x ( ordinate
of full curve
x MERIDIONAL
FICJ. C.23
e) Hoop membrane
Fig. C.25 and
N
.+
= ordinate
force per
of N+ curve
unit
width;
x -9?g
ib =
r,
due to
the external
6,
deflection
at the edge
04
1.0
1*5
2-d
2.5
3.0
3.5
C*O
FIG. C.24
-030
MERIC~ONAL
MPJMENT
*
MERIDIONAL
Mr
s=
l0.3
Nr
-2
4-z
.- 0.25
to.2
FORCE
ROM
FIG. C-22
MOMENT
M)
0.20
Nx?
w
Mx
+0*1
l*O
k5
0.15
2.0
S
0
-0*20
l-i-
+0*2or
, , , , , , , , , , , , , , , ,
, , ,
I
HOOP
I!
! ! ! ! ! ! ! !.!!
7P.Y I
! ! ! ! ! ! ! ! I
s=
kdu=b.\ / i j / j / i i i
i ! ! 1_ 1 ! ! ! ! ! !
o-5
l*O
1.5
2.0
2-5
3.0
3.5
L.0
ol!l,,t
0
o-5
1.0
1.5
dJr I
FOUND
?*O
2.5
MOMENTSAND
MEMBRANE
FORCESIN
SPHERICALSKELLSUBJECTED
TO A RADIALLOAD
FROM
3.0
FIG. C.25
1.
Gl-
F4.
C-22
3'5
6.6
IS:2825-1968
C-4. SUPPORTS
PRESSURE
C-4.1
General
AND MOUNTINGS
VESSELS
Considerations
for
FOR
Snpporr~
C4.1.1
Introduction - This clause and thei two
which follow are concerned with the supports for
pressure vessels and the supports for fittings carried
.from the shell or, ends of the vessel, with regard to
their effect on the vessel. The structural design of
supports is not included because it can be dealt
Convenient reference
with by the usual methods.
for this is IS : 800-1!362*.
The supports of vessels and of fittings carried
by the shell produce local moments and membrane
forces in the vessel wall which can be treated by
Notes and cross-referthe methods given in G5.
ences for applying these to various types of support
are included.
Fro.
(3.26
MOMENTAPPHED
EXTERNAL
SPHERICAL
TO
SHELL
c.4.1.2
Notationfor c-4
Area of effective cross section of -a stiffener for a horizontal
vessel.
a
A
b
bi
c
G .. . G
d
Descri$tion
Unit
JVotation
mm
to
the adjacent
mm
mm
end of the
mm
mm
Constants.
Distance from centroid
of stiffener.
of eflective
area
of stiffener
to tip
kgf/mm
Modulus of elasticity.
kgf/mms
kgf/mms
kgf/mm2
Nominal
Resultant
kf
Resultant horizontal
support.
mm4
Moment
mm
from 5.5.
vessel.
of a saddle
Constants.
Length of cylindrical
part of vessel.
155
IS I 2825 - 1969
Untt
Notation
Description:
mm
Ml
kgfmm
Bending moment
support.
kgf-mm
Rending moment
its supports.
M8
kgf mm
M4
kgfrnm
Longitudinal
supports.
igf/cm*
Internal
kgf/mm*
%
r
kgf/mms
mm
Radius of cylindrical
fI
mm
Radius
mm
mm
Thickness
of vessel shell.
t1
mm
Thickness
of reinforcing
t,
mm
Thickness
of ring stiffeners.
kgf *mm
Maximum
tb
mm
Thickness
km/h
Wind velocity.
kg
Weight
kg
Maximum
Jr
kg/m
mm
mm
mm9
degrees
Included
degrees
WI
W
in a horizontal
in a. horizontal
bending
ring girder
above
moment
vessel midway
in a horizoutal
vessel at its
pressure in vessel.
part of vessel.
plate.
twisting moment
in a horizontal
ring girder.
of vessel end.
of vessel.
reaction
at a support.
0*5
1.0
l-5
angle
of a saddle
2.0
s
2-5
forces
to the
acting
on a
support.
3*0
3-5
its own
44
N,I
h&&-i
lCOSB
./X
xi---CO58
+3-o
-0.2
+ 2.4
-045
+2*0
-O*l
4.105
-0.5
tr.0
0'5
1.0
l*5
2-O
2*5
3.0
3.5
3.0
3.5
S
to.6
+0*5
-0.25
-0.20
-0.15
-0.10
-0*05
FIG. C.28
MOMENTSAND
MEYBRA
,NE
FORCES
IN A
0*5
1-O
1.5
2*0
2-5
S
EXTERNAL
MOMENTM
44
1s:282!5-1969
C-4.1.3 CVind Loads 011Eqhsrd Vmels - The
windy pressure to be expected on a rall vessel
depends on its site, both geographically
and. in
relation to neighbouring buildings or Other obstruction to the wind, and on its rota1 height abcve
ground level.
The values of basic wind pressures at different
heights above ground level in the various regions
of India have been given in Fig. 1A and accompanving Table of IS : 8X-1964*.
For the purpose
of c&ulating
the external pressures acting on the
projected area in the plane perpendicular
to the
wind, these values wi!l have to be multiplied by
a shape factor of 0.7 as recommended
in Table 3
of IS : 875-1%%4*.
The wind pressure found as above is assumed
to act over the whole projected area of the vessel.
The resultant wind load, required for calculating
the reactions at the vessel supports, is assumed to
act through the centre of gravity of the projected
area.
Vibrations
due to wind effects can develop
in tall slender vessels without
lateral
support
and having relatively large natural periods of
Such vibrations may lead to fatigue
vibration.
ailure.
Vessels having a natural period of vibration
greater than O-4 to 0.8 seconds, depending on their
to be
weight
and proportions,
may require
reinforced to avoid this trouble.
Reference 7 gives a design procedure for such
cases and methods of finding the natural period
of vibration of the vessel.
It is not necessary to apply this procedure to
mild steel vessels of uniform diameter,
thickness,
and contents unless w.r/t exceeds the critical values
given in the following table:
Working
conditions,
load and loads due
in&ding
full
to pipework.
wind
b)
moment
156
50
60
30
40
20
740000 104CGO 23800 890 3i70
70
80
IS : 2ti225 - 1969
Find the resultant stresses due to these by
that the vessel wali and the
assuming
reinforcing
plate share the moments M
d
and M, in proportion
to the bquares of
their thicknesses and the membrane forces
LO thei:.
N+ and Jvr in direct propcrtion
thicknesses.
Reinforcing piates for spherica! vesseis and the
spherical parts of vessel ends can be designed by
applying the charts of C-3.4.2 and C-3.4.3 in tne
same vra,y.
BRACItE
Iv
VESSEL
FOR
VESSEL
SUPPORT
WALl
i WI
BRACKET
Fro.
of the actual
C.29
FOR
--t-
EXTERNAL
LOAD
TYPICAL BRACKETS
following procedure:
a) Find the maximum
and
Recent experimental
work, discussed in Reference 17 has shown that there is some stress
concentration
near the sharp corners of rectangclar reinfcrcing
plates.
Rounded
comers
are,
therefore, preferable.
the
maximum
A4 and Al,
4
membrane
forces .N+
moment
)cX
Fxo. C.30
SECilON
REMFORarrW
the
XX
ls:2925-1969
local loads on the snell, offer less constraint against
differential expansion between the part of the vessel under pressure and its supports, and reduce
the effect of discontinuity stresses at the junction
of the cylindrical shell and the bottom.
Skirt
supports should have at least one inspection
opening to permit examination of the bottom of the
vessel unless this is accessible from below through
sup.porting f:aming. Such openings may need to be
compensated.
In general cylindrical skirt supports should be
designed in accordance with 3.13 but t1.c: critical
stresses for buckling shou!ci be checked by the
met&&
of G5.2 for large or heavily loaded skirt
supports.
The critical. load for a conical skirt
support may be found as in C-53.1.
Skirt supports may also be applied to spherical
vessels and to the spherical parts of vessel ends.
The local stresses d.ue to skirt supports in these
positions should be calculated as in C-3.4.
C-4.2.1.1
Overturning moments on skirt sujAt any horizontal section ofa skirt support,
the maximum load per linear millimetre of the
skirt circumference is given by:
p0rt.f
Nx
~p&k$ stress
small vessels the anchor bolts can be deon the assumption that the neutral axis
bolt group lies along a diameter of the
flang?, but this assumption leads to overin the case of tall vesseis with large overmoments because the effect of the elastithe foundation, which produces an addiresisting moment, is neglected.
ports-
hi WQ
*IF?
Tl Wr,
4
W,4
W/8
6
W/C
w/12
-0.034 2 -0.014 8
l-O.0176 $OfN751
0.335
0.222
0.005 3 0.0015
8
WI8
W/16
12
w/12
W/24
-0908 27 -@003 65
-t_O$M415 +090190
Pill
afw
O+OO63 9000 185
where
r,
I-
between
supports,
F RESULTANT
F RESULT4NT
HOR!ZONTA!_
IHORIZONTA_
F RESULTANT
-t-
LOAD
iOAC
--l-
HORIZONTAL
L3AD
in
FIO. C.32
Fro. C.33
TYPICAL RINOSUPPORT
/-
TYPICALSTEELWORK
&No SUPPORT
UNDER
REINFORCING PADS,
F NECESSARY
THIS
DISTANCE
NECESSARV
(A)
Fro. C.34
160
(B)
C-4.3 Supports
zontzl Vessels
and Mountings
for Horim
C-4.3.1 General Consideration - Tiorizontal vessels are subject to longitudinal bending moments
and local shear forces due to the weight of their
contents.
IS : 2925 - 1969
POINTS
MAX 10
BM=O
IF REQUIRED
----4
I------Fxa.
C.35
TYPICAL
RING GIRDER
IS : 2825- 1969
designed
because
tests.
The mountings
and brackets
which
carry
loads supported from the vessel shell should be
designed as described for vertical vessels in G&l.
(A) SADDLE
SUPPORTS
-7-l
NEUTRAL AXIS OF
RING SUPPORT
1
-A-
-A-
-4
Wl
(C)LEG SUPPORTS
FIO.
162
C.36
to saddle supports
and for vacuum
vES#RLB
IS : 2925- 1969
C-4.3.2 Saddle Supports - Saddle supports, as
shown in Fig. C.36A are the most frequently used
type of support for horizontal vessels although no
rigorous analytical treatment of them is available.
The methods given in C-3 are not strictly applicable to loaded areas extending over the large
proportion of the total circumterence
of the vessel
The following
which is usual for saddle supports.
treatment
which is based on an approximate
analysis discussed in Reference
19. The analysis
gives a good approximation
to the results of strain
gauge tests on large vessels ( R.eference 19 ).
The included angle of a saddle support, i3 in
Fig. C.36A, should not normally be less than 120.
This limitation, which is imposed by most codes
of practice, is an empirical one based on experience
of large vessels.
work of Zick (Reference
19) applies to
Nora -The
normal thickness/diameter
ratios and errors can occur if
the method is extrapolated
to apply to large thickness/
diameter ratios.
In such casq or in cases where doubt
arises, the method to be employed in computing
stresses
due to support loads shall be agreed between the purchaser and the manufacturer.
G4.3.2.1
Longitudinal bending moments and
stresses in the vessel shell - Figure C.37 shows the
loads, reactions, and longitudinal bending moments
in a vessel resting on two symmetrically
placed
The bending moments are given
saddle supports.
by the following equations:
at mid-span MS =
the
highest
point
of
the
Atthelowest,f,=2t~loo+--&
cross
...
(C.8)
...
(C.9)
C-4.3.2.3
Longitudinal bending stresses at the
saddles-These
depend on the local stiffness of
the shell in the plane of the supports, because, if
the shell does not remain round under load, a
portion of the upper part of its cross section, as
shown in Fig. C.40 is ineffective
against longitudinal bending.
When the supports are near the end of the
vessel, so that A < r/2, the stiffness of the ends is
enough to maintain a circular cross section.
Such
shells are said to be stiffened by the ends.
The
resultant
longitudinal
stresses
pressure and bending are given by:
a) at the highest
in shells which
of the support
plane in those
at supports M, =
1 --
W,A
;+(12-b2)
4b
1 + 3z
and 4
are known,
obtained
these reduce
Cs are factors
TABLE
C.4
2t x 100 +
VALUES
C.38
from
M
---!!.K21rr2t
OF FACTORS
CONDITION
Shell stitfcned
rings
obtained
M
IC,xrt
. ..
...
Tr;liedA
SADDLE
ANOLB fj
(DEOREES)
That
by
end
or
Shell unstiffened
riXlgs
where C and
Fig. C.39.
pr
f4 =
to
A)
from Fig.
to
(C.10)
2t x 100
. ..( C.7)
due
+A!.__--L
2AL
1 -
section,
by end or
and
no
(C.11)
C.4.
Kl AND K,
K-1
X8
120
150
120
0.107
9192
150
9161
a279
163
I
I
W
A
7-i
Positive values of Md are obtained for the following forms and proportions:
Flat ends
<
0.707
<
0.44
Semi-ellipsoidal ends 2
<
0.363
: 1 ratio
FIG. C.37
Moment Diagram
(A>;)
164
The maximum
given by:
tangential
shearing
stress is
(A<5)
IS:2825-1969
=M.=W.(C,L-A)
0.35
.-0*30
k
ln
W,
3 0.25
0.20
WHEN f
FOR AL
I
nl
-1.0
I
2*0
90
I
4-O
III
$0,
64
8*0
10
15
20
VALUES OF f
FIG. C.38
165
040
= 1(HEMISPHERICAL
0.25
0*5
VALUES
A
OF
FACT&?
o-75
h
1-o
2*0
4.0
3.0
VALUES
c2
-FIG. C.39
END)
5-O
6.0
OF #
FACTOR
C3
8-O
10-O
IS : 2925- 1969
Fxa.
C.40
q=
KW
3
rt
in the shell
...
(C.13)
...
( c.14
C.5
VALUES
OF FACTOR
( Claue c-4.3.2.4
unstiffened
by
rings
by
by
ringa adjacent
to saddles
K4
SADDLE
K3
ANGLE
( DEGREES )
CONDITION
A )
Ks AND
K4
by
+<A<b
1.171
0,799
120
150
0.319
0.319
120
150
1.171
0.799
and
qe -
120
150
0.880
0.485
150
120
0.485
0.880
0.485
0380
0.401
0,297
by JS.
b) 1) At
the
horn
fi = 180 -
of
the
saddle
( where
the
by means of rings.
2) At
3) At
in the shell
( 1*15f--f,)
C-4.3.2.5
Circumferential stresses - Figure C.41
shows the circumferential
bending moments diagrammatically.
There is no rigorous analysis of
these moments and the constants in the following
stress formulae were determined
experimentally
( Reference 19 ).
shell is unstiffened
q = 0.8f
120
150
Shell stiffened
end of vessel
in the end
where fn = pD,K/Pt
x 100 in which X is the
shape factor from Fig. 3.7.
the equator
( a = 90 ) when the
shell is stiffened with rings adjacent to the
saddle.
C-4.3.2.6 For a shell not dyened by rings the lowest point of the cross section:
w,
fs= t -(b, Kti
+ lot)
***
...
At
(C.15)
167
> 8,
fe -
- w1
3% WI
4t( 6, + lot)
...
- WI
4t(b,+
lot)-
1f;c8,f,=
Values
of
6rings adjacent
2t2
1.. (C.16)
b)
shell may
be stiffened
by means ofi
12Ec, W, r
LP
...
. . . (C.17)
Fig. C.42.
C-4.3.2.7
The
f5 =
t (bl-t
at the shell,
C,K, W,rc
f, = P-F
-
K, Wl
a
. . . (C.19)
at the tip of
ring
the
remote from
the
shell, fe =
C, K, W,rd
X8 WI
..* (C.20)
___
a
effective cross-sectional
area, a, of the
( or stiffeners ) and the portion of the
+4X
BENDING VENT
EACH RING STIFFENER
ZM#Z KgWl r
WHERE n IS ?HE
NUMBER OF
STIFFENERS
MAX BENDING
MOMENT =Ma=Ks W, r1
(A)
FIG. C.41
168
(B)
to Saddle
lS:2825-1969
shell which can be assumed to act with them is
indicated
by the shaded areas in Fig. C.44A,
44B and 44C.
The numerical
values of the circumferential
stresses found as above should not exceed 1.25
times the allowable working stress in tension.
The
axis Xthrough
C-4.3.2.8
Design of saddles- The width 6,
of steel saddles ( see Fig. C.36A ) should be not
It should
less than 10 x the thickness of the shell.
be increased if the circumferential
stresses, found
from whichever of the equations (C.15) to (C.20)
is applicable, cannot be accepted.
Positive values denote tensile stresses and negative values denote compression.
0*06
0
0
l*O
0.5
I.5
2-o
2.5
3-O
t?ATIO $
FIG. C.42
LPARTS OF SADOLE
BELOW THIS LINE
OFFER NO AFPRCCIABCE
RESISTANCE TO FORCE H
FIG. C.43
169
26 i 2825 - 1969
The upper and lower flanges of a steel saddle
should be thick enough to resist the longitudinal
bending over the web or webs due to the bearing
The web should
loads as in any machine support.
be stiffened against buckling due to vertical shear
forces as for structural beams, and against bending
due to longitudinal external loads on the vessel.
I =wEcL
__f TcwcK)(Ess
7
IN PLANE
OF SADDLE
(8)
INTERNAL
RING
STlFFENERS
ADJACENT
C-4.3.3
Ring Su@orts for Horizontal Vessels Ring supports for horizontal vessels, as shown in
Fig. C.36B are used where it is important
to
ensure that the shell of the vessel close to the
supports . remains
round under load.
This is
usually the case for:
TO SADDLE
a) thin walled vessels iike!y to distort excessively due to their own weight, and
b) long vessels requiring
two positiorrs.
03
EXTERNAL
RING STIFFENERS
FIG. G.44
ADJACENT
10
SADDLE
The tangential shear stresses in the shell adjacent to the ring support are given by:
4 S
0 = 1509
C.6 VALUES
IN PLANE OF
SADDLE
INTERNALRINQ
( Fro. C.44A )
r---____~
@= 1.500
e=1200
-1
+1
$1
--
-0.052 8
0.340
170
-1
OF COEFFICIENTS
( Clauses C-4.3.2.6
RIM
rt
TABLE
o-319 w,
and C-4.3.2.7
I__----
)
RIN~SADJACENTTOSADDLE
A--__--,
External Ringr
Internal Rings
(Fig.
y-d___
8-120~
+1
-1
C.44B)
8=150
+1
-1
( Fig. C.44C )
c---e-150*
I.+ 1200
-1
-1
-l-l
+1
a.760
0.673
0.760
0.613
0.031 6
0.057 7
0.035 3
O-057 7
WO35 3
0.303
0.263
0.228
0.263
O-228
IS*28254968
The effect on stability of the local stresses near
the ends of a closed cylinder is neglected.
d/r>
C.7
VALUES
C.7.
OF FACTOR
&J
KlO
ANGEE, @l
DEGREES
n;o
0.075
60
0.035
35
0.065
65
0.031
,Votation
40
0 056
70
0.026
=.a
Azzsl
30
45
0.049
75
0.021
50
O-044
80
O-016
55
0.039
85
0.015
90
0.015
C-5.1.2
Notation
Unit
Description
mm
Average maximum
radial
departure of a cylinder from
its true cross section
Ratio,
greatest
difference
between actual and nominal
radii and thickness of shell
mm
External
diameter
of cylinder
mm
Major diameter.of
round cylinder
an out-of-
mm
C-4.3.4
L.eg Su@orts for Horizontal Vessels - Leg
supports are only permitted for small vessels by
the usual codes of practice because of the severe
local stresses which can be set up at the connection of the support to the vessel wall.
FT/rnrnz
Modulus
Eccentricity
STABILrTy
VESSELS
THE
Critical
Value off,
shell
kgf/mm2
stress
for an imperfect
stress
of material
Factor
for failure by local
buckling under axial load
Factor
for
support
type
of
edge
of cylindrical
shell
Ratio of circumferential
axial wave lengths
and
kgfmm
External
vessel
Number
of circumferential
wave lengths
in circumference of vessel
moment
acting
mm
External
t
,.,
mm
-
Thickness of shell
W
w
kg
Total
kg
Critical
axial
conical shell
degrees
Semi-vertex
cal Shell
load
of shell
kgf/mm*
mm
-
OF THIN-WALLED
axial
kgf/mm2
kgf/mms
-
of
of elasticity
on
radius of shell
Unevenness
factor
on
angle of a coni-
Poissons ratio
171
Is:2825-
1969
-$f-
$N
is a function of 4;
the values of GN
. . . ( c.22 )
1
from the chart of Fig. C.46 when _
drt
is known.
value of $
curve
Gl.SG
Range of Values
of U
Machined cylinders
3x10-4
to5x10-
Under
Axial
Compres-
sion
C4.2.1 Initial Development - A thin cylinder
under axial compression may fail in one of the
following three ways:
a) By plastic yielding when the stress in the
material reaches the yield stress.
factors &
and
by means
of
external loads and ordinary manufacturing imperfections only are present, the following typical
values of U may be used:
U is found
the factor
from the
KU from
c5.2.3
Combined Bending and Direct
Axial
Stress - The highest compressive stress occurring
in a cylinder subjected to an axial load W and a
bending moment M is given by:
fm=
&[1+~]+s-
M in the equation
above
is in
05.3 Std$lityofConicalShe~e
C&3.1 Local Buckling Unhr Axial Compession h ideal right circular frustum of a cone of constam thickness t and semi-vertex angle a will fail
by local buckling under a critical load given by:
2 x Eta cos2rx
W, 55 -_?z=
t/3(1--v)
when-
W,, z
Em, C.45
for
*I + r
= --z-*
The unevenness factor U is found as in CS1.3,
by taking I equal to slant height of the cone or
frustum.
a frustum of radii r, and r,, +
lO.0'
(I*0
6.0
S-0
L*O
?N
3-O
Unevcnncdn
Factor U - X0 00
FIG. CA6
t
( 1
173
xs:2825-1969
TABLE
C.8
COMPARISON
OF MODES
OF FMLURE
Critical
EULER
BUCKLING
PLASTIC
YreLorNo
MODEOP
FAILURL
LOCAL
Bucrir~o
fa=fr
stress
transition
Conditions
between
modes
Plastic yielding to
local buckling
Euler buckling to
local buckling
Plastic yielding to
Euler Buckling
-_ failure
of
:vy
--
TABLE
C.9
CRITICAL
STRESS FACTOR
AXIAL
COMPRESSION
( Clause c-5.2.2
C-6.
kI FOR
and Refcrexc
&.-___-..__,
Clamped
Free
Simp!y
Simpiy
1961.
4
0.25
supported
1-o
Clamped
Simply supported
2.0
Clamped
Gampcd
4.0
supported
O-02
FIG. CA7
174
Handbook
&as~c~.
mentals.
of
engineering
funda-
T:MOSHEAKO
Eild 2
End !
3.
REFERENCES
END CONDITION
c-------
0.001 92
0.04
0.06
(L H) and WAN
imperfections on buckling
under axial commession.
Mechakr,
March i 950.
DONNELL
--
0.08
--
0.1
BUCKLING
YIELDING
0.12
STARTED
044
046
FACTOR K,
BV
0*18
( 2
(C C). Effect of
of thin cylinder
Joarnal oj Applied
P 6083-617s.
Fro. C.48
4. SErnE (P). Axi-symmetrical buckling of ciraxial
compression.
under
cular cones
3ournal of Applied Mechanics, December 1956;
P 625.
5. HERB and LEYLAND. Conical vessels subject
to ejrternal pressure. Trans. I. Gem. E. 30.
1952. 65-74.
6. Sm~on (K). Pressure vessel manual.
Edwards Bras, USA.
February
3ournal of
EngineeGg
for
of anchor
July 1951.
APPEND1
problems.
Stresses
and deflections
due
to local loadings
on
shells.
Welding Journal Research
cylindrical
Supplement, July 1960.
Industy,
bolt
1959.
1942.
15
18.
Design and
pressure vessel skirt
analysis of welded
supports. Journal of Engineering for Industry,
February 1960.
September 195 1.
D-l. GENE&U
D-l.1 The ductility of some metals, including the
carbon and low ahoy steels referred to in this
standard, is significantly diminished when the
operating temperature is reduced below some critical value. The critical temperature, commonly
IS : 2825 - 1969
brane stress is sufliciently high to supply the
necessary energy.
Thus vessels in refrigerant service will not normally
require
any special precautions where the operating pressure is temperature dependent and
hoop stresses are ,small at operating temperatures.
MATERL4LS
AND
DESIGN
STRESSES
b)
That in which the pressure at low temperatures will be considerably below the pressure permitted at 0C (for ,example,
in
refrigerating equipment ).
IS : 2825 - 1969
D-2.3.1 Such equipment
shall be designed
according to 3 using design stresses in accordance
with 2.2 (see also Table D.2 ) for the highest
It shall
pressure which
may occur in it.
then
be verified that
the nominal
stresses
calculated in accordance
with 3 do not exceed
the appropriate values given in Table D.2 for all
combinations of pressure and temperature which
may occur at temperatures lower than the limiting
value given in Table D.l appropriate to the prothickness and whether stressposed material,
relieved.
D-2.3.2,
If it is found
TABLE
that
D.1
MINIMUM
( Clauses D-2.!,
POST-WELD
HEAT
TREATMENT
ALLOWABLE.
D-2.2, D-2.3.1,
OPERATING
is mandatory,
with 6.12.
TEMPERATURES
( See Table D.2 for vessels operating under reduced pressure at low temperatures )
r----
MATERIALS
------A-------7
Description
Carbon steel
Type, R;X;UX
CHARPY
V-NOTCH IMPACT
and VALUE I\SDETERMINEI)BY 7HE
METHOD GIVEN
IN IS : 1757-1961
AT TEST TEMPERATUREIN kgfm
(AVERAGE OF 3
SPECIMENS
)
Grade 1 of
IS : 2002-1962
Not specified
Not exceeding 12
-30
Not exceeding 18
Not exceeding 25
rv;;yeeding
30
-20
-10
Bolting
bars
-30
-60
-1-50
Not exceeding 25
%&c,ccding
30
-20
-10
-10
Wrought
material
only
-:
-10
Not exceeding
Not exceeding
Not exceeding
Not exceeding
Over 30
-
12
18
25
30
-30
-20
- 10
Not exceeding
Not exceeding
Not exceeding
Not exceeding
Over 30
12
18
25
30
-30
-20
-10
Not exceeding
Not exceeding
Not exceeding
Tv;y3yding
12
18
25
30
-30
-20
- 10
Grade 1 of
IS : 2100-1962
Not specified
Not exceeding 12
Not exceeding 18
Not specified
Type 2 of
IS : 2041-1962
Not specified
20Mn2 of
IS : 4367 - 1967
Grade I of
IS : 4899- 1968
Grade II of
IS : 4899-1968
Grade III of
IS : 4899- 1968
4.8
( Izod
room
at
tcmpcraturc
pl at -40C
21 at -50C
2.1 at -60%
-30
Not specified
Grade 2 of
IS : 3038-1965
-;
-20
Bars
for
bolting,
material
conforming to Grade 1 of
IS : 2100-1962
Not specified
-50
-30
Not exceeding 16
Class 3 of
IS : 2004-1962
REMARKI
Stress-Relieved
Vessels Strcssby Heat
Relieved by Hea:
Treatment
Treatment and
>Seealso
Kolting
Table 6.3 )
Not specified
Grade 2gof
IS : 2002-1962
Impact
t;tteet
ferritic
castings
MINIMUM
ALLOWABLE
OPERATING TEMPERAXUREC
r_--_--L-_
-----7
Welded
Seamless
Vcss& not
Vcsscls, Welded
mm
Grade 2A of
IS : 2002-1962
Class 2 of
IS : 2004-1962
C;w&m~inga-
THICKNESS
00
-50
-40
-30
-20
Not exceeding 30
Over 30
Not exceeding 30
Over 30
F;;yzeding
30
0
0
00
0
0
Castings
-50
-40
-30
-20
-20
-50
-40
-30
-20
Forgings
only
-20
0
Castings
-30
-40
177
IS : 2825 - 1969
D-4. DESIGN
D-4.1 Care should be taken to avold notches and
the use of details which produce local areas of
high stress, for example, lugs, gussets producing
discontinuous
stiffening, and sudden change in
section.
Rings for supporting internal equipment
or lagging should be continuous.
Vessels which will. be subject ta fi%quent
fluctuations
in
temperature
of
appreciable
magnitude
should be the subject of special consideration (, for example, refrigeration vessels where
low temperature
liquid refrigerant
is suddenly
replaced by warm refrigerant vapour at regular
intervals ).
D-5.
on steel.
D.2 ALLOWABLE
OPERATING
TEMPERATURE/STRFSS
CONDITION FOR lR%ELS
WHERE RESTIUClTONS
GIVEN IN TABLE D.l ARE NOT SATISFIED
( CIalrrcsD-2.1, D-2.2, D-2.3.1, D-2.3.2, D-3.1, D-5.1 and D-6.5)
( Applicable to cases where pressure is due solely to vapour pressure of cozrtents )
M~V~IMUM
ALLOWABLESTRESSAT TEMPERATURE,kgf/m&
-_--__~---_----~__-_.____
--,
Seamless Vessel and Vessels Stress-Relieved
Welded Vessels not Stress-Relieved
by Heat Treatment
by Heat Treatment
A --~-~------/
c-__--.------_-- 1OC Oc; r6OC -50C -40C -30%
-20C -10C OC
-60C -50C -40C -30C -20C
2.81
*
*
*
*
*
1.41
l-76
246
210
*
*
l
Not exceeding 12
1.05
2.8,
rl
*
+
*
2.46
1905
1.41
?lO
*
*
210
1.76
Not exceeding 18
@70
0.70
1.05
A.41
1.76
210
*
1.7l.i
210
2.46
281
+
*
*
Not exceeding 25
@35
PLATE THICKNESS
mm
<
0.35
078
1.05
1.41
1*7G 2.10
1.76
2.10
246
281
*
*
Post-weld
heat treatment required
1.76
2.10
246
2-64
281
Over 30
NOTE-The above table applies in the case of vessels where the vapour pressure/temperature characteristiw of the fluid
are such that the design stresses listed above are not exceeded at any temperature below the valuca given in Table D.l
for the corresponding material.
Not exceeding 30
APPENDIX
E
(Clauses 3.1, 3.1.3.2 and 3.8.2)
TENTATIVE
El.
RECOMMENDED
PRACTICE
GENERAL
TO AVOID
FATIGUE
CRACKING
c) Applications
or fluctuations
of pressure,
d) Forced vibrations, and
e) Variations in exter&al loads.
Fatigue cracking will occur during service if
endurance
limit of the material is exceeded for
the particular level of cyclic or repeated stress.
El.2 .When the expected number
of cycles of
stress during the service life of any integral part
IS:2825-1969
of a pressure vessel may exceed the endurance
limit, the level of cyclic stress and/or the expected
number
of cycles Should be reduced
to fall
reasonably within the limit.
El.3
Corrosive conditions are detrimental to the
endurance of the vessel material.
Fatigue cracks
may occur under such conditions at low levels of
fluctuation
of applied stress.
Since the tensile
strength of a steel has little or no effect upon the
fatigue strength under corrosive conditions the use
of high strength steels in severe corrosion fatigue
service will offer no advantage unless the surface is
effectively protected from the corrosive medium.
Where corrosion fatigue is anticipated it is especially desirable to minimize the range of cyclic
stresses and carry out inspection
at sufficiently
frequent intervals to establish
the pattern
of
ehaviour.
$ I.4 A detailed analysis of the cyclic stresses in
a /pressure vessel and interpretation
in terms of
satisfactory service life is usually tedious and time
When such estimates are required,
consuming.
the purchaser should inform the manufacturer.
The manufacturer
should arrange for the calculations to be made, the purchaser having access
to any part of the calculations relating to the
final assessment.
El.5
There is a lack of data on the influence of
creep on the endurance of the construction
material under cyclic stress. Where
a pressure
vessel is intended for cyclic operation within the
creep range of the material, the range conditions
should be agreed between the purchaser
and
the manufacturer
having regard to the available
service experience and experimental
information.
El.6
The
following
notes relate
to pressure
vessels which operate at temperatures
below the
creep range of the material of construction:
a) In general, a detailed analysis need not be
made when the design is based on previous and
satisfactory
experience
of strictly
comparable
service;
b) A fatigue test or tests have been made
to demonstrate
the reliability of the design;
c) The recommendations
which are detailed in
the following parts of this section are satisfied; and
d) Where strains have been determined
experimentally and shown to be below the endurance
limit for the required life.
E-2.
PRESSURE
CYCLING
E2.1
A cycle of pressure !oading is represented
by either each loading and unloading of a vessel
or any single pulsation or fluctuation of pressure.
E2.2
For a vessel which operates at constant
pressure and at a steady temperature
below the
creep range for the material, the expected number
of cycles .N due to start up and shut. down during
the life of the vessel should not exceed:
N=
l-4( 3000
[I
2K.fr- f
T)
1
*
... (E.1)
where
7-Z
the temperature
in C corresponding
to application
of the
cyclic or repeated stress;
f=
Ii-=
fr=
cyclic
E-2.3Where
at
stress
K
In
E2.4
For a pressure vessel which is subjected to
pressure fluctuations in addition to the conditions
defined in E-2.2,
the requirement
is that:
$;+
3;+-$-
+-$+...etc
dl*O...
(E.2)
where
the expected
n19 % % n,, etc, are
numbers of cycles of stress for the ranges
of pressure fluctuations;
and
N,, .N,, Ns, N,, etc, are the limiting
numbers of cvcles .calculated bv eauation
(E. 1) for the cT;;e;;ding
)anges . of
stress
cyclic
whrch
gave
2&X
< 1.1 may be neglected ).
E2.5
The ratio of the
to the limiting number
and shut-downs
ups
should be included in
cycles due to pressure
E3.
CYCLIC
THERMAL
STRESSES
E3.1
Pressure vessels which operate at elevated
or sub-zero temperatures
should be heated or
cooled slowly and should be efficiently lagged to
minimize
temperature
gradients
in the shells.
Rapid changes of shell temperature
should be
avoided during service.
The vessels should be able to expand and contract without undue restraint.
E-3.2 ,Provided the above conditions are observed
estimates of thermal stresses due to temperature
changes need not be specially considered.
Where
slow rates of heating and cooling cannot be employed or temperature
transients during service
may cause rapid local heating or cooling, the
following limitations are recommended:
During
start-up
and
shut-down
the
difference in temperature within a distance
equal to twice the thickness of the shel.1
should not exceed 6OC near discontinuities or 150% at uniform sections.
b)
IS : 2825 - 1969
E-4.
FORCED
VIBRATIONS
E-4.1 Pulsations of pressure, wind excited vibrations or vibrations transmitted irom plant ( that
is, rotating or reciprocating machinery ) may cause
vibrations of piping or local resonance of the shell
of a pressure vessel.
In most cases these cannot
be anticipated at the design stage.
It is therefore
advisable to make an examination of plant following initial start-up. If such vibration occurs and is
considered to be excessive, the source of the vibra-
tion should be isolated or stiffening, additional
support or damping
the local vibration.
E-5.
FINISH
introduced
OF PRESSURE
at the location
of
VESSELS
E-5.1 Where
a pressure vessel is intended
to
operate under cyclic load during service, fillet
welds and irregularities should be dressed smooth.
Any square edges at junctions between branches
and the inside surface of the shell should be
radiused.
APPENDIX
F
( Clause 3.3.3 )
ALTERNATE
METHOD
FOR
AND SPHERICAL
VESSELS
F-l.
DETERMINING
SHELL THICKNESSES
UNDER
EXTERNAL
PRESSURE
BY
NOTATION
F-l.1
The follolving notation is used in the design
ofspherical and cylmdrical shells subject to external
pressure:
-4 and B -
&
Factors
obtained
from the appropriate chart for shell thickness
for vessels under external pressure.
D0
= Outer
= Effective
diameter
in the
it is the
values
the
The
in mm.
length
( see Fig. F.l )
case of cylindrical
shells
maximum of the following
and is measured narallel
axis of the shell i; mm:
distance
betl,.een
head
OF CYLINDRICAL
USE OF CHARTS
F-2.
= Design
= Minimum
pressure
shell in
in kgf/cms.
CYLINDRICAL
SHELLS
Determine
StepP-From
the chart determine the intersection of the lines representing
L/Do
and, Do/t.
AXIS OF RING
h-DEPTH
OF HEAD
I---L ------a./
t--L--+--L4
FIG. F. 1 EFFECTIVELENGTH OF A CYLINDRICAL VESSEL UNDER EXTERNAL PRESSURE
180
the
IS : 2825 - 1969
Step 3-From
this intersection
point move
vertically to the material line for the
design temperature.
Step 4-Find
the value of Factor 3 corresponding to this point
of intersection.
Compute the allowable working pressure pa by
formula
pB =
SPHERICAL
a circumferential
and
connection
3)
a circumferential
third the depth
head bend line.
B=
14*220,/t
2)
SHELLS
Step2-Calculate
Step l-Assuming
a value of t, determine
ratios of Rllt and RijlOO t.
the
by the
formula
14.22
. . . F.2
Step 3-Find
the value of Factor -4 corrcspondinq to this point on the material line.
Step&-Determine
the required
moment
of
inertia
I,
from
equation
( F. 1 )
using the value of that factor A as determined above. Compare this value
of I, with I and choose a section such
that its moment of inertia is greater
than I#.
Step 4-Find
the value of Factor B corresponding to this point of intersection.
working
L3 = - --g
t + As
11-
Step S-From
this intersection move vertically
to the material line for the design temperature.
the allowable
Factor
Factor
Step P-Enter
the left-hand side of the chart
at the value of Ri / 100 t d,etermined from
Step l and move hortzontally
to the
line marked Sphere Line .
Step 5-Compute
Step l--Select
a member to be used for the
stiffening
ring.
Let its moment
of
inertia be 1.
to a ,jacket,
pres-
pa = -- --c--14.22RJt
b) See 3.3.3.4
(c).
c) See 3.3.3.4
(d).
d) See 3.3.3.4
(e).
e) See 3.3.3.5.
F-4.
STHWENING
RINGS
FOR
VESSELS
UNDER
EXTERNAL
PRESSURE
F-4.1 Intermediate
stiffening rings composed of
structural shaped welded to the inside or outside
of the shell shall have a moment of inertia about
its neutral axis through the centre of gravity section
parallel to the axis of the shell, I, not less than that
determined by the formula:
I, =
Do2L (t+A,/L)
x FactorA _.-__.~~-----~-
... Fl
14 x l-04
where
I, = required
moment of inertia
stiffening ring in mm4;
A, = cross-sectional
ring mm;
area
of
of the
stiffening
and
L = one-half
the
distance
from
the
centre line of one stiffening ring to
the next line of support on one side,
plus one-half
of the centre line
distance to the next line, if any on
All the
the other side of the ring.
distances are parallel to the axis of
the shell and are in mm.
1) anotherstiffening
ring,
F-5.
CHARTS
FOR DETERMINING
SHELL
CYLINDRICAL
THICKNESSES
OF
AND
SPHERICAL
VESSELS
UNDER
EXTERNAL
PRESSURE
Fig. F.2
Carbon
Fig. F.3
04Crl9Ni9
Fig. F.4
Fig. F.5
07Cr13
Fig. F.6
Fig. F.7
.%luminium
Fig. F.8
Al-\lg
N4)
Al-big
N5)
alloy ( Grade N3 )
Alloy
i Grade
( 3.5:;
?clg ) Alloy
( Grade
AI-Mg
N8)
( 4.5%
AIg ) Alloy
( Grade
Fig. F.ll
Copper
(sci IS:
Fig. F.12
i~luminium
ISABZT-IS
Fig. F.9
Fig. F-10
( 276 llg )
1972-1961
bronze
( see
: 1545-l 960 )
Grade
Nickel
181
FACTOR
Fro.F.2
182
IS:2825-1968
I6000
16000
14000
12000
10000
9000
6000
7000
6ooO
5000
4000
35co
3000
2500
2000
1803
1600m
1400
8
b-
1200
Y
too0 k
900
800
700
600
500
400
350
300
250
200
I60
160
140
120
100
90
80
70
60
50
C*OOOOl
0*0001
0.001
FACTOR
O*Ol
04
183
IS:282511968
o*oooo1,
O*cml
O*ool
O*Ol
o-1
FACTOR A
CHARTS FOR DETERMININGSHELL THICKNESSESOF CYLINDRICAL AND SPHERICAL
VESSELSUND~ZREXTERNAL PRESSURE,07013 TYPE OF STAINLESSSTEEL
FIG.F.5
IS I 2829- 1969
50
60000
40000
35000
30000
0*00001
0.001
FACTOR
FIG. F.7
I ? I /-H-HI
O*Ol
04
CHARTSFOR DETF.RMINING
SHELLTHICKNESSES
OF CYLINDRICALAND SPHERICAL
VESSELSUNDER EXTERNALPRESSURE,
ALVMINIVMALLOY ( GRADE N3 )
187
ISr2825-
1969
o-40
o-35
o-30
0*25
o-20
O-18
0.16
O-14
0.12
0'00001
0*0001
45t!
s loOl
O*Ol
FACTOR A
FIro. F.9
CHARTSFORDETERMININIO
SHELL THICXNENSF,S
OF CYLINDRICALAND SPHERICAL
VESSELSUNDER EXTERNALPRELIIURE,
AI-Mg ( 3.5% Mg ) ALLOY ( GRADE N5 )
189
rs:2%2!5-1969
50000
40000
35000
30000
25000
20000
16000
16000
1~000
-12000
10000
9000
8000
7000
6000
LOO0
3500
3000
l-2
F'i
l-0
0*90
0.80
Xi iWtH
2500
Pp
2000
1800
1600
1400
8
I2
L
1200
0.70
0*60
0*50
0.40
O-35
0.30
O-25
0*20
0.18
0*16
0.14
0*12
oeia
o-09
O-00
o-01
0.06
040001
0*0001
O*OOl
0.01
0.1
FACTOR A
Fxa. F. 10 CHARTS FOR DETERMININOSHELL THICKNESSES
OF CYLLNDRICALANDSPHERICAL
190
50000
35000
30000
25000
18000
14000
12000
10000
9000
8000
7000
6000
5000
4000
3500
3000
2500
2000
1800 *
1600 a
1400 e
1200 y
1-o
o-90
0.00
JO00
900
000
o-70
700
0.60
600
o-50
o-40
o-35
400
350
o-30
300
0.25
,250
0.20
O-18
0.16
"200
180
160
O-14
140
0*12
120
'100
90
80
70
60
11'
34560
FACTOR
FIG. F.ll
O*OOl
34566
O*Ol
456
50
6
o-1
VESSELSUNDER EXTERNALPRESSURE,
COPPER (see IS : 1972-1961 1
191
1.6
1.4
O.bo"
.
0.60
0'70
0.60.
, , ,
,,,w,I_
0*10
o-35
0.30
0.25
0.20
34568
0*001
FACTOR
34569
0.01
3L560
-0.1
FIG. F.12
CHARTSFOR DETERMINING
SHELLTHICKNESSES
OF CYLINDRICAL
AND SPHERICAL
VESSELSUNDER EXTERNALPRESSURE,
ALUMINWMBRONZE( see GRADE ISABZT-IS
: 1545-1960 )
192
IS : 2825- 1969
~ 5ooou
40000
35000
30000
25000
20000
16000
16000
14000
12000
8000
6000
5000
2500
2000
1600 *
1600 my
1400
1200 u
iooo
900
600
iz
700
600
500
400
350
300
250
200
160
160
140
120
100
90
80
70
60
50
0*00001
0*0001
0.001
O-01
O-1
FACTOR A
FIG. F.13
193
X8:2825-1969
I IIIIIIII
TO!I 1II
I II
I IIIIIIII
IIII :II IIII
I IIm50000
LOO00
35000
30000
25000
20000
16000
1200G
2
0*00001
45670
2
04ca
3 4 5670
0.001
345676
Q*Ol
L 5678
04
--
FACTOR A
OF CYLINDRICAL
AND SPHZRICAL
FIG.F.14 CHARTS FOR DETERMININGSHELL THICKNESSES
VESSELSUNDEREXTERNALPRESSURE,NICKEL
IS i 2825 - 1969
APPENDIX
( m711se 6.2.1.1 )
TYPICAL
G-O.
DESIGN
OF WELDED
GENERAL
b) Welding
CONNECTIONS
the appropriate
detail fromthe
shown for each type of connecshall be given to the service
which
it will be required
to
Weld
groove dimensions
and other details
bevel, angles, root faces, root radii
However,
it should
and gaps ) are not included.
he understood
that in boiler work easy access for
the deposition
of sound weld metal at the root is
pnrticularly
important
in single J and single bevel
wt-1;j.s and that these welds should be proportioned
so as to provide such access.
; for example,
of pipe connections.
G-l.2 Typical
Designs
( General ) - Notes
referred to in the figures given in this appendix may
be found at near the end of the appendix.
FIG. G. 1
SCREWED
TYPICAL
G-l.1 The
covered:
CONNECTIONS
following
a) Typical
designs
ALTERNATIVE
(FOR DlMENSlDNS
types
of
[ general
connections
), and
WELO OETAlL
are
0=2xd
a) Total thickness of shell plate plus weld should
be adequate for number of threads required.
exceed
b) Screwed
connections
should
not
thread size 14 (see IS: 554-1964).
SCREWED
FIG. G.2
SEE F1G.G. 4)
COMNECTIONS
SXH
CONNECTIONS
ALTERNATIVE
DETAIL
WELD
a) If the shell thickness f exceeds approx 15 mm, preference should be given to joint shown in Pig. G.1.
b) Not recommended where inside of vessel is accessible for welding.
4 gcmwed connections should not exceed ISP thread size If [see IS : 554-1964 Dimensions for pipe threads
gas list tubes and prcsaurc tight screwed fittinga ( rcviscd) 1.
FIG.
G.3
for
195
lsi2825-1969
13
1 14 1 16 ( 18 / 19 1
l--l-l-l
-k----17
1 20 1 21 1 23 1 27 1
I
4 If the required fillet size exceeds about 15 mm, then details given in Fig. G.5 should be used.
b) The branch should be a loose fit in the hole but the gap at any point should not exceed
3 mm or la/2 whichever is less.
lheintent of the limitation in the size of the fillet weld is to maintain the stress field induced
by welding within reasonable limits.
t-
size 14 ( see IS
: 554-1964 ).
Fro. G.4
WELDED SOCKETS
ALTiRNATlVE
Weld size
B + F I
( SCREWED )
WELD DETAILS
Fm. G.5
196
WELDBD
in welds to be avoided.
SOCKETS (SCREWED)
THE WLLOS
SHALL
Oli
ON THE LOAD TRANSMITTEO
OASCO
NOT LESS
THAN OIA OF
STUD-,
Fm. G.G
OF THEWELDS
ON THE LOAD
WELDED
SEATINGS
Sl4Al.L BE BASE3
TRANSMITTED
NOT LESS THAN
MA
OF STUD,
Its use when thermal grad&t may cause oversiress in welds to be avoided.
Recommended
for light duty vessels.
FIG. G.7
r
WELDED
NOT LESS
SEATINGS
THAN
DIA OF STUD
~trlOmm,.,AX
a) This detail iti only recommended if vessel is not subject to pulsating loads and the shell thickness does not exceed 10 mm maximum.
Recommended
for
b) Its use when thermal gradient may cause overstress in weldr to be avoided.
The weld sizes are minimum.
light duty vessels.
Fro. G.8
WELDED SEATINCM
ALTERNATIVE
Special precautions,should
be taken to minimize
Frtx.G.9
WELD
DETAIL
WELDED
SEATINGS
197
Special
precaut:ons
slmlld
Le taken
to minimize
Fit. G.10
Weld dimensions
FIG. G.11
are minimum.
WELDED SEATINGS
( Recommended
Now
mc
by welding.
SEATINGS
WELDED
j- TELLTALE
FIG. G. 12
HOt E
in calculating
WELDED
the reinforcement
required.
SEATINGS
---I
Stb
WELD SIZE
See
FIG.
Notes
G.13
WIELDEDBRANCHES
-L
-;
Backing
ring removed
;-_-_---_._--_-
on compkc!ion of welding
._-___-
if rquircd.
__--
_... __-.__~_--
I; n ibt mm
__ .______
_---.
._._ __ ___..-.
- --
.__
_-.__- 8 /
8 \;Fi
IC
IS : 2825- 1969
Set&Jotts 1,2,3,
Fm. G.15
WELDED-BIUNCHFORFLANGEDNECK
(A) BEFORE
IB) AFTER
MACHINING
&
Nom
Fxo. G.19
MACHINING
WELDED BRANCH
I
i
i
I
Fro. G.20
Fm.
WELDED BRANCH
WELD
--I
-7
t-tb
ALTERNATIVE
WELD
SlZE
G.21
may cause
WELDED BRANCH
L=tb
i-b
DETAILS
~~-~~~~~~~I~~~~
1
-
Fm.
200
G.22
WELDED BRANCH
IS I 2825- 1969
L6 mm
MIN
FIG. G.23
WELDED
BRANCH
Er6mm OR 0'7tbWHICHEVER
ALTERNATIVE
WfLD
IS LESS
DETAILS
FIG. G.24
WELDED
I
1.5 wm
See
WELD
SIZE
BRANCH
--il'bP-
L = 1,
FIG. G.25
WELDED
BRANCH
201
IS e2025- 1969
FERRED
WHERE
EOS ABOUT
tr
I5 mm
+-7
AHERNATIVE
a) The branch
WELD
b) When thermal
gradient
use should be avoided.
may
cause
DETAIL
in the welds
connecting
the reinforcement,
its
of 15 mm.
FIG. G.26
WELDED BRANCH
METAL TO BE REMOVED
FITTING REINFORCING PLATE
PREFERRED
WHERE t,
EXCEEDS ABOUT 15mm
LSEE
YOTE
3mm-4
k-
(A)
LSEE
r6mm
MIN
NOTE 6
(8)
a)
is
kss
with a maximum
FIG. G.27
202
WELDED BRANCHES
the reinforcement,
of 15 mm.
its use
IS 82825- 1969
,-
BRANCH
-SEE
NOTE 6
-REINFORCEMENT
RING
RElNFORCEMENl
WELD SIZE
C-I.5
AFTER
(8)
a) Before machining
shell.
connection
b) After machining
connection
is limited to conditions
obtained with the type of r&forcing
ring shown.
c) For alternative butt
G.76 and G.77.
1,
MACHINING
weld preparations
between
where
reinforcement
for welding
adequate
compensation
ring
branch,
and
inside the
may be
G.28
WELDED
BRANCHES
203
IS:2s25-1969
the reinforcement,
of 15 mm.
15 mm.
FIG. G.29
+bt
BEFORE
FITTING
REINFORCING
f-o_m
PLATE
whichever
of 15 mm.
\~ELDEr~
BRANCH
EXCESS
METAL TO BE REMOVED
BEFORE FITTING REINFORCING PLATE
a)
WELDED BRANCH
of 15 mm.
its
USC
IS : 2825- 1969
PREFERREO
WHERE
1, EXCEEOS
ABOUT 1Smm
WELD SIZE
ALTERNATIVE
WELD DETAILS
a) Fillet weld size E = O-7 I, or 0.7 f whichever is less with a maximum
b) Values ofdimensions
Cand D asin Fig. G.22.
c) Ses Notes 1, 2, 3, 8 and 10 on page 223.
Fm. G.32
of 15 mm.
WELDED BRANCH
MAY BE CHIPPED
AND GROUND FLUSH
REFERRED
WHERE 1,
EXCEEDS ABOUT 15mm
ALTERNATIVE
WELD
DETAILS
a) In the range lb = 14 to 20 mm the choice between afillet or a fillet plus groove weld should
depend on relative cost.
b) Weld dimensions are minimum.
c) When thermal gradient may cause overstress in the welds connecting
the reinforcement,
its USC
may be avoided.
d) Values C and D as given in Fig. G.22.
P) Filler w,-Id size B = 0.7 fr or 0.7 t whichever is less with a maximum of 15 mm.
f) SH NX~tes 1, 2 and 11 on page 223.
FIG.
G.33
~YELDED BRANCH
205
IS : 2825- 1969
--Pi-
Etb
MAX
ALTERNATIVE
WELD
where proximity
DETAILS
uf flange restricts
access.
a) Compensating
plate may be fitted to inside of vessel if desired.
Arrarlgcmcnt
of welding groove
may be reversed if desired. In the range lb = 14 to 20 mm, the choice bctwc en a fillet or a fillet
plus groove weld should depend on relative cost. Weld dimensions arc minimum.
b) When thermal gradient
may be avoided.
the reinforcement,
its USC
uf 15 mm.
FIG. G.34
WELDED BRANCH
the reinforcement,
of 15 mm.
Fro. G.35
206
WELDED BRANCH
its use
IS : 2825 - 1969
FIG. G-36
Under
Consideration
ldt,
.-_._,:.._
_^.,
.,l.,?
,,-
,,E_
FIG. G.37
~VELDED BRANCX
~VITII NECK
MIN
The welding
PIECE
207
IS I 2825- 1969
FOR ALTERNATIVE
SEE
PETAILS
FIG. G-39
REINFOXEMENT
BRANCH
RING
THE RECOMMENDED
JOINTS FOR
CONNECT!+& THE REINFORCING
ALTERNATIVE
use of this connection is limited to conditions
with the type of reinforcement shown.
a) The
WELD
may be obtained
FIG. G.38
BRANCH ( REINFORCED)
WELDED
TO PROJEC: WHEN
SET FOR WELDINQ -\
Dimensions
FIG. G.39
WELDED FLANGES
DE TAIL
ISs2825-1969.
,- + OR1Omm
MIN
l-
GENERALLY MACHINED
AFTER wELOING
TG PRU
SE1 FO
.1._
f- MACHINING
ALLOWANCE
(8)
gradient
Fio.(2.40 WELDED
in welds and/or
FLANGES
GENERA~LV MACHINED
AFTEd
WELOiNG
NOT LESS
THAN 2tb
WELD
ztb
SIZES
F,=l.S!&JT
SHOULD
NOT.EXCEED
15 mm
F2 =lsOtb,MIN
3mm
a)
NOT LEL
THAN
gradient
may
cause overstress in welds and/or fatigur when
conditions exist.
b) In certain cases a smaller limltatiwl of weld
size Fs_ equal to 1-O la is prefi rrrd.
HUBBED SLIP
ON FLANGE
of weld
FLANGES
FLY THEN JOINT
EVELLED
OR
FOR WELDING
BACK OF
CHIPPED
MACHINE0
BEFORE
MAKING INSIOE
WELOING
-4
11 k-
UP TO 15mm
(A)
-_I
12
OVER
l-15mm
iD)
ALTERNATIVE
FROFILE
OF FLANGE NECK
(2)
This connection
may also be llrcd wlwn :hrre is proccss fur wcklinl: TIO~IIimidr.
proccdu*.e should be slwh ;LSto unsure: wu~d positive root ynrtration.
Tllc weldit~g
size
IS I 2825 - 1969
NOLIMIT
L-L,
(A)
This connection
procedure
CC)
(8)
there
WELD
SIZES
PROFILE
NECK
(D)
FIG. G.44
B+F=b5t.
MIN
L= 1~51. YIN
F ANO L SHOULD
EXCEEO 15mm
ALTERNATIVE
OF FLANGE
OVER !5mm
UP TO 15mm
root penetration
from
The
inside.
welding
WELDED FLANGES
J OR BEVEL
PREPARATION
JACRET
1.
ALTERNATIVE
WELD
In certain
cases limitation
L equal to 10tsis preferred.
FIG. G.45
SHELL
DETA!L
in weld
size of
Ik
wcldipg procedure shall lie such as to ensure
sound posltlve penetration
in the joi::t.
FIG. G.46
JACKETED CONNECTIONS
JACKETED CONNECTIOKS
ALTERNATIVE
TYPES OF JOINT MAY BE
SE0 BUT THE WELDING PGOCEDURE
SHOULD BE SUCH
AS TO ENSURE
SOUNO
POSITIVE
ROOT PENETRATION
NOT EXCEED
1.51,
M,N---Cr-_sl
wl.51,
210
G.47
BEVEL PREPARATION
MN
JACKETED CONNECTIONS
In
FIG. G.48
JACKETED CONNECTIONS
IS:2825-1969
WELD SIZES
8.F,.l.5t#4
RETAINING
Fp = 1.515 MIN
F, ANO
RMG
F2 SHOULD
NOT EXCEED
limm
ALTERNATIVE
In certain
caws a smaller
limitation
FIG.
G.49
WELD
DETAILS
CONNECTIONS
ALL WELDS
TO BE
MADE OOWNHAND
a) Attachment ofjackct to vessel having a wall thickness not greater than 20 mm.
b) Weld dimensions arc minimum.
G.50
JACKETED CONNECTIONS
211
IS I 2825 - 1969
ALL WELDS TO BE
WADE DOWNHAND
E=tj*3
a) Attachment
of jacket to vessel having a wall thickness not greater than 20 mm and
where there is no access for making a weld inside the jacket space.
b) Weld dimensions are minimum.
--
10
11
; 14 ~ 15
,_-..__p_I
12
J,
__._~~
B
_
I
I
-----12
10
___/14
1 I.?
_ __._.
___--
All dimensions
Fm.
17
20
21
18
;j
in millimetres.
(A)
WHERE FLPINGE RESTRICTS ACCESSIBILIT,
THIS WELD
TO BE COMPLETE
BEFORE FLANGE IS ATTACHED
~STMOAT.
AFTER
KNOCKING
PLATE
(8)
Permissible only where both fillet welds are fully accessible for welding.
b) Both ends c,f jacket attached to cylindrical
portion of vessel.
a)
JACKET
PLATE THICKNESS
tJ
JACKET WIDTH
ON DIA
mm
A D~PENDXNO
OF
VESSEL
mm
--
31 Max
212
12
FIG. G.52
Mux
37 to 50 Max
10
31 to45
50
!
JACKETED CONNECTIONS
20
I
24
1-I 27
ISl28!2S=lB69
SUITABLE EDGE PREPARATION 10 ALLOW FOR
45-THROAT. AFTER KNOCKING PLATE OVER
-4
tt,
Lj
BETWEEN J
$Z;:;EtNCE
attached
to cylindrical
portion
of veuel.
JACKET
PLATE
:j
,
A DEPENDINO
OP VESSEL
mm
JACKET W~TX
THICKNESS
ON DIA
mm
31 Max
-_
31 to 45 Max
6
A.
37 to 50 Max
10
-.
50
12
-
Fxo. G.53
JACKETED CONNECTIONS
(A)
rA
DETAIL Al A
(8)
( For light duty vessels only )
FIG. G.54
JACKETEDCONNECTIONB
WTANK
KTWKN f LANK5
10 K SUCHTHAT THE WIZLOI
Fm. G.55
JACKETED CONNECTIONS
a) Attachment
of jacket
tion is desirable.
where
for
b) See Fig. G.41 and f43
attachment
of the angcs.
FIG. G.56
a flanged
detaiis
connec-
of weld fir
JACKETED CONNECTIONS
213
IS : 2825
- 1969
DISTANCE
BETWEEN
FLANGES
THAI
THE WELDS
ARE
\ ACCESSIBLE
T- SUCH
TO BE
FULLY
--I
-16
-23
21
15
20
20
-
-8
_I_
27
-
--
Fillet and
above
19
18
ll
a)
Attachment
ofjacket where a flanged
dots not exceed 38 mm.
b)
Weld dimensions
connection
is desirable
-,_I
25
--I-I-
10
I
I
-,-,-,-I
21 / 25 1 25 / 25
12
17
Cl
VC@
wall thickness
27
I
I
I
25
31
are minimum.
All dimensions
in millimcfres.
MAY
FLUSH
BE ORESKO
IF REOUlRED
WELD DETAIL
( Pordw
Fra. G.58
214
WHICHEVER
IS SMALLOT
3 vcncl8 only )
JACKETEDCONNECTIONS
FIO. G.59
,IACKETEDCONNECTIONS
18:2825-1969
0 PROJECT WHEN SE,
OR WELMNG.GRCUNO
LUS4i ON COMPLETIDN
WELD GROUND
ON COMPLETION
iWi4
WELD OIMENSIONS
ARE MINIMA
FLUSH
a)
FIG.
G.60
Ail dimensions
Ftc.
in millimctres.
1 6 j
ti
4 10
( 13
1 10
I I1
12
1 14
1 15 1 17 ) 20
All dimensions
FIG. G.62
( 14 1 15 ( 18 1 20
PERMISSIBLE THROUGH
1 21
) 23
1 27
/ 1.
1 B
in millimctrcs.
CONNECTION
FOR JACKETED
VESSELS
E- j3MlN
Weld dimensions
h
- B
--- 6
10
8 / 10 / 11 / 13
j 12
1 14 j 15 / 17
All dimensions
3x0.
G.63
are minimum.
PERMKSSIBLE THROUGH
14
20
16
23
18
2,
22
27
in millimctrcr.
CONNECTION
FOR JACKETED
VESSELS
215
+225mm
MN --./
DUTY
ONLV
PERMISSIBLE
0.64
VESSELS
FLUSH
Weld dimensions
ax minimum.
All dimensions
in millimetres.
Fro. G.65
PERMISSIBLE
THROUGHCONNECTION
/SEE
FORJACKETEDVESSELS
NOTE 10
(A)
(8)
Tube wall thickness
t - 3 mm Min. Weld sizeL l * I
Min.
b) Minimum distance between tubes - 25 t or 75 mm
whichever is greater.
4 The tube ends should be slightly expanded to not more
{ban 90 percent of depth to fill the holes.,
4 If the end of the tube projects beyond the weld, the
projecting position should be removed after welding.
e) It may be necessary to deposit the weld in two runs to
ensure a tight joint if the operating
conditions
are
onerous.
-+lt-
(4
&Notes
FIO. G.66
216
(8)
on page22%
CONNECTIONBETWEENJACKET
AND SHELL
Fro. G.67
IS a2025- 1959
S)
b)
c)
d)
(El
(A)
The tube ends should be slightly expanded to not more than 90 percent or depth to till the hola.
If the end of the tube projects beyond the weld, the projecting portion should be rem
arc onerous.
It may bc ncccssary to deposit the weld in two runs to ensure a tight joint if the operating
danger of burning
The preparation
shown in Fig. G.68A and G.68B should he preferred where there
&rough the tuba wall due to its thinness.
Fra.
G.68
TUBE-TO-TUBE
IA)
PLATE CONNECTIOMI
(Cl
(0)
,a) If tbe end of the tube projects beyond the weld, the projecting portion should Le removed
b) This detail is bared on the practice followed. in certain cases.
FIG. G.69
TUBE-TO-TUBE
+I-
PLATE
WELD
CONNECTIONS
SIZES
t1*3m
121
ALTERNATIVE
WELD DE TAIL
hY
(A)
(8)
G.70
after welding.
TUBB-TO-TUBI
in operating temperatute.
PLATE CONNECTIONS
217
ls:2825-1969
OR LESS
t=Smm
_cl
I+-t=TuBE
FALL
THICKNESS
(A)
(6)
t-l0=1.5t
MIN
2.01
TO
CC)
a);Thc tube ends should be slightly expanded to fill the hole not more than 90 percent of the depth.
b) When using this detail special care should be taken to ensure that the tube plate is not laminated.
4 Rsfhtcr
Welding
The detail shown in Fig. G.71B is suitable for wcldng
by processes other than the metal arc
process.
A filler rod should be used if the tube wall thickness exceeds 1.5 mm when oxyacetylene gas welding is employed and 2.0 mm when other suitable arc welding processes are
used, such as atomic hydrogen or inert gas are welding.
to minimize
the deformation
of the
FIG. G.71
1
T
-T
t,
SHOULD
BE EQUAL
OR
NEARLY EOUAL TO 12
t1 SHOULD
BE EOUAL
OR NEARLY
EOUAL
-4t,!-(A)
a? It is uncommor~
-41)_
(8)
b) Rcferc~~cc Welding
The detail shown in Fig. G.70 is suilabL* for welding by procrsscs othrr than the metal arc
process.
A hllcr rod should be used if the tube wall thickness cxcerds l-5 mm when oxyacetylene gas w, Idiug is employed and 2.0 mm when other suitable arc welding processes a=,
tlsed,such as atomic hydrogrn or inert gas arc welding.
FIG. G.72
218
IS t 2825 - 1969
(A)
FIG. G.73
WELD
e*f=t
J OH
PREf
SIZE
MN
BE LESS
IOU10
If Z, exceeds
15 mm,
detail
in
shown
FIG, G.74
~~refcrence
Fig. G.75.
should
br given
IT
to the
FIG. G.75
r TUBE PLATE
T TUBE PLATE
PREPARdTl0ti
ANGLE Of TAPER 0
ShWLO NOT
(SLOPE
SOUND POSITIVE
PENETRATION
(SLOPE
X4)
EL0 SHALL BE GACK CHIPPED
BACK
WELDED OR ALTERELV TN WELOING PROCEDVRE
LO BE SUCH AS TO ENSURE
5olJNO POSITIVE ROOT PEKTRATIGN
ROOT
fCfiALTERNATIVE
1:L)
SEE f IG. G-43
Its USCto be
cause
FIG.
overstt
G.76
avoided
when
css in w&is.
TIJBE
PLATE
TO
sllouldbe si\
tllcrmzl
gradient
en to
may
SHELL CONNEXXIOSS
Frc,.
(;.77
TIME
PI.ATE
TO
SHELL CONNECTIONS
219
ylUBE
PLATE
T TUBE PLATE
--I&-
kt-l
4 Alternative
on both
b) Accessible
fcr welding
sides of the shrlt.
SHELL
on
both
may
on one side
4
Fxa. G.78
preparation
may
bv
used but the wcldir:g procrrirlre
should br such as to ensure sound
root penetration
in the
positive
butt joint.
a) Alternative
preparation
may be
used but the welding procedure
should be such as to ensure sound
positive
root penetration
in the
butt joint if made from the outside only.
TUBE PLATE
TO
CONNECTIONS
FIG. G.79
SHELL
/TUBE
TUBE PLATE
TUBE PLATE TO
CONNECTIONS
FIG.
G.80
TUBE
PLATE
TO
SHELL CONNECTION?
PLATE
Omm
t-i-l
(A)
(8)
Thisdetail is recommended
conditions
FIG. G.81
for non-corrosive
only.
operating
FIG. G.82
(A)
Fxo. c.83
( Forforgedshapes
only)
TUBE PLATE TO SHELLCONNECTIONS
I6 : 2625- 1969
DETAIL
AT X
only.
b) The hazard of weld cracking shall be taken into consideration.
Fro.
G.84
-t
t NOTLESSInaN It
a) Weld profilca are diagrammatic only.
b) The hazard of weld cracking shall be taken into conridcration.
Fxo.
G.86
COVERS
IS t 2825 - 1969
PROCESS
ARC PLUS GA5 WELDING
OF ROOT
GAS
ARC
F017M 1
SOUARE
; TO
BUT1
WELD
12
FORM 3
S,&Gl.E- WlT WELD
! TO 28
FOFiM6
YYGLE-U
FORM
Bull
WLLO
ABOVE
28
a) These fvrms
METAL MERT
ofgap apply
RING
steels.
welding
mtthods
are
for
c) Gap widths depend both on the thickness and diameter of the pipe and on the type of filler wire
used. The gap widths indicated in the table are for guidance only.
Fro.
222
G.87
WELDING
OF PIPE CONNECTIONS
IS : 2625 - 1969
DEPOSITED
LINING
CORROSION RESISTANT
SHEE 1 LINING
CARBON
STEEL
CORROSION
FIG. G.88
NOTES*
should be a
loose fit in the hole but the gap at any point
should not exceed 3 mm or tb/2 whichever is
the lesser.
3. Special
precautions should be taken to minimize the stresses induced by welding particularly when the shell thickness exceeds about
20 mm.
4. When
5. These
connections
may also be used
there is accessibility for welding.
B,=1.5
B,=
F2=
F3 =
L =
be used with
an
9. Alternative
detail permissible
provided the
thickness or the branch of shell, whichever is
the lesser, does not exceed 20 mm.
1.5 fb
1.5 tr
16 mm nor be
1-O lb Min
__
in the figurer
10tb
15tb
tb I
and
F2 should not I
exceed 16 mm nor be less I
than tb/2.
J
Fl
connection
may
reinforcing ring.
1
1
1
I
1
1 Thc intent Of the
1 limitation in the
1 uZe Of the fi11et
when
8. A similar
STEEL
(8)
(A)
GENERAL
RESISTING
17.
IS : 2825 - 1969
APPENDIX
OF WELDING PROCEDURE
QUALIFICATION/
PERFORMANCE
QUALIFICATION
TEST
WELDER
Record of
............................................................
Contractor/Manufacturer
Welding Operator
Material
: Name ..............................
of
Joint.
Address
..........
....................................
..............................
Identification Number/Symbol
Date of Birth
........................
......................................................
................................
.Tensile Strength
........................
Fathers Name
Specifcation
......................................................
( Plate or Pipe )
Electrode Type.
..........................................
............................................................
...................................................
D&gnation
Date
...............................
Material Thickness
......................................................
(If
Preheat Temperature
pipe,
Range
dia
and
wall thickness )
...................................................
Weldirig
1.
-~~
Specimen
No.
Area
mm*
Dimensions, mm
T--~--7
Width
Thickness
Specification No.
REDUCED-SECTION
Gauge
Length
mm
Ultimate
Load, kgf
TENSILE
Tensile
Strength
kgf/mme
Date
.................................
.....................
TEST
Yield Point
Eiongation
percent
Character of Remarks
Failure and
Location
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ~...............,................,....
2.
--_-
ALL-WELD
METAL
TENSILE
TEST
_____
____________-___-_-__-_-~_
Specimen
No.
Area
mm
Dimensions, mm
Diameter
Ultimate
Load, kgf
Gauge
Length
mm
Tensile
Strength
kgf/mm2
Yield Point
Elongation
percent
Character of
Failure and
Location
Remarks
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .._........................I............................................................................................
3.
GUIDED
---
Former
Radius
mm
FACE-BEND
---___-_
Thickness of
Specimen
mm
TEST. (TRANSVERSE
Remarks
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..,..............................................................,..........................................
4.
An+dof
. . . . . . . . ........~.............
-w
224
.,............
ZZ
mm
GUIDED
ROOT-BEND
Thickness of
Specimen
mm
TEST
(TRANSVERSE
Remsuks
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . .
5.
GUIDED
SIDE-BEND
TEST
Thickncas of
Specimen
mm
FOI-KIU
RadiuI
mm
(TRANSVERSE)
Remarks
... .. .... .... ...... ...... ...... .. ...... ....... .... .......... ...... .. ....... .. ......... .... ... .... .. ......... ... ....... .. .. ... .... ...... ...... .... ... ...... .. ... .. .
6.
Description,
&cknaD
Appearance
of Fracture
Rault
mm
..a................
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..a...*...
7.
Sea
TEST
s cimen
TyqcN!~~
____
NICK-BREAK
IMPACT
Specimen
OR NOTCHED
BAR TEST
Impact Values
kgf.m/cm*
Tat
TemT_
RCrIUUb
F=:
of
. ... ...... ..... .... ....... ..... ... ...... ....... ....... .......... ..... ......... ..... .. ......... ... ..... .. .. .. ..... ........ ...... .... .. .... ..... ... ...... .... ... ....
8.
FILLET
W??LD-TEST
Tat
Fracture
teat
appearance
Resultr
Fillet
size
mm
Convexity
concavity
mm
Remarks
mm %
.
..n.........................................................................................................................................,...................
9.
SpecimCn
Type
of Etchant
MACRO
EXAMINATION
& HARDNESS
Observation
Vi&r3
I
Parent metal
._......................................
Witnarcd
Inspecting
Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . ..
Remarks
that the statements made in this report are correct and that the tat
with the requirements of IS : 2825 - 1969.
by ..*....................,.........................................................
Authority
Hardness
-Weid metal
Heat a&ted
zone
TEST
officesad
Signature
wcl&
.,.............................,...,...
For
and on b&f
of . . . . . . . . . . . .
(Contractor/ Manufacturer)
Date
. . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
225
IS : 2825 - 1969
APPENDIX
( Clause 6.7.28 )
WELDING
J-l.
GENERAL
OF
-Ii-FIG. J.l
3 mm MAX
J-2. FABRICATION
J-2.1 Preparation
- The clad material should
be protected against mechanical damages and
from the inclusion of foreign material.
While
shearing clad plates the clad side should be upwards, so that the burrs or ridges are built on the
base metal side. The cut edges shall be ground
smooth.
Clad steels may be flame-cut from the base
metal side, provided proper care has been taken
in the selection of cutting speed, gas pressure and
nozzle size. Preheating prior to the start of flamecutting is advisable in certain cases. Flame-cutting with iron powder may be of considerable
advantage, if cutting from clad material side is
considerations
necessary. While flame-cutting,
should be given to the effects of flame-cutting on
clad material particularly in the neighbourhood
of kerf. Cleaning of chromium-nickel or stainless
steel clad material or linings before successive runs
should be done with stainless steel brushes to avoid
inclusion.
J-2.2 Joints in Cladding
Applied Liihgr
The types of joints and welding procedure used
shall be such as to minimize the formation of
IS t 2925 - 1969
brittle weld composition by the mixture of metals
of corrosion-resistant
alloy and, the base material.
NOTE-&cause
*of different thermal coefficients of
exparuion of dirimllar met& caution should be exertired in desi.? and construction under the provisions of
this appendix in order to avoid difficulties in service
under extreme temperature conditions, or with unusual
restraint of par& such as may occur at points of stress
concentration.
J-2.3 Inserted
Strips in Clad Material
- The
thickness of inserted strips used to restore cladding
at joints shall be equal to that of. the nominal
minimum thickness of cladding specified for the
plates backed, if necessary, with corrosion-resistant
weld metal deposited in the groove to bring
the insert flush with the surface of the adjacent
cladding.
J-2.4 Butt Welds
in Clad Plates - For steel
clad with resistant chrome steel and austenitic
chrome-nickel
steel, the requirements shall apply
separately to the base plate and to the cladding.
The thickness specified in Table 7.2 shall apply to
the total thickness of the clad plates (see also
Tables J.1 and 5.2).
J-2.4.1
The welding procedure for butt welds
in integrally clad plate shall be qualified as provided in J-2.3 when any part of the cladding thickness of clad plate is included in the design calculations in 3. When the cladding thickness is not
included in the design calculation, the procedure
for butt welds may be qualified as in J-2.4 or the
weld in the base plate joint may be qualified by
itself in accordance with 7.1 and the weld in the
cladding joint by itself in accordance with J-2.7.
J-2.5 Fillet
and
Composite
Welds - Fillet
welds of corrosion-resistant
metal deposited in
contact with two materials of dissimilar composition may be used for shell joints and attachments
of various connections
2s
permitted
under the
respective provisions of this code.
In all types of
joints and their forms, it should be ensured that
there is a continuity of the clad material and the
heat-affected zones are sound. The qualification of
welding procedures and welders to be used on fillet
and composite welds for a given combination
of
materials
and alloy weld metal shall be in
accordance with 7.1 and 7.2.
J-2.6 Alloy
Welds
in Base
Metals -Butt
joints in base metal plates and parts may be made
between corrosion-resistant
alloy steel filler metal,
or the joints may be made between corrosionresistant alloy steel and low carbon or low alloy
steel provided the welding procedure and the welders have been qualified in accordance with 7.1
and 7.2 for the combination
of materials used.
Some applications of this rule are base metal welded with alloy steel electrodes, and alloy nozzles
welded to steel shelves.
J-2.7 Corrosion-Resistant
Weld Deposits
d
Construction
in which deposits of corrosion-resistant alloy weld metal are applied as 2 protective
covering on the surface of base metal plates and
IS : 2825- 1969
TABLE
J.l
OPE
RATIOI
WELDING
OF STEEL CLAD WITH RUST-RESISTANT
AND AUSTENITIC
CHROE-NICKEL
STEEL
( Clause J-2.4 )
B
FOR
ALLTHICKNESSESOP
CLADDING MLTAL
NO
CHROME
REMARKS
STEEL
METAL
METAL
jingle-V
or single-u
jingle-V
butt weld
a = 60
b=2mmMax
jingle-U
butt weld
b=2mmMax
r=4mm
OTO8mm
CLADDING
;ing!e-U
kLADDlNG
METAL
Single-U
butt weld
,- BACKING
butt weld
/-BACKING
METAL
METAL
METAL
For method
B, the sides adjoining
the root
face must be clear of cladding
metal for a
distance > 2 mm.
CLADDING
side
METAL
side
kLADDlNG
METAL
&ACKlNG
METAL
MINI
and
CLADDING
\METAL
1 mm MiNl[
hCKlNG
Wrlding
I BACKING
228
METAL
Welding
METAL
CL ADDING
METAL
METAL
LBACKING
and
METAL
METAL
enough
on
the
..-_ -
-____d
to ensure
backing
that:
side
is
IS : 2825 - 1969
are to be used in construction.
One specimen
from each position to be qualified shall be sectioned.
polished and etched to show clearly the demarcation between the fusion zone and the base metal.
For the procedure to qualify, the specimen shall
show, under visual examination without magnification, complete fusion in the fusion zone and
complete freedom from cracks in the fusion zone
and in the heat-affected metal.
J-2.9 Thermal
Stress Relief*
J.2
WELDING
NICKEL
ALLOYS
AND
( Clause J-2.4 )
Nickel
OPE-
No.
RATION
and Nickel
Allop
-;_
REMARKS
B
FOR THICKNESSES
OF CLADDING
METAL >
2.5 mm
JEWTable J. 1
1.
7
Welding
2.
_-
.-
the backing
Welding
side
the backing
side
LBACKING
METAL
--
3.
and
-....
,Clad side weld pt-eparation
welding
of sealing run
and
to ensure that
backing
reached,
on
the
side
is
and
b) slag
inclusions
and cracks in the root are
eliminated.
Weld the sealing
run with
a filler metal identical in kind with the
cladding
iBACKlNG
METAL
LBACKING
METAL
_-
4.
Welding
yCLADDlNG
_-
rBACKING
Welding
r CLADDING
METAL
METAL
-__-
&ACKlNG
METAL
METAL
___
IS a 2825- 1969
TABLE
J.2
ALLOYS
AND
OPR
/
,
RA1101
FOR ALL
No.
-_-. -_
~~~~~~~~~~~~
CLADDIXO
bfETAL
--__.^__.___._____I-
RPMARKI
OY
!
:_P--.-
-----
-._--___-_
,__._.-_..
-_-________
I.
7--
Weldmg
2.
the hacking
&ADDING
side
METAL
3.
and cocks
and
L BACKINGMETAL
__.__ _.._.._-.. ._ -__-_ --Welding the clad side
4.
&LADDING
--
METAL
----
--.-
of cladding
with a filler
.-_-.-__
Radiographic
j-2.10.1
v r6-vu-e
.
Examinat ia
of rlad
vessels
plate
and
J-2.10.2 RinsePlate Weld with S!rifi Cooeriqc .When the base plate weld in clad or lined cons-
230
in which
the
is used in the
bj On lined conqtruction. and on clad constructic-*n in which the base plate thickness
only is used in the design calculations,
exe-tpt a5 otherwise
prrmitted
under
J-2.10.4.
J-2.10.4 The required radiographic
examination may he made on the romplcted weld in the
base plate before the corrosion-rrsistant
alloy
Lover weld is depcsited provided all of the follolving requirements arc met:
The thickness of the base plate at the welded
joint is not less than that required by the
design calculations;
The weld rcinf~.~rccmeat ix removed dolvn
to the surface which is to be covered,
IFaving it flush wit.h the adjacent base plate,
reasonably smooth, and free from underrutting;
The corrosion-resistant
allo~~~eld deposit
is not air-hardening;
and
The completed
corrosion-resistant
weld
dcpoyit is examined b)- spot-radiography
as provided
in 8.7.2.
Such spot-radiographic examination
is to be made .only
for the detection of possible crack?.
ISr282!i-1969
J-2.11
Tightness
of AppIied
Lining
by welding.
Repetition of the radiography,
the
heat treatment, or the hydrostatic test of the vesse!
after lining repairs is not required except when
there is reason to suspect that the repair welds
may have defects that penetrate into the base plate,
in whir.+case the inspector shall decide which one
or more shall be repeated.
5-2.11.3 When the .test fluid seeps behind the
applied liner, there is danger that the fluid will
remain in place u;. il the vessel is put in service.
In cases where the operating temperature
of the
vessel is above the boiling point of the test fluid,
the vessel should be heated slow1 for a sufficient
time to drive out all test fluid fyrom behind the
applied liner without damage to tl e liner.
This
heating operation may be performed at the vessel
marmfacturing
plant
or at the plant where
the vessel is being installed.
After the test fluid
is driven out, the lining should be repaired by
welding.
APPENDIX
OF PREPARING
K-l. GENERAL
K-l.1 The surfaces to be etched should be
smoothed by filing or machining
or by grinding
on metallographic
papers.
With different alloys
and tempers, the etching period will vary from a
few seconds to several minutes and should be
continued
until the desired contrast is obtained.
As a protection from the fumes, liberated during
the etching process, this work should be done
under a hood. After etching, the specimens should
be thoroughly rinsed and then dried with a blast
of warm air. Coating the surface with a thin
clear lacquer will preserve the appearance.
K-2.
ETCHANTS
FOR
FERROUS
MATERIALS
K-2.1 Etching solutions suitable for carbon and
low-alloy steels, together with directions for their
use, are suggested as follows:
acid
Acid - Hydrochloric
a) Hydrochloric
and water equal parts by volume.
The
solution should be kept at or near the boiling temperature
during the etching process. The specimens are to be immersed
in the solution for a sufficient period of time
to reveal all lack of soundness that might
exist at their cross-sectional
surfaces.
b) Ammonium PersulphateOne part of ammonium persulphate to nine parts of water
ETCHED
SPECIMEN
by weight.
The solution should be used
at room temperature and should be applied
by vigorously rubbing
the surface to be
etched with a piece of cotton saturated with
the solution.
The etching process should
be continued until there is a clear definition of the structure in the weld.
231
ISr2825-1969
APPENDIX
Nameofmanufacturcr
2.
Name
3.
VCWI No,
of customer
FOR
REPORT
OF
RADIOGRAPHIC
..................................................................
........................................................................
Material
................................................
.....................
Radiograph
Serial No.
method
of numbering
No.*
radiographs,
vcascl have
to
longitudinal
shown
thickness
Intcrprcta!ion
and Remarks
seam,
seam,
the position
Example:
refer
in
C) Following
2L would
number 2.
taken
see Note.
to circumferential
been
Ggnaturc of Manufacturers
Inspecting Authority
Material
NOTE - Numbering of Radiographs ( For use in Radiograph No. column of the Report Sheets only).
1C would refer
number 1.
Electrode
Office Seal
*For suggested
EXAMINATION
Examples of radiograph
the foregoing procedure
numbers based on
would be:
the
radiograph
2615/16_indicating
covering the unit length between positions
15 and 16 on the second circumferential
seam.
indicating the radiographs
lL-31/32(R2)covering the unit length between positions
31 and 32 on the first longitudinal seam
following second repair.
IS:28259i&B
AP,PENDIX
( Clause 8.3.1.1 )
I.
MANUFACTURE
Name ofthe
......................................................
Inspecting
...........................
Type ofvessel(horizontal
or vertical
...................
of vessel ( Intended
Working
pressure ...........................
Working
temperature
efficiency factor
Shell plates
use or application,
Materials
Tensile strength
Heat
treatment
stress relief or
normalizing )
Whether
( material
Design
..........................................
Whether
Elongation
out, if any,
Dimensions,
r---*-
mm
Area
Gauge
Width Thickness
test reports
Specimen
No.
Dimensions,
Diameter
mm
Ultimate
Load, kgf
mm
2.
Area
mma
ALL-WELD
Gauge
Length
mm
.........
circumferential
.................
( mention
Ultimate
Load, kgf
if any..
................
..................................................................
report
Whether
TE8Tt3
.......................................
.......................................
TEST
Yield Point
TENSILE
Tensile
Strength
kgf/mm*
( MECH
TENSILE
Tensile
Strength
kgf/mma
METAL
composition,
..........................................................................
construction.
REDUCED-SECTION
mm% Length
or
No. 8c Type).
..................
Details of heat treatment
if any (to be attached as ..................
an enclosure )
..................
Calibration
and dimensional
Check on vessel
qualified ..........................................
1.
Girth
Chemical
.....................
to seams during
welding procedure
..............................
........................
II. PRODUCTION
Spe;$en
i *
.........................
.....................
of manufacture
................................................
) ................................................................................................
Details of radiography
temperature
.....................................................................
teatprarure
test
.......................................
by
..........................................
( preheat, .....................................................................
Preheat
temperature
.................
..........
Girthorcircumferentialseam
T(%: o~;m~ongitudinal..
specification
HHdrauhc
ydraubc
Witnessed
......................
of construction
........................................................................
duty, etc )
.........................................................
0.
...........................
& addrar
DrawingNo. ...................................................
Design pressure..
( Thickness ). ................
authority
Overall
....................
Brief description
Joint
Dia(insideoroutside).
....................................
purchaser
.........................
No.ofshells8~drum.s..
Identification
TEST
Manufacturers
Purchasers
AND PRODUCTION
OF MANUFACTURE
PRO FORMA
Elongation
percent
Character
Elongation
percent
Character
of
Remarks
of
Remarkr
fla;i.d
TEST
Yield Point
*pila.o;d
233
3.
Former
Radius
mm
Angle of
Bend
SPg-
GUIDED
FACE-BEND
TEST ( TRANSVERSE
ThicJmess of
Specimen
mm
RemarkI
. .. ...... ..... .... ... .. .... ..... .... ... ... .. . .. . ...... ... ... .. ...... .... ....... .. ........ .... ...... ..... .... ..... .... ... ..........................................
4.
Angle of
SPg-
ROOT-BEND
TEST ( TRANSVERSE
Thickness of
Specimen
mm
Former
wu
mm
Bend
GUIDED
Remarks
. .. ... .. ....... ... .... ... .. .... ..... .... .... ...... .... . ........ ...... ... ...... ....... ...... ..... ... ... .... ...... ..... ........ ... ...... ...... ..... ... .. ... .... .. ...
5.
sea.
A&of
GUIDED
Former
Radius
mm
SIDE-BEND
TEST
(TRANSVERSE
Thicknesd of
Specimen
mm
Rema&
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ..*.........................................................................................................
--
6.
NICK-BREAK
TEST
Description,
SPg
Appearance
of Fracture
Result
..a.......
7.
IMPACT
OR NOTCHED
BAR TEST
. ...... ..... .. . ... .. .... ... ..*..*...... . .. ..... ....... .. . ..*............... .. ... ... ....... ... ..... . ... .. . ... ... ...... .... .. ... ... ... .... ........ .... .. .. .. ..... . ..
8.
MACRO
specimen.
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ...*..
&d
EXAMINATION
6 HARDNESS
TEST
Remarks
Observation
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
&rti6cdth8ttheparticuhuIcnteredinti
out in dee
with the pro&ion
rt are correct.
of IS : rx
2 5.1969.
The war-p,
.......................~......................
inspectiOn and
Signature
OKice seal
Designation
titc
teata have
of mun&turcr
been
ISr2S25-
APPENDIX
( CZause
1969
N*
0.5 )
following:
a) The I corrosion allowance
parent metal if there is
the lining failing, and
b) The remaining corrosion
parent metal if it were
lining.
N-3.1 Periodicity
of. Inspection
N-3.1.1 The maximum period betkeen inspections should not exceed one-half of the estimated
remaining safe operating life of the vessel, which
requires deduction of 50 percent of the remaining
corrosion allowance from the last measured
minimum thickness in computing the allowable
working pressure.
In cases where part or all of the vessel has a
protective lining, then maximum period between
inspections should be determined from a consideration of any previous record for the lining during
similar operations and in consideration of the
*SUN
alsoSection31 of the Factoria
allowance on the
not protected by
CorrosionRate Percent
of Minimum Wall
Period of Inspection
not to Exceed
r-L-%
Years
>lO
$6
24
$10
& 8
&6
34
2
3
4
5
:]
,8
:;
e>
N-3. INSPECTION
N-3.0 Vessels constructed in accordance with
this code shall be permitted to operate under the
conditions for which they were designed for a
with this
period determined in accordance
appendix and where this and each subsequent
period is elapsed the vessel should be inspected as
in the following paragraphs land the allowable
conditions for service and the next period of
inspection established.
If the conditions of operation are changed, the
allowable working pressures, or temperature or
both and the next period of inspection should
be established by these new conditions.
If both the ownership and location of the vessel
are changed, the vessel shall be inspected as
required in this appendix and the allowable
conditions of service and the next period of
inspection established.
on the protected
any likelihood of
SpCt;ol Cases
N-3.1.5.1 Vesset not in continuous serviceThe periods for inspection referred to above
assume that the vessel is operating with normal
shut-down intervals. If the vessel is out of service
for an extended interval, the effect of this change
in condition may be considered in revising the
data for the next inspection, which was established
and reported at the time of the previous inspection. If the vessel is out of service for a continuous period of one year or more, it should be
given an inspection before it is again placed in
service.
N-3.2 Inspection
for Corrosion
235
under
N-3.1 by any suitable
method
or as
follows.
N-3.2.1 The depth of corrosion
in vessels
subjected to corrosive service may best be determined by gauging from protected surfaces within
the vessels, when such surfaces are. available.
These protected services may be obtained
by
welding corrosion-resistant
strips or buttons to the
corrosion susceptible surfaces of the vessel and
removing the strips during inspection.
when strips or buttons cannot be used because
of electrolytic
action
or other reasons, small
holes may be drilled from the corrosion susceptible
surface at suitable intervals to a depth equal to the
metal thickness allowed for corrosion, and these
holes plugged with protective material that can be
readily removed to determine from time to time
the loss in metal thickness as measured from the
bottom of these holes.
N-3.2.2 When the depth of corrosion cannot be
readily
determined
otherwise,
holes may be
drilled in portion of the metal where corrosion is
expected to be the maximum and the thickness
obtained by taking thickness gauge measurements
to the next 06 mm below the gauge reading or
any suitable method that will not affect the safety
of the vessel may be used provided it will assess
the minimum
thickness
accurate
to within
08 mm.
N3.2.3
Where the area in the vessel is excessively corroded, the average of the least thickness
within that area may be considered as the thickThii thickness should be used
nes of the metal.
as a basis for computing the allowable working
pressure and for determining
the corrosion rate
at that location.
N-3.2.4 Isolated corrosion pits may be ignored
provided their depth is not more than 50 percent
of the thickness of the vessel wali and the' total
area of the pits does not exceed 45 ems within any
20 cm diameter circle.
N3.2.5
Comction of Corrosion RatsIf on
measuring
the wall thickness at any inspection,
it is found that an inaccurate
rate of corrosion
has been assumed, the rate to be used for the next
period should be suitably modified to conform to
the actual rate found.
N-3.3 Inqection for Defects
N-33.0 The parts of the pressure vessel which
need to be carefully inspected depend on the type
of vessel and the operating conditions to which it
is subjected.
The
inspector
should
suitably
modify the requirements
given under this paragraph to meet the special needs peculiar to local
All surfaces before inspection should
conditions.
be thoroughly cleaned.
N3.3.1 SM.r -All
surfaces of the shell plate
shall be carefully examined for cracks, laminations,
and other injurious defects.
N-3.3.2 End-Plates-The
inner surface of the
knuckle radius of domed ends, etc, when not rotected by lining should be carefully atamin J for
236
Check
of Dimensions -The
vessels
be examined for visible indication of disand if any such distortion is suspected, the
dimensions of the vessel should be checked,
N-3.5 Safaty and Prerrure Relief De&em TThe safety valves and other protective devices,
such as rupture discs and vacuum valves, where
used, should be checked to see that they are in
proper condition.
This inspection
in the case
of valve will normally
include a check on the
required operation at the set pressure, a check
that the proper spring is installed for the service,
and that the discharge header and outlets are
free of loose corrosive products or other stoppage.
N-3.6 Temperature
Mearuring
DeviceaTemperature
measuring
devices where used for
determining
metal
tern erature
in excess of
450% should be checked Por accuracy and general
condition.
N&7fJ$mble
ISr2825-1888
N-4. COMPUTATION OF PROBABLE RATE
OF CORROSION
N-3,8 Record
of InBpection
b)
4
4
4
f)
made
after
ADDITIONS
ALTERATIONS,
M~ufacturct
.................................
........................
De&P-
Original hydrostatic
w..
......,
........
............................
...................... . .......
Owner..
Thickness
at critical
points
I
Service..
Location..............................
Strviu ...........................
Date.
Location
Service ...........................
Date ...........................
Serviu..
Date..
..............................
Location.. ............................
............................
Date of
mqection
Location.. ............................
Maximum
metal
temperature at
critical points
*
--
Maximum
corrtion
allowance
remaining
.........................
.........................
Calculate-d
allowable
working
p&sure
Date ...........................
..........................
.........................
Date of
next.
inspection
Signature 05
Inspector
me
position of thtye critical points shall be marked up on a sketch or a copy of manufacturing drawing to be at u&d
to tllis record.
23t
xsr2825-1969
under the provisions of this code and under proper
supervision. Complete records of repairs, alterations and additions shall be made and maintained
for future reference.
All welding should be done by qualified welding
operators who have demonstrated their ability
to meet all requirements of the welding and under
conditions that will prevent excessive stress
developing in the vessel. Where we!ding has
been done on vessels that have been stress-relieved
in accordance with the provision of this code,
the parts affectedshould be stress-relieved wherever
it is required by this code. If stress-relieving is
not required and is not done, the joint efficiency
bhould conform to that permitted for a class 3
,vessel.
N-5.1 Welded Joints and Plates-Repairs
to
welded joints, cracks and to.minor plate defects may
be made after chipping out a U- or V-shaped
groove to the full depth and length of the crack
by filling this groove with weld metal.
N-5.2 Corrosion Pito - Isolaned corrosion pits
may be chipped out to sound metal and filled up
by weld metal.
N-5.3 Corroded or Distorted Flange Faces Corroded flange faces should thoroughly be cleaned
and built up with wel,d metal and remachined
in place to a thickneSs not less than that of the
original flange. Corroded flanges may also be
remachined in place without building up with
weld metal, provided that all metal removed in
the process comes from a raised face and does
not reduce the thickness of the main portion of the
&urge.
flanges
N-5.3.1 Warped
Flanges -Warped
which cannot be remachined or flanges which
have becomedistorted due to excessive tightening
of the flange bolts should be replaced with new
flanges welded on in accordance with the require. ments of this code.
N-5.4 Cracks at Tapped Opening-Repairs
to cracks at a tapped opening merely by chipping
out, welding or re-tapping is not recommended.
238
TEST
AMENDMENT
SEPTEMBER 1977
NO. 1
TO
of
(c) ] -
Note 2, line 3 ) -
Substitute
,,tx
mms .
(3),
dejnition of symbol A ) -
Substitute mm for
( Page 43, clause 4.4, deJinition of symbol CF)- Substitute the following
for the existing matter:
bolt pitch correction factor
CF =
bolt spacing
2. ( bolt diameter ) + t
The value of CF shall be, however, not less than 1.
E
( Page 44, clause 4.4 j - After the definition of symbol FL and before
the sign of equality = *insert the notation f .
of
dqhition
( Page 44, clause 4.4,
6, > 63 mm for b > 63 mm .
Jymbol G,
Substitute h, for ( h, .
line 7 ) -SubstitWe
and
col I and II ) -
Substitute W for Cw
Tfor
( Page
last sentence) -
Substitute
second sentence ) -
as far as
Unless otherwise specified the out of straightness of the shell shall not
exceed 0.3 percent of the total cylindrical length in any 5 m length.
( Page 75, clause 6.12.2.5,
for yield point .
( Page 78, clause 6.12.4.2,
[Page
103,
line 8 ) line 5 ) -
clause 8.7.1.1
(c),
last tow ) -
line 4 ] -
20 mm.
Substitute
Substitute -$for
dejinition of fn ) -
19 mm for
f .
line 2 ) -
Substitute
(Pup115,
116nd117,~ubkA.1)
TABLE
MATEBIAL
S~OITIOATION
GBADB0B
DESIBHATION
A.1
CATEOOBY
ME~EANICAL PEO~ERTIES
~__--_-h___-~
Cli~ZXL
COMPOSITION
( see TABLPJ
B.1 )
Tensile
Strength
Yield
Stress
hfin
kgf/mm*
ho
kgf/mma
Bzo
Mi?r
Percentage
Elongation
Min
on Gauge
Length
= 5*65~/5
STEEL
IN TENSION
1:o
1:
2%
2%
&I
;5
11.5
S%
400
4%
4&
4:o
5?0
5;;
5%
UP
UP
5f705 $0
Plates
Is : 2002- 1962 I
IS : 2002.1962 2A
Is : 2002-1962 2B
IS : 2041-1962
2OMo55
IS : 2041-1962
IS : 1570-1961
18: 1570-1961
20Mn?
15Cr9OMo55
Cl5Mn75
IS
I8
I8
I8
Is
Class I
Clam 2
Class S
Class 4
20Mo55
A
A
B
A
D
A
37
42
52
48
W55Rao
@50R40
050Ra0
28
26
25
20
20
12.3
14.0
17.3
16.0
12.3
12.9
159
16.0
11.9
14.7
16.0
10.4
10.8
13.3
15.3
95
9.8
121
14.3
8.7
9.0
111
13.2
7.8
8.1
10.0
12.3
7.5
7.7
9*5
11.9
7.2
74
8.3
11.5
5.9
5.9
5.9
11.2
4.3
(3
4.3
.10.8
3.6
36
3.6
7.7
_
5.6
_
3.7
_
-
_
-
_
_
52
50
42
so
so
2s
20
20
25
l?S
16.6
14.0
17.3
16.6
14.0
17.0
l&6
IS*0
15.4
16.6
11.8
14.0
16.0
10.7
12.8
15.2
9.8
11.6
144
8.9
lJ;O
13.8
8.4
8.3
13.4
8.1
5.9
13.0
5.9
4.3
12.6
4.3
3.6
11.7
3,6
8.6
-
5.8
-
3.5
-
37
44
50
63
48
0.50Rz,,
O.50Rtr,
0*50Ra,,
0*50Rz,,
28
15
21
15
20
12.3
14.6
16.6
21.0
16.0
11.3
13.4
15.3
19.3
16.0
10.4
12.4
14-l
17.8
16.0
9.5
11.3
12.8
16.1
15.3
8.6
10.2
Il.*7
147
14.3
7.9
9.3
10.7
13.4
13,2
71
3.5
9.6
12.2
12.3
6.8
60
9.1
11.5
11.9
o.3
7.7
8.3
8.3
11.5
5.9
5.9
5.9
5.9
11.2
4.3
4.3
4.3
4.3
10.8
3.6
36
3.6
3.6
7.7
5.6
3.7
_
._
-
_
_
-
_
_
_
_
_
50
50
so
32
20
20
16.6
16.6
16.6
16.6
16.6
16.6
l&6
16.6
16.0
16.6
15.2
166
14.4
16.4
13.8
16.1
13.4
15.8
13.0
15.3
12.6
149
11.7
12.7
8.6
9.6
5.8
7.0
3.5
4.9
3.2
_
2.3
146
14.2
13 6
12&8
12.1
11.5
11.1
lox7
10.4
100
9.7
8.6
5.8
3.5
7.0
4.9
Forginga
: 20041962
: 20041962
: 2004-1962
: 2004-1962
: 1570-1961
18 : 2611.1964
I8 : 1570-1961
15Cr9&o55
lOCr2Mol
A
A
A
A
B
D
E
T&es,
IS : 3609-1966
Is
: 3609-1966
1%Cr - )%Mo
Eu$
Norma-
and
Tempered
2tcr - l%Mo
Tube
Normaend
lized
Tempered
20Mo55
Pipem
a44
24
950/Rzo
14.6
49
25
95O/R2o
16.3
156
15.0
14.5
14-O
13.5
12.8
12.6
123
12.0
11.6
11.3
9.6
: 1570-1961
IS : 1914-1961 32 kgf/mm2, Min
46
25
95O/Rzo
15.3
15.3
14.6
13,6
12.8
11.8
11.0
10.6
103
10.0
9.6
77
5.6
3.7
32
0.50Rze
950/Rzo
10.6
9.8
9.0
82
7.4
6.8
6.2
5.8
5.6
5.0
4.3
3.6
IS
43
0*50Rae
95O/Rzo
14.3
13.1
12.2
11.0
100
9.2
8.3
7.9
7.6
5.9
4.3
3.6
32
O5OR2,,
9.8
9.0
8.2
7.4
6.8
6.2
5.8
5.6
5.0
4.3
3.6
I8
: 1914-1961
IS : 2416-1963
Tensile Strength
43 kgf/mm2, Min
Tensile Strength
32 kgflmmg, Min
Tensile Strength
950/&o
10.6
( Continueff)
TABLE
MATERIAL
SPEOIFIOATION
GRADE OB
DESIGNATION
CATEQORY
CBEzm
COMPO-
aIT.ION
(xc TABLE
B.1)
IS: 1978-1961
IS
: 1979-1961
A.1
ALLOWABLE
STRESS VALUES
MECHANICAL PROPERTIES
----\
~-_-__----.h____
Tensile
Yield
Percentage
Strength
Stress
Elongation
Min
Min
Min
kgf/mms
kgf/mms
on Game
LengthRzo
B 20
= 5.65j/x
18
20
21
25
31.6
33.7
33.7
42.2
176
19.7
21.1
24.6
St 30
St 32
St 37
422
44.3
464
29.5
32.3
366
35
17
17
15
St
St
St
St
POH CARBON
AND
LOW
ALLOY
STEEL
IN TENSION -Co&
DP
UP
UP
UP
UP
UP
UP
UP
UP
&
:oo
l?o
26O
IZO
300
3&
3t705 4%
105
11.2
112
14.0
105
112
112
14-o
9.9
11.2
11.2
13.9
9.0
10.1
10.8
12%
8.2
9.2
9.8
115
7.5
84
9.0
10.5
6.7
7.6
6.4
;::
9.0
i40
14.7
15*4
140
1+7
15.4
1YU
147
154
14.0
14.7
15.4
138
14.7
15.4
12.6
13.8
15.4
11.5
12.5
141.
10.1
8.2
10.2
10.1
11.9
15.5
6.2
77.27
.
6.g
.
UP
UP
4F5
5nO 5%
;I;
;:;
10.8
11.8
13.4
83
8.3
8.3
5.9
5.9
5.9
96
:I:
62
9.6
7.7
4.4
7.5
2.7
9::
111
140
8.5
5.5
6,7
::4
2.7
2.7
::f
5.9
5.9
36
3.6
UP
UP
UP
UP
5;
5?5
f%
-.
castings*
IS : 3038-1965
IS
: 2856-1964
Grade
Grade
Grade
Grade
Grade
Grade
1
2
3
4
5
6
g ;,w-;;;
32:
43
::
15
13.7
11.7
13.0
122
13.0
15.7
A
A
21
25
20
18
10.5
12.2
h
B
C
32;
13.7
116
13.0
12.2
13.0
!57
137
11.0
130
12.2
13-o
15.7
11.9
13.0
15.7
11.2
13.0
157
10.6
12.5
15.7
9.6
11.5
89
10.6
80
9.6
7.3
8.7
67
8.0
;;
10.4
11.8
8-6
98
7.9
90
8:;
6.8
7.9
6.5
7.4
2:;
4-2
f5
;Tb
37
2.6
7.2
4.9
?4
1.7
-.
;9
IS : 1990-1962
055&e
0*55Rs0
26
23
12.3
140
12.3
140
11.5
13.1
St 42-S
St 55 HTW
A
A
42
50
24
29
23
20
14.0
166
140
16.6
13.6
16.4
123
148
98
11.7
9-O
107
8.1
9.6
IS
St 42-W
23
23
14-O
14.0
13-O
11.8
9.8
9.0
8.1
2;;;;
A
A
42
-
14.0
146
140
166
13.0
16.4
11.8
14.8
9.8
11.7
9.0
107
81
96
Grade
Grade
Grade
Grade
Grade
1
2
3
4
5
0*50Rso
0.50Rso
0.50Rso
0*50R,,
050Rs0
12.3
14.0
14.6
156
166
11.3
12.9
13.4
144
15.3
10.4
11.9
12.4
13.3
14.1
9.5
10.8
11.3
12.1
12.8
8%
9.8
10.2
Il.0
11.7
7.9
9.0
9.3
100
107
71
68
7.1
6.5
I.4
;:!j
9.1
;:;
8.3
22845
14.6
16.6
14.6
16.6
136
16.1
12.3
146
9.8
11.7
9.0
IO.7
: 2062-1962
IS : 3039.1965
IS
: 3503-1966
IS : 3945-1966
Grade A-N
Grade B-N
::
2
37
42
44
;;
48)
For additional
88::
9-l
9.6
;:;
5.9
59
5.9
5.9
5.9
3.6
3:;
3.6
3-6
-
-.
inspeLtion as detailed in Note to Table 2.1, a quality factor of 0.9 shall be used and the above stress values increased
PrInted
Delhi
AMENDMENT NO. 2
OCTOBER 1978
TO
IS : 2825- 1969 CODE FOR UNFIRED PRESSURE VESSELS
Alterarations
Sl
No.
1.
Sl
No.
5.
7.
design of
the
2.
8.
4.
*Criteria for
earthquake resistant
structures ( second revision ).
Gr 2
1
Sl
Sl
.NO.
d\m.
15.
16, clause
3.3.3.4(c)
[ Page
number
the clause as 3.3.3.2(a).
] -
Re-
16.
[ Page
17, clartse 3.3.3.4(d)
number the clause as 3.3.3.2(b).
] -
Re-
17.
1) the total
length
of intermittent
wcldiIlg on each side of the stiffening
ring shall be not less than one-half
the
outside
circumference
of the
vessel, for stiffening
rings situated on
the outside. However,
at any location
of the stiflening
ring there shall be
welding between the shell and at least
one side of the stiffening
rin,e.
The
maximum
unwelded
length ;on any
side shall not exceed
8 timrs
fhe ,I
vessel thickrless for external rings and
12 times
the
vessel
thickness
for
internal rings as shown below:
Material
added
for compensation
shall
ha\ e approximately
same coefficient
of
thermal
expansion
( say 85 percent ).
The thickness
of compensating
pad shall
be limited
to the nominal
thickness
of
shell or head
as relevant.
-An)- area
contributing
to compensaticn
shall be
attached
to shell or head by full penetration welds.
( Pa,ge 35, infotmol
table under dnrrs(,
3.8.9.1 ) - Substitute
the follolving
for the
existing table:
.Ifittittrrtm Tltiiktt~~ss
( Branch .\bttlitrnl Si:t-
21.
18.
19.
20.
] ) -
Renum-
mm
111111
15
20
25
3L
40
50
65
80
100
125
150
200
250
300
350
400
450
500
600
2.4
Nom-The
value
increased
by the
corrosion allowance.
Renumber
22.
( Page
"'4
2.7
1
3.1
3.6
3.9
4.7
5.4
3.
;:2
6.9
8.0
8.0
8.8
8.8
8.8
10.0
IO.0
given in the table is to be
amount
of any required
planes
3.8.5.1 General - At
all
through the axis of the opening
normal
to
the vessel surface
the cross-sectional
area
requirements,for
compensation
as calculated
below shall be satisfied:
Material
in added compensation,
or in
a branch,
should have similar mechanical and physical properties
to that in the
24.
the
be made by
from
plate
sub-clauses of
for valve
wherever
it
the
26.
( Pages
Substitute
clause:
:2.
33.
34.
35.
a) The circumferential
seam shall be
radiographed, for a total length of
three times the diameter of opening
with the centre of whole at mid
length.
Defects thaf are completely
removed in cutting the hole shall
not be considered
in judging the
acceptability of the weld.
( Page 66, clause 6.3.2.1,
Substitute
the following
sentence:
27.
31.
36.
Joints
28.
37.
( Page 67,
( Page 81, clause 7.1.4, jirst sentence ) -Add the following new matter after the first
sentence:
for temperatures
less than
0C the qualification
shall be valid for
thickness from 1 to 1.1 times the thickness of test piece.
6.4.2.5
Edges which have been flamecut by hand shall be cut by machining
or
chipping
for
a distance
not less than
1.5 mm.
29.
30.
if in gas shielded
metal
arc
welding
(MIG)
or gas shielded
tungsten
arc
welding
(TIG)
a
change is made in the composition
of the gas and a change in the
electrode from one type to another
or from non-consumable
electrode
to consumable
electrode
and vice
uersa, or an increase of 25 percent
or more or a decrease of 10 percent or more in the rate of flow of
shielding gas.
However,
38.
39.
41-
lines 3 and
above the
51-
Sl
Y 0.
Sl
No.
thickness of the plate
abo\-e the other .
-30.
2,
Sul,s[tifIg
&me
2Ommfof
permits,
one shall be
7.1.5(c)(l),
30mm.
lillf 2 ] -
41.
42.
the
14.
Jirst and
following
Two
47.
48.
49.
50.
(EDC
the
transverse
tensile
test
Ada
if
the
) -Delete.
When image
7.2.6.5
Radiography
is acceptable
in place of mechanical
testing for manual
metal arc or gas shielded tungsten arc or
combination processes.
43.
53.
54.
When special
55.
the
48)
Prlnted
Delhi
AMENDMENT NO. 3
JULY 1979
TO
16:
2tQ!j-1%9
Alterationa
Sl
Sl
No.
NO.
8. [ Page 83,
Sub+
aType of joints* for Type of job~ts .
2. ( Pag# 8 ) -
foot-note
of Class 1
vasels and categories A and B only nf Class 2 and
For categories C and D, derails shown
3 vessels.
in Appendix
G or equivalent
shall be used, as
ap@icahle to the relevant class of the vessel.
Substitute the
following
for the
existing
matter:
1) Double welded butt joints with full penetration
Substitute
matter:
the
following
g6.4.11 Plates
Seams in plates
forming provided
non-destructive
forming.
the following
b) Permitted
c) if in arc welding
joints a backing
for Class
3 vessels
the following
b)
(c) ] -
Substitute
matter:
of single welded
strip is omitted.
la permitted
c) Special attention should be paid to the examination of the plate edges before and after
welding.
tell-tale
. . . . . . . . . ..a ( 3.32 )
(d) ] - Substitute
for the existing matter:
the following
butt
Substitute
notes for the existing note:
the reinforcement
required.
in
Sl
$1
;vi .
NO.
the
24. ( Pup 218, Fi.c. G.72 ) -Substitute
Collorzirlg for &e existing figure and the
notes thereunder:
into account
required.
in
SEE NOTE
REFFRENCE
WE LOINC
l-77
considera-
1
-f
G.40(B) ] -Add
the
19. [ Puge 209, Fig.
followirtq
note at the end and renumber
the exiskng note as note (a):
b) Permitted
(6)
(A)
It shall not be
a) tt is the thickness of the tube.
less than 2.5 mm.
b) I~ is the original plate thickness.
c) ts is the plate thic knrss after bonging.
ta
should not be less than I,.
d) It is uncOmmon
for this detail to beused if
the thickncrs of the tube or tube sheet exceeds
4 mm.
e) Rrfiw~cc Wtlding
The detail shown in Fig. C.70 is suitable for
welding by processes other than the metal arc
process.
A-filler rod should be used if the
tube wall thickness exceeds 1.5 mm when oxyacetylene gas welding is employed and 2.9 mm
when other suitable arc welding processes are
used, such as atomic hydrogen or inert gas arc
welding
the follow-
AMENDMENT NO. 4
TO
MARCH 1982
VESSELS
Alterations
Sl
No.
Sl
No.
APPENDIX P
[ Clause 3.12.1 (d) ]
DESIGN OF JACKETED PORTION OF VESSEL
Pl.5 Typical jacketed connections are given
in Fig. G.45 to G.66 of Appendix G.
Pl. SCOPE
P-l.1 The rules in this appendix cover minimum requirements for the design and construction of the jacketed portion of the vessel. The
jacketed portion of the vessel under analysis is
defined as the inner and outer walls, the closure
devices and other parts within the jacket
which are subject to pressure stresses.
P2. TYPE
TION
JACKETS
AND
NOTA-
P-2.1 Csnventional
Jacket ( see Fig. P.1.
and Fig. P.2 )
a) The normal configuration of conventional jacket is as shown in Fig. P. 1,
Type A. This assures the most efficient
heat transfer to the maximum surface
area of the vessel.
b) An often used variation of this configuration is made ( see Fig. P. 1, Type B )
by dividing the straight side into two or
more separate jackets.
OF
JACKET
CLOSURE
CLEARANCE
BETWEEN
SPIRAL
BAFFLE
AND
JACKET (DEPENDENT
UPON
FABRlCATlCN
TECHNIQUES)
TYPE
p.
TYPE
0, OUTER
INNER
DIA
OF_
SHELL
TYPE
II
JACKET
BAFFLE
WELDED
INNER VESSEL
Fxo. P.l
SPACE
TO
CONVENTIONAL
JACKETIN CROSSSECTION
I------L------------rl
min. LESSER
TYPE
TYPE
Fxa. P.2
CONVENTIONAL
JACKET
2
I---
til
PITCH = 1..Sdi
_I
I
Fro. P.3
Fro. P.4
FIG. P.5
FLATNESSSECTION
P-2.4 Notation
Unit
D~J
mm.
mm
mm
mm
Jacket space.
Inner diameter of shell,
Outer diameter of shell.
Inner 3diameter
of the
jacket.
mm
kgf/mmz
inner
diameter
of half
pipe coil.
Modulus
of elasticity of
material
at operating
temperature.
kgf/mmr
mm
DI
DO
DcscrijMon
Symbol
Um
kgf/cm2
kgf/cms
to
mm
Maximum
allowable
stress value.
-Weld joint fact
Design length
jacket
section.
Poissons ratio.
operating
Maximum
pressure in jacket.
Maximum
operating
pressure in shell.
Thicknessmember.
of
closure
Descri)tion
Symbol
Unil
11
mm
Thickness
wall.
of outer jacket
mm
Thickness
of inner
Symbol
Unit
Description
f,J
mm
t r*
mm
vessel
Wall.
t rc
mm
ENLARGED
VIEW OF VESSEL-WITH
DIMPLE
JACKET
Fta.P.6
DIMPLEJACKET
4
DETAIL
AT A
T-t-r--
I
I
OETAIL
Fro. P.7
P-3. DESIGN
CRITERIA
P-3.1 Conventional
Jacket
P-3.1.0 Design
shall
comply
\vith
the
app!icable
requirements
of the code except
\vhere otherwise provided for in the appendix.
between
e)
xf P
XJ ---x t,* -
x D~J
0.5
1,
. . . . ..
P-3.1.4 De&v
for Jacket
1,
j-cl
.-a
(P.5 j
stress is
4UO t,j x
3+
25u I,, x
3 --
(P.61
Design of Shell
+ 400 t,] x
IS
P di
3+
3
... ... ( p.71
250 t,sj x
sfress
1) the longitudinal
. . . . . . ( P.3)
f8* =
D1 3
400 x 11, x
f-*mxpt:x3
p-3.1.5
Minimum
weld size requirements
are as detailed in Fig. G.45 to G.59.
I..
P di
O2 -
f-St= Toa3
P-3.1.4:2 Closure
P-3.2
of Half Coil
( p-1 1
inner
G.49,
types
The
shall
comparison
-~
P-3.2.3
. . . . . . (P.2 )
-T
7
in
load
P-3.1.4.1
Closures of Type 3 of Fig. P.2
( Fig. G-55 modified ) shall be used only for
Type C of Fig. P.l jacketed vessels and with
further
limitation
that t,j does not exceed
15 mm. The required mimmum thickness for
the closure bar shall be greater of the following:
t,, = 0.086 6 x A x
like fin on
P di
200x t,j x 3
and longitudinal
CloJures
tr, = 2 ( trJ )
Design
effect
P-3.2.2.1
A half coil is a part of torous
for which stresses have been analyzed
by
Timoshenko . It can be shown that maximum hoop stress in the coil will occur at Ihe
junction with the shell and is
has an
P-3.2.2
A = --
the coils
finned tube.
Also
f84 =
6
2 AP do
300 t,,,r
. . . . . . (P.ll)
( Negative
value
of
/,_P = (p - p)
need not be considered
as this refers to
high
internal
pressure.
Bending
moment due to internal
pressure is insignificant compared
with direct membrane
forces
which
must have already
been
n!lowed for the hoop stress calculations.
./,r, =fsz
tfss
critical
analysis
Cylindrical
Theory concept may be followed.
... ...
Maximum
Epivalent
S.fc1
fSlx .Ll
It is prudent
allowable
value.
-i-f&t
Stress at
Coil
a) uniform
(fs,
Xfcl)
to rl~cck that
*rJ mln
this islrithin
2 (a)--lh<fiwm
( P.16 )
. .. .. .
.Non-unifootm spacing
... ...
where
s!,acing of
p ( (12-j- t)
100 x f
P-3.3.1.4
Case 2 (b) of sfa_ys ( see Fig. F. 7 )
the
and
of the staying
(P. 13)
The adopted
thickness
corrosion
and manufacturing
(P.
17)
stays.
tJ
sidl
allowances,
include
etc.
P-3.3.2
Dimple Connecting Welds -The
weld
attachment
is made
by fillet welds around
holes, or if the thickness
of the plate having
hole is 3 mm or less and hole is 25 mm or less
in diameter,
the holes may be completely
filled
with weld metal.
The allowable
load on weld
shall equal the product of the thickness of plate
having
the hole, t~he circumference
or perimeter of hole, the allowable
stress value in tension
of
the
material
being
welded
and
joint
efficiency of 55%. The connecting
welds shall
be checked for shear and tear failures.
P-3.2.7
One difficulty
leading
to failure of
the bottom end of the half coil has been traced
to be Steam Hammer
when steam is used
The steam
intermittently
inabatch
process.
entering
a cold vessel causes
condensate
to
accelerate
round
the coils and hammer
the
exit branch and coil ends.
For this reason the
coil length should be limited to not more than
three turns in series ( see Fig. P.9 ). The exit
nozzle should be swept rather than right angular and care taken
in design of steam trap
manifold.
P-3.3.1
=CX
of staying,
spacing
P-3.3.X .3 (he
rfa3.r ( sfe Fig. P.7 )
f St+
...
spacing
b) non-uniform
P-3.2.6
Vessel Boffoms - It is extremely
difficult to cut a half coil to suit a hemispherical
or
conical vessel bottom.
Preferable
methods
in
this regard
shouid
be decided
between
the
manufacturer
and designer.
The recommended practice
is to arrange
pattern
of coils
radially
like hub spokes and rim of a wheel.
Dimple
a; the centre
~0
P-3.2.5
As a steam coil may be subjected
to
vacuum
( ifstearn is turned off j there are any
possible
c~v
of pressure
to vacuum
in coit with pressure
to vacuum
in the shell
and this gives 4 distinct
limiting
cases in the
region of the coil.
There
are further
2 cases
in the region where there is no coil corresponding to vacuum
or pressure in the vessel with
atmospheric
pressure
outside.
By analyzing
the stresses in details as indicated
above,
it is
quite advisable
to analyze the six conditionsto
determine
the worst one.
P-3.3
deflection
( P.14 )
Shell
3XW
--. ~---4 x x I,12
. . . . . . (P.15)
cj For
fl? = fs?
stress at edge,J,,
. . . . . . ( P.12)
-i-f@
P-3.2.4
.iIaximum
Shell Junction
hfaximum
P-4.
CONSIDERATIONS
OF STIFFENING
EFFECT
OF JACKET
ELEMENTS
( see Fig. P.2 to P.6 )
P-4.1
Calculations
IUaximum
working
for Elastic
pressure,
Buckling
P =
Jackets
Dimple
Plate Thickness
. . . . . . ( P.18 )
7
P-5. FABRICATION
P-4.2
Calculation
P-4.2.1
for Plastic
Case I -
mum permissible
\then
working
P,=200xf
P-5.1
dance
5, the
pressure
maxi-
1
0.2 D,
1 _ L--
1.5c
1+
--
.*. ( P.19 )
>
P-5.4 Proper
is mandatory.
10~ f,,jD,
factor.
x q
0
x 100 ( see Fig. P.4 ).
Case 2 -When
p = Greater
of zDl*
P-6.
> 5
or
f x t,s2*
L*
... ...
applicable
for pinholes
in the
welds
APPLICATIONS
( P.20 )
P-4.2.3 In vacuum
vessels the stiffening
effect of the jacket elements ( half pipe coils,
heater channels, etc ) may be taken into consideration in calculating
the whole shell. For
elastic buckling analysis the permissible pressure will then be greater, in proportion to the
of inertia ( taken about the axis
moment
through
the appropriate
centre
of gravity
X-X, or X-X ) and for plastic deformation
analysis the permissible pressure will be greater in proportion to the cross-sectional
areas
with and without the jacketing elements.
*This formula
is particularly
distance between stiffeners is small.
testing
300
of the code.
..
Any radial
welds
in closure members
shall be butt-welded joints penetrating through
the full thickness of the member and shall be
ground
flush where attachment
welds are to
be made.
x 100
P-4.2.2
parts
P-5.5
Di max - D1 min
7
a) For ovality cr = 2 X
Di max f D1 nun
b) For flatness C = g
applicable
is given by:
with
Deformation
<
Fabrication
-For
high
temperature
applications
NOTE
thermal
expansion
differentials
should be considered between the metals
used in the vessel and
the jacket, and difference in thicknesses between the
vessel and the jacket walls, and for temperatures
beyond
300C the jacket be fabricated
from a
metal having the same coefficient of expansion
as
that used for the inner vessel.
when
Printed
Delhi
AMENDMENT NO. 5
OCTOBER 1988
TO
IS : 2825 - 1969 CODE FOR UNFIRED PRESSURE VESSELS
[ Page 75, clause 6.12.2(a) ] Substitute the
following for the existing matter:
a) intended for containing lethal* material;
[ Page 75, clause 6.12.2(g) ] Add the following new items after 6.12.2(g).
h) intended for transport of flammable or
toxic material; and
j) when required by the statutory authority.
( Page 76, Table 6.3 ):
a) Material Group 2a Substitute Sum of
alloying elements, that is, Cr, Mo and V 080 Max
for 6 Residual or other elements 0.80 Max.
b) Renumber material group 2a as 2.
c) Renumber material group 2b as 3.
d) Delete the present material group 3.
pressure means
pressure due
[ Page 14, Tables 3.1, 3.2, 3.3 and 3.4 ( see also
Amendment No. 2, Sl No. 11 ) ] Retain the
tables with all the existing matter.
[ Page 21, clauses 3.4.6.1 (a) and 3.4.6.2(a), line 4
( see also Amendment No. 2, Sl No. 12 and 13 ) ]
Suhstitute 3.3.3.1 for 3.3.3.3.
[ Page 35, clause 3.8.7.1 (b), line 2 ] Substitute P2 ( 50 mm nominal bore ) for P 112 size.
( Page 36, clause 3.9.4, last line ) Substitute
P2 ( 50 mm nominal bore ) for size P 112.
( Page 65, clause 6.2. 5,first para ) Substitute
the following for the existing para:
Any person who wishes to qualify for welders
performance test under this code, shall not be
below the age of 18 years and shall have adequate
experience or training.
( Page 71, clause 6.4.10, last sentence) Substitute the following for the existing sentence:
If the forming or bending operation takes
place in hot condition, no subsequent heat treatment is required, provided during the last operation, it is uniformly heated to a temperature
within the normalizing range.
[ Page 71, clause 6.4.11, First sentence ( see also
Amendment No. 3, Sl No. 6 ) ] Substitute the
following for the existing sentence:
6.4.11 Plates Welded Prior to Forming Seams
in plates may be welded prior to forming provided
they are examined radiographically throughout
the entire length after forming. In the case of
class 1 and 2 vessels, the seams shall also be
inspected by magnetic crack detection or dyepenetrants.
( Page 71, clause 6.5.1, last sentence ) Substitute the following matter for the existing
sentence:
8.5.1(a) For low temperature vessels, in addiTack welds shall either bet removed completely
when they have served their purpose or their tion to the test coupon plates mentioned in 8.5.1,
stopping and starting ends shall be properly pre- each other shell course shall also be provided
with a coupon plate sufficiently long for testing
pared by grinding or other suitable means so that
two
sets of impact test ( one for weld metal and
they may be satisfactorily incorporated into the
one for heat affected zone ). One set of tests shall
final weld. Tack welds shall be made by qualified
be conducted to cover 5 seams.
procedures and welders, and shall be examined
visually for defects and, if found to be defective,
*See1.3.1.1(a) regarding clarification of the word
shall be removed.
lethal.
Gr 9
8.5.1(b)
I?& vessels other than covered
under 8.5.1 (a), any one test plate shall be selected
by the inspector for all tests described in figum
under 8.5.1.2 of the code except for all weld
metal
tensile
test.
[ Page 99, Fig. 8.5(A) ] -
Relete.
P-2.2.1 Notation
Unit
fo1
kgf/mm*
fos
kgf/mm
fat
kgf/mm
Total hoop
shell
for
fs1
kgf/mms
Substitute
Isa
kgf/mm
Longitudinal
stress in
the shell due to vessel
pressure
fse
kgf/mms
far
kgf/mms
to 28
line 4 ) -
kgf.m
the following
Description
Symbol
Substitute the
Substitute
the
a
b
mm
el
es
[ Page 195, Fig. G.l, foot-note (b) ] -- Substitute CP2( 50 mm nominal bore ) fey csize 1).
Page 195, Fig. G.2, foot-note (b) J - Substitute P2 ( 50 mm nominal bore )foy 6 size 14.
[
[ Page 195, Fig. G.3, foot-note (c) ] - Substitute sP2 ( 50 mm nominal bore )fof size 1).
( Page 196, Fig. G.4, foot-note (d) 1 tute P2 ( 50 mm nominal bore ) for <size 1).
S acing of
e 2
1L
spacing
I ( Fig. P.6
dimples as per
( Non-uniform
of
dimples )
)
Constant concerning
load conditions
kgf/mm*
the
fe
kgf/mms
f ed
kgf/mms
Maximum
stress in
dimple jacket wall.
kgf
Substi-
Amendment No. 4, page 1, clause P-2.8(4 ] Substitute the following for the existing item:
fSL
stress in the
the
P-3.3.2.1
( &ndm&
h%. 4, page 3, clauss P-2.4 ) Substitute l/mfor l/m.
( Amendment No. 4, flags 4, Fig. P.6 ) - Delete
the two existing figures given ori the right hand
bottom on this page and add the following
new figures.
( Amendment No. 4, page 7, clause P-3.2.4;squarim P.13 ) - Substitute the following for the
existing equation:
f*' =f8l'+frt'+fcl*
fc1 +fat
--x31
7.1 Manufacturers
xfa +fi1 x
P.13 )
( Amendment &ix 4, PagG 7, clau~s P-3.3 ) -Substitute the following for the existing clause:
... (
t,l Min = C x
spacing of stays
166 xs)
... (P.14)
4~
spacing
i@Ey*
Responsibilities
XfOI
QUALIFICATIOiVS
of
(P.15)
qualification
7.3.1.4 Any major change in weld preparation details for low temperature ,operation and
single-sided j oint.
7.3.3 Fillm Metal - The filler metal classification to be used on the production weld should be
same as the one used for procedure qualification.
Any appreciable variation in the filler metal
classificatjon from the one used for the procedure
wiI1 rec@re requalification. In case of single
welded joint, a change of more than one-third in
the diameter of electrode for root run of manual
metal arc welding requires requalification for low
temperature operation.
X2.2.4 Overheadposition - Plate in horizontal position with the weld metal deposited from
underneath ( see Fig. 7.1D ).
7.2.2.5 Multt$fe josition horizontal - Pipe
with its axis horizontal and the welding groove in
a vertical plane. Welding shall be done without
rotating the pipe so that weld metal is deposited
in muhipla position ( see Fig. 7.1E ) .
7.3.5 Preheat - The miuimum preheat temperature shall be specified in WPS. A decrease of
more than 50 degree Celsius and an increase of
more than 100 degree Celsiusfor low temperature
and stainless steel jobs from the minimum spetified shah require requalification,
Plate Horizontal
Axin of p:pXdVwtlcal-
welding
7.1 A-l
Test Position
( Flat )
Plate Vertical,
Axis of
Weld Vertical
7.1
Test Position
( Flat )
Plate Horizontal
7.1 A-2
POS~IONSOF
7.1 0
PLATES
OR
Test Position
( Overhead )
TEST
WELDS
TABLE
7.1
GROOVE-WELD
PROCEDURE
QUALDICATION
TEST_ SPECIMENS
(Classes
RANGE OF
THIOIKXESE
or
BASKMBTAL
Tatcc~~~2-
COUPON
(seaNOTE 1.I)
QU~LIBIED
( see NOTES 1
AND 7)
C--A-~
mm
Mk
Max
( sed Note 5 )
mm
mm
7.3.1.3,
AND
R ANOU OP
TYPES AND NTJMBXBOF TESTY REQTJIBED
----w-m-P-L
TIXI;F~
I--------Side
Notched Bar Impact
Redu- All Weld TramTransverleBend .T .---_---7
DEPOSLTUD ted
verse
Metal
Weld Metal
Heat
WELD
Section Tension
Face
Root
METAL
Tension
Affected
Bend
Bend
Zone
QUALIPIPD ( su
( III 73.4
( sad 7.5.1.4
and
and Notes 1.2
MNz.vsy
7.53 )
Notes 4 and 6 )
and3)
AND 7 )
mm
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
3upt % and
inclu ing 10
21
2t
5
(see Note 7)
2T
2t
20 and less
than 40
21
2r
40 and above
200
Over 10 but
less than 20
LIMITS
Below 3
(1)
lTiICKNESS
2OOwhen
t,40
(12)
(11)
(NI Note 2)
4
(10)
(9)
Macro
and
Hardness
(~86 7.5.1.5
and 7.5.1.6
and
Note 6 )
NOTE 1 - When the groove is filled using a combination of welding processes and/or welding procedures
same process ( one welding process with a different combination of essential variable ).
with the
NOTE 1.1 -
The thickness t of the deposited weld-metal for each welding procedure shall be determined and used
column. The test coupon thickness T is applicable for the base metal for each
welding procedure and shall be used in the range of thickness Df base metal column.
in the thickness t of deposited weld metal
NOTE 1.2 - The deposited weld metal of each welding process and of each welding
the tension side ofthe bend when these test samples are used.
procedure
rhall be included
on
NOTE 1.3 - Each welding process and each welding procedure qualified in this combination manner may be used
separately, only within thesame essential ariables and within the thickness limits described in this table.
NOTE 2 - Side-bend test may be substituted
10 mm but less than 20 mm.
face
and
NOTB 3 - Longitudinal face and root bend tests may be substituted for the required transverse face, root and side
bend tests, when the bending properties of the two base metals or the weld metal and the base metal differ markedly
( see 7.5.4 and 7.5.5 ) .
NOTE 4 - Out of three specimens for notched bar impact test for weld metal as well as heat.affected aone ( HAE )
two specimens shall contain the face side of the joint and one specimen the root side of the joint. These form one set ok
specimens ( see 7.5.6 ).
For oxythickness for which the procedure qualification is valid.
NOTE5 - .S~C
also 7.3.1.5 and 7.3.6.3 for further limitations on range of thickness of base metal qualified.
acetylene
welding
application,
NOTE 7 - For low temperature
16 mm and 16 mm for thickness 16 mm and above.
the
examination
7.3.6
a) No PWHT;
9 PWHT below
lower transformation
rature ( for example, tempering );
7.5.1.2
All weld metal tensile test - One test
is done to determine the ultimate tensile strength
and elongation of weld.metal.
7.5.1.3 Guide bend tests - Guide bend tests
as described below are done to determine soundness and ductility of groove weld joints:
tempe-
up to
10 mm
up to 10 mm
above 10 mm
One longitudinal root bend instead of transverse root bend ( see 7.5.5 ); and
One longitudinal
face bend
transverse face bend ( see 7.5.5
instead
).
of
e) PWHT
7.4 Non-essential
Variables - Variables other
than above arc non-essential variables including
change of location and does not require fresh
procedure
qualification
for metal arc welding,
submerged arc welding and gas shielded arc
welding. The WPS may alone be revised to show
the non-essential variable where necessary.
For
other welding processes the essential variables
will be drawn in consultation with the Inspection
Authority.
7.5 Tests
7.5.1 The following tests are required for procedure qualification ( see Table 7.1 ).
WELD
RLINFORCEME~T
GE MACHiNE
METAL.
qHAu
FLUSH
MAtHINE
WILH.
MINIMUM
GA
ANGUNT
TO OBTAIN
APPROXIMATELY
PARALLEL
SURFACE
DISTORtlOW
I
t
260
OR AS
REOUIREO
LENGTH
EQUAL
I?
:o
I - 1
/
FACE
L-
. BE
EDGES
THERMALLY
MAY
r-
WIDEST
CUT
12rqn
-THIS
-
7.2A
MATERIAL
PERFORM
THAN
TEST
Ot
WELD
e-k
PARALLEL
THESE
OR MACHINE
TO TWO-THIRCS
25 min.
25
I - i
GRIND
SUFFICIENT~
SECTION
LENGTM
FACE
ADDED
EGUALS
OF WELD
PLUS
LENGTH
MACHINED
Reduced Section-Plate
MINIMUM
IS NEEDED
SHALL
TO
r--+qx7---
-_-_-.
GE REMOVED
B
_
_ THIS SECTION
MACHINED
r
7.28
---we_
__
__
1
12
SECTION
__-_-
--.
----_
REDUCED
25
Reduced Section-Pipe
i=
_-
,r
75min.
I
---
_--p-.-_
/EDGE
0F WIDEST
FACE OF WELD
R 25
I
/
Reduced Section-Pipe
All dimensions
FICL 7.2
does
< 76 mm OD
in millimetres.
not exceed
WELD REINFORCEMENT
SHALL BE MACHINED
FLUSH WITH BASE MET
TESTING MACH
PLUG
FIG. 7.3
SMALL PIPE
,I.---
tensile
7.5.3.4 In case of multiple process or multiple procedure the specimen are to be prepared to
represent each process/procedure.
The location
and size of specimen are selected in consultation
with the Inspection Authority.
7.6.1
7.6.1.3
If the specimen breaks outside the
fusion line, the test shall be accepted as meeting
the requirement
provided the strength is more
than 95 percent of the minimum tensile strength
of the base metal.
7.6.2
Bend Tests
7.6.3.3
the specimen
sidered unless
result from
defects.
base
transverse
a) Where
as shown
are removed
required,
10
i
T
_-
-_
-_
--A
R 3 max.
150 min.
PIPE
PLATE
7.5A
Face-Bend
Specimen -
--_
-----
iili!L-.
40
150 min.
PIPE
PLATE
1r
150 min.
J
3min.
/___,_~______
,
IL-C-___-__a
t+
10
\
I
2. T=
The specimen
TwhenIis
lOto20mm.
Side Bend Specimen -
7.5C
NOTE I - Weld reinforcement
surface of the specimen.
and
backing
strip
or
backing
ring,
if any
shall
be removed
NOTE 2 - If the pipe being tested is 100 mm nominal diameter or less, the width of the bend specimen may be
as follows:
2.1 20 mm for diameters 50 mm to 100 mm including
2.2
10 mm for diameters
less than 90 mm to 10 mm including
2.3 Alternatively,
if the pipe is 25 mm nominal dia or less, the width may be that obtained
by cutting
the pipe into quarter sections, less an allowance
for cutting.
These specimens are not required
to have one surface machined
flat as shown.
NOTE 3 - If the
3 mm from the surface
surfaces
of bend
shall be required.
specimen
are
All dimensions
FIG.
7.5
gas
cut,
removal
by machining
in millimetres.
TRANSVERSE
BEND TEST
11
SPECIMENS
or grinding
R3
max.
I
I
LO min.
I
150 min.
4
ROOT
BEND
FACE
BEND
Y=T WHEN
T IS 1.5mm
Y=lOmm
WHEN
T>lOmm
FIG. 7.6
THIS
DISCARD
REDUCE
PIECE
---__
TE%lLi
SPECIMEN
---_A_
SECTION
[SIDE
_-_-_FACE
(SIDE
TO 1Omm
----
SPECIMEN
-----we---
BEND)
BEND
BEND1
I
_____-__-_+-----_--------
ALL-WELD
METAL
I
I
SPECIMEN
TENSILE
SPECIMEN
r >
-___---NOTCHED
._________
BAR
;__I
_------
____
NOTCHEb
BAR
____________._-__--__-.
NOTCHED BAR
.-----_-__--_--m-w
___----
IMPACT
-._-__-----~
SPECIMEN
IMPACT
SPECIMEN
IMPACT
SPECIMEN
--_-
MACRO TEST
-___---__-___,_-___---
SPECIMEN
DISCARD
THIS
PIECE
12
DISCARD
------5
LONGITUDINAL
IHIS
_--
i------, FACE
PIECE
BEND
SPECIMEN
__-_-
IGUCEO
.--
-I
SECTION
----e-e-
_I__--_-TENSILE
SPECIMEN
T_---c--
---
LONGITUDINAL
ROOT BEND
SPECIMEN
MACRO-
I___---
_-_----a.
WELD
--.
._-
r-i
TENSILE
METAL
'1
SPECIMEN
TEST
ALL
---
qualifies for
7.6.9.3
Qualification
on a groove
weld
qualifies partial penetration groove welds for the
thickness of deposited weld metal qualified as
indicated in Table 7.1.
.I
-I
plate
7.6.9.2
Qualification
on a groove
weld
qualifies the fillet weld of all sizes on all base
metal thicknesses as permitted in Table 7.1.
.
I
--a
of
-----
SPECIMEN
member
shall be
b)
cl
Alternatively,
the maximum thickness permitted in Table 7.1 may be adopted for
thicker member provided the qualification
was made on the base metal of thickness
40 mm or more.
_-----___----r
I
I
I-
NOTCHED
--__-e-m-
-1
--e--w--
SPECIMEN
---
IMPACT
-------
IMPACT
-------
SPECIMEN
IMPACT
-_---_---
SPECIMEN
NOTCHEDBAR
NOTCHED
___-----
_--
BAR
---
BAR
---
THIS
7.7 Preparation
of Test Coupon - The base.
metal and filler metal shall be one or more of
those listed in the WPS.
The dimension of the
test coupon shall be sufficient to provide the
required test specimens. The base metal may consist of either a plate or a pipe, Qualifications
of
plate also qualifies the pipe and vice versa.
PIECE
Hardness Test -
7.6.6.1
lb.
group 0,
7.6.6.2
240 HV
group 2.
7.6.6.3
and 4.
group
7.7.2 The test coupon shall qualify the thickness ranges of both base metal and the deposited
weld metal to be used in production.
Limits of
shall
be
in
accordance
with
qualification
Table 7.1.
7.7.3 The WPS made as above on groove weld
qualifies the fillet weld for all fillet sizes on all
base metal thicknesses.
7.6.7
(PQR) -
13
REDUCED
SECTION
NOTCHED BAR
IMPACT
NOTCHED BAR
IMPACT
(SlOti
BEND)
(SIDE BEND)
FIG. 7.9
7.8 Welders
Performance
Qualification
7.8.2 QuaYiJcation
Tests - The
performance
qualification tests are intended to determine
the
ability of the welder or welding operator to make
sound welds. The manufacturer
or contractor
shall qualify each welder or welding operator for
each welding process to be used in production
welding. The performance tests can be either for
groove weld or for fillet weld.
7.8.3
7.8.3.1 Mechanical test - The type and number of test specimens required shall be in accordance with Table 7.2. The order of removal of test
specimen is shown in Fig. 7.10.
The acceptance
shall be in accordance with 7.6.
7.8.3.1.1
Mechanical testing as given in
Table 7.2 may be substituted by radiography on
a test bed of 225 mm length. Acceptance standard
for radiography
shall be as per Class I vessels.
Qualification by radiography is not permitted for
gas metal arc welding.
Groove Welds
qualification
7.8.2.2
A welder or welding operator qualified to weld in accordance -with one qualified
WIS is also qualified to weld in accordance
with
other qualified
WPS
using the same welding
process within the limits of variables listed in this
section ( see 7.8.7 ).
7.8.3.2
Test coupon for pipes - ihe test
coupons for pipes shall be removed as shown in
Fig. 7.1 I for mechanical testing. The acceptance
shall be in accordance with 7.6.
14
..
TABLE
7.2
GROOVED-
WELD
PERFORMANCE
QUALIFICATIONS
AND TEST SPECIMENS
THICKNESS
LIMITS
( cluusc 7.8.3.1 )
TBICENESS t OR
DEPOSITED WELD
METAL
QUALIFIED
( scc 7.8.6 AND
NOTE 2 )
mm
THICxNPss l- OB
THE TEST
COUPCN WELDED
( see NOTE 1 )
mm
up to 10
2t
2t
10 but less
than 20
20 and above
NOTE 1 c
Maximum
welded
( J-CCNote
2
to be
5 )
1
-_
The entire thickness of groove joint test coupon shall be filled with deposited weld metal.
NOTE 4 -
Face and root-bend tests may be used to qualify combination test of:
in Fig. 7.11B.
IIISCARD
DISCARD
ROOT
(SIDE
BEND
BEND)
FACE
BEND
(S!DE
---_--
BEND)
--_---
MACRO
------
_-----
l-
.ONGITUDINAL
FACE
BEN0
I I
THIS
--
PIECE
-I--
----
, SPECIMEN
SPECIMEN
I
.---
TEST
.ONGITUOINAL
DISCARD
ROOT
7.10A
Transverse
BEND
I-
- I-
---
SPECIMEN
Bend
~
I-
_---MACRO
TEST
DISCARD
I
7.106
Fro. 7.10
1.8.4
ORDER
OF REMOVAL
OF TEST SPECIMEN,PLATE -
specimen
for fracture
test
Longitudinal
SPECIMEN
THIS
PIECE
Bend
PERFORMANCEQUALIFICATION
Fillet Welds
7.8.4.2
-_I_____
t
is
15
FACE
BEND
YE
MACRO
L!7.11A
Fro. 7.11
BEND
(SIDE BEND)
Multiple
Horizontal
and Multiple-Inclined
OF BENDING
P AND RESTART
AR THE CENTRE
WELD
TEST
SPECIMEN
MACRO
100
\MAXIMM
FILLET
SltE=t
TO 1Omm
t = 5mm
IMUM FILLET
t = WALL THICKNESS
Norm -
BEND
/&CE
7.11B
Fiat or Horizontal
WE
I-
BEND)
\ ROOT BEND
(SIDE BEND)
MACRO
J&T BEND
7.8.4.3 The
cut end of one of the end
section shall be smoothed and etched with a suitable etchant ( see Appendix K ) to give a clear
,definition of the weld metal and heat affected
zone. The visual examination shall show complete
fusion and free from cracks except that the linear
indications at the root shall not exceed O-8 mm.
The weld shall not have a concavity or convexity
.greater than l-5 mm and the difference in length
of legs of fillet shall not exceed 3 mm.
7.8.4.4 For fillet welds the basic position for
plates and pipes are described
in Fig. 7.14 and
7.15.
7.8.4.5
The limitations and number of tests
required for fillet weld performance
shall be as
shown in Table 7.3 for plate, Table
7.4 for fillet
qualification
by groove weld and Table
7.5 for
,small diameter pipe fillet weld.
7.8.5
7.8.5.1
Welders who pass the required tests
in groove welds in test positions ( see Fig. 7.1 )
shown in Table 7.6 shall be qualified for the position of groove welds, including
branch welds,
shown in Table 7.6 and the fillet welds (see Fig.
7.14 and Fig. 7.15 ) shown in Table 7.6. In addition, the welders who pass the required test for
groove welds shall also be qualified to make fillet
welds and in all thicknesses and pipe diameters of
any size within the limits of the welding variables
( see 7.8.7 ).
7.8.5.2 Welders who pass required test for
fillet welds in the test position of Table 7.6 shall
be qualified for the positions shown in this table.
Welders who pass the test for fillet weld on plate
shall be qualified to make fillet weld only in all
thicknesses
of material, sizes of fillet weld and
pipes and tubes 73 mm outside diameter and over,
within the essential variable.
Welders who make
fillet weld in pipe or tube less than 73 mm-outside
diameter shall pass the pipe fillet test in accordance with 7.8.4.5.
7.8.5.3 A fabricator who does production
welding in a special orientation
may make the
test for performance. qualification
in this specific
orientation.
Such qualification
is valid only for
the position actually tested except that an anguof f 15 is permitted
in the
lar
deviation
inclination of the weld.
7.8.6
@al$cation
Test Coujons
7.8.6.1
The test coupons may be plate or
pipe. When all position qualifications for pipe are
accomplished
by welding one pipe assembly in
.both horizontal
and multiple
positions, large
diameter pipes shall be employed to make up
the test coupons-as illustrated in Fig. 7.16.
7.8.6.2 The dimensions
of the
welding
groove of the test coupons used in making double
welded groove welds or single
welded groove
yelds with backing shall be the same as those of
any welding
procedure or shall be as shown in
Fig. 7.17.
Partial penetration
groove wtldtrs or
fillet welds are considered
as welding
with
backing.
7.8.6.3
The
dimensions
of the
welding
groove of the test coupon used in making qualification tests for single welded groove welds without backing
shall be the same as those for any
WPS qualified by the manufacturer
or as shown
in Fig. 7.18.
7.8.7
Welding Variables
\AXIS
OF WELD
HORIZONTAL
7.14A
AXIS OF WELD
AXIS OF WELD
7.14 POSITIONS OF TEST PLATES FOR WELDER PERFORMANCE QUALIFICATION OF FILLET WELDS
TABLE
TYPE OBJOINT
5 to 10
TY_PE OF JOINT
Any groove
7.4 FILLET
All thicknesses
TEST
NUMBER OF SPECIMENS
REQUIRED ( see FIQ. 7.12 1
c-_-~---~
Macro
Fracture
QUALIFICATION
TEICKNESS~ OF
TEST COUPON AS
WELDED
FILLET-WELD
RANGE QUALIBIED
THICKNESS t cm
TEST COUPON AS
WELDED
mm
Tee fillet
TABLE
7.3 PLATE
BY PLATE
OR PIPE GROOVE-WELD
RANQE QUALIFIED
18
TESTS
7.15A
Flat
7.1%)
TABLE
NOMINAL PIPE SIZE OB
WELn
7.158
7.15C
Horizontal
7.15E
Overhead
Fro. 7. i5
SAMPLE
(Rotated
Vertical
( Rotated )
Multiple
7.5
SMALL
DIAMETER
PIPE FILLET-WELD
( No MAXIMUM )
PIPE WALL
THICKNESS
QUALIFIED
TEST
NUMBER OB SPECIMENS
y-_---h-_---~
Macro
Less than 20 mm
20 to 50 rhm
Over 50 mm
19
Fracture
All
All
All
1
1
1
1
TABLE
7.6
PERFORMANCE
QVBLIFICATION TEST
h_-____-_T
r------Weld
Position
Plate-Groove
QUALIFICATION
F
i, H
v
0
V and 0
H, V and 0
Plate-Fillet
20
F: V, 0
All
0
V and 0
Pipe-)Groove
2F
MI
Hand
Pipe-Fillet
POSITION
POSITION AND
r-------__-_,___h
Groove
Plate and Pipe
Over 600 mm OD
30
All
All
MF
F ( Note 2 )
F, H ( Note 2 )
F ( Note 2 )
F ( Note 2 )
F ( Note 2 )
F, H ( Note 2 )
0
V and 0
F
F, H
F, H, V
F, H, 0
All
All
F i Note 2 )
F, H ( Note 2 )
F, H, V ( Note 2)
F, H, 0 ( Note 2 )
All ( Note 2 )
F
F, H
F, V, 0
All
All
F
H
LIMITATIONS
FFH
Ail
All
All
FFH
F: H
F, H, 0
All
F = Flat
H = Horizontal
V = Vertical
ROOT BEND
BEN3
L REFERENCE
FIXED
TAL POSITION
SIDE
BEND
NOTE 1 NOTE 2 -
FIG. 7.16
Side bend may be substituted for face and root bends for thickness above 10 mm.
Acceptance as per 7.6.
ORDER
ALL
POSITION-PERFORMANCE
TEST
t2m*
~tox.BUT
/SUGGESTED
slzE
0F ,,
RING OR STRIP t/3 x 1 bt
FIN. 7.17
GREATER
FIG. 7.18
OUTSIDE DIAMETER
QUALIFIEIJ
( No MAXIMUM )
mm
Minimum of not less than
size welded
20 to 50 mm
Over 25 mm
Over 50 mm
7.8.8.1
When the qualification
coupon has
failed
in
mechanical
testing
in accordance
with 7.8.4.1,
retesting
shall be by mechanical
testing. When an immediate retest is made, the
welder or welding operator shall ma$e two consecutive test coupons for each position for which
all of which shall pass the test
he has failed,
requirement.
WELDS DIAMETER
QUALIFICATION
Less than 20 mm
NOT
THAN 3mm
73 mm and over
7.8.9.1 When
he has not welded with a
process during a period of 3 months or more, his
qualification
for that process
shall be expired,
except when he is welding with another process,
the period may be extended to 6 months.
7.8.7.8 fin-essential
Variables Variables
other than above
are
non-essential
variables
including changes of location and does not require
fresh performance
qualification
for metal
arc
welding, submerged
arc welding and inert gas
arc welding. For other welding processes this is to
be drawn in consultation
with the Inspection
Authority.
with any
his qualiof which
by virtue
(EDC48)
21
Printed
Delhi-7